Home
        Smeadlink User`s Guide
         Contents
1.      Smeadlink Scanner program    When you are scanning paper or electronic documents with the Scanner  program  you can choose to have the images attached to rows in Smeadlink  or left unattached  The Scanner program attaches images to rows using  LinkScripts  which are created using the Indexing Wizard     Introduction to Smeadlink 13    The second component in the Imaging module is the Image Viewer  The  Image Viewer is an add on utility for Smeadlink  and it allows you to view  any image that is attached to a row in Smeadlink  The Image Viewer in   cludes features to help in viewing an image  like Zoom and Rotate  and it  also includes features for faxing or printing an image  The example below  shows what the Image Viewer looks like        Se Sel Ree  nye ee       Image Viewer in the Smeadlink    The third component in the Imaging module is the Manual Indexing Viewer   which is another add on utility  The Manual Indexing Viewer allows you to  view images that have been scanned into Smeadlink  but have not been at   tached to any rows  These are called orphan images  and they can be created  by several Smeadlink programs  including the Scanner program     Like the Image Viewer  the Manual Indexing Viewer includes features to  help in viewing images  like Zoom and Rotate  and it also allows you to fax  or print orphan images  In addition to these features  the Manual Indexing  Viewer also allows you to attach orphan images to rows  You can either  attach an orphan image au
2.     1  Open the Tools menu in Smeadlink     2  Click the Import command on the Tools menu  The Import submenu will  now appear     3  Click the Run command on the Import submenu  The Run submenu will  now appear  listing all the imports and jobs that have been created in the  open database     4  Click the desired Denso import on the Run submenu  A Smeadlink win   dow will now appear as shown below  telling you to prepare the Denso scan   ner to transmit data     i  Prepare ha Dieraciand In Traci     Praz DE when rocky  Cee      Smeadlink window       5  To prepare the Denso scanner for transmitting   e Open the main menu in the scanner   e From the main menu  press the 5 button     Note  The Denso scanner needs to be in its cradle for data to be uploaded  from the scanner to Smeadlink  and the cradle needs to be connected to the  computer that the import will be run from     6  Click the OK button on the Smeadlink window  then press the ENT but   ton on the Denso scanner     The tracking data in the Denso scanner will now be imported into Smeadlink   A Transfer Completed  message will appear in the Denso once the data has  been uploaded  The tracking status of the objects and destinations in the  open database will now be updated with the information from the uploaded  tracking session     Using the Tracking Features 291    15  Using Smeadlink s Tracking  Features    oh Cie bimp ed Petes Poth F Saad Pec  Dees Bears    THS i Lem  Lee  eI   Te ETY i uppe  amm Shale 7   ST PS L
3.     The second search utility is called Find  The Find utility allows you to locate  individual rows in the open folder by their ID numbers or any other desig   nated field  Find locates records by matching data that you enter with the  data in each cell of a column in the open folder  Once Find has located a cell  in the column that contains data matching the data you entered  it takes you  automatically to that location in the open folder s records grid     For instance  suppose you have a folder that contains customer rows and one  of the columns in this folder is called State  Each cell in the State column  contains a two digit abbreviation of the state one of your customers is lo   cated in  Now suppose that you want to view the row for a customer in the  state of Wisconsin  To find this customer row you could enter the data  WI   into the Find utility  and have it search the State column to find any cells  that contain the data  WI   When Find locates the first cell containing the  data  WI   it will automatically take you to that portion of the records grid     Introduction to Smeadlink 51    One of the strengths of the Find utility is that you do not have to know the  exact text string or ID number of the row you are searching for  You can  enter as much data as you remember  and Find will locate the row that best  matches the data you entered  Usually Find will locate the desired record  before you have entered the entire text string or Id number     The Find utility
4.     The selected folder will now be opened in the Smeadlink window        Workgroup submenu    Query Mode    By default  as set in the Options menu   Smeadlink opens folders in Query  Mode  In this mode  a Query Window will display  allowing you to specify  the criteria for the record or records you are looking for  For example  you  might enter the patient ID to be taken immediately to that patient s record  Or   you might enter  A   in a Vendor Name field to see all vendors that start with   A   Query Mode provides a quick way to get to the data you are looking for   Below is an example of a Query Window        After entering your criteria  click Apply Query to display the matching records   If you want to see all records  do not enter any criteria and click Apply Query   In the above example  the user is looking for all Client records that starts with   Smead      Moving Around in Smeadlink 59    Opening a Subfolder    Each Smeadlink folder may have one or more subfolders  Each subfolder  may also have one or more subfolders of its own  This section will show you  how to open a subfolder in Smeadlink  You can use the procedure explained  in this section to open a subfolder from a regular folder or from another  subfolder     Note  For a detailed definition of a subfolder  see the section Basic Smeadlink  Terms in chapter 3     To open a subfolder     1  Activate the row in the open folder that you would like to view informa   tion about in a subfolder  You can activate a r
5.     e Ifany objects have been assigned to the desired destination  then select  the row of one of these objects  An entry for the destination will now  appear in the Tracking Viewer  along with an entry for the selected  object     2  Place your mouse pointer over the destination entry in the Tracking Viewer   and then click the right mouse button once     The Tracking Viewer submenu will now appear  The commands on this  submenu will differ according to the tracking level of the destination that  you selected  and whether or not it is a container  If the destination is a  container  then you will see a command called History on the Tracking Viewer  submenu  This command allows you to open the History report  which dis   plays all the locations the destination has been assigned to     Using the Tracking Features 297    If the destination contains one ore more objects  then the submenu will also  contain one or more  ITEMS Contained  commands  where ITEMS is one  type of object assigned to this destination  For instance  if a destination had  a folder assigned to it  the Tracking Viewer submenu would include the  command Folders Contained     Regardless of the destination s tracking level  and regardless of whether or  not it is a container  you will see a command called Refresh Tracking Infor   mation on the Tracking Viewer submenu  This command can be helpful if  your Smeadlink system is installed on a network and you want to see the  latest tracking status of an object     
6.    Text file with exported Smeadlink data    Introduction to Smeadlink Imaging 129    8  Introduction to Smeadlink Imaging       Chapter contents    Introduction  Basic Imaging Concepts  Scanner System Requirements    130 Chapter 8    Introduction    The next five chapters will show you how to use the Smeadlink Imaging  module  The Imaging module consists of three components  the Scanner  program  the Image Viewer utility and the Manual Indexing utility  The Scan   ner program allows you to scan images of paper or electronic documents  into Smeadlink  and either attach the images to Smeadlink rows or leave  them unattached  The two viewers then allow you to view both attached and  unattached images in Smeadlink     This chapter will introduce you to the Imaging module  The first section  explains the basic concepts for using Smeadlink Imaging  and the second  section lists the specific system requirements for the Scanner program  If  you have never used the Imaging module before  then reading this chapter  should give you a good basic idea about how the different components in it  are used  If you are already familiar with the Imaging module  then you may  just want to skim this chapter and go to chapter 9     Note  For a summary of the Imaging module and its function in your  Smeadlink system  see the sections Imaging Module and About Your  Smeadlink System in chapter 1 of this manual     Introduction to Smeadlink Imaging 131    Basic Imaging Concepts    The Smeadlink Imagin
7.    The second part of this chapter will show you how to track objects in the  Denso portable scanner  You will learn how to configure the Denso scanner  for use with Smeadlink  how to track objects in the Denso scanner and how  to upload tracking information from the Denso scanner into Smeadlink     Assigning an Object to a Destination    This section will show you how to assign an object to a destination in the  Tracking program  This is the first step in the process of monitoring the  location of an object with Smeadlink Tracking  This section will also show  you how to assign a due back date to objects assigned to Out destinations   The due back date is the date the object needs to be returned to its permanent  destination  When you assign due back dates to objects in the Tracking pro   gram  you can then run a report in Smeadlink or the Tracking programs that  tells you which objects have not been returned by their due date  This al   lows you to keep up to date on the status of each object     Note  Smeadlink Tracking uses bar codes to monitor the locations of ob   jects  In order to track objects with Smeadlink Tracking  the bar code of  each object you want to track and the bar code of the destination you want to  assign the object to must be in your Smeadlink database  Objects or destina   tions that do not have bar codes in your Smeadlink database will not be  recognized by Smeadlink  For more information  see the Tracking Require   ments section in the previous chap
8.    e Click the down arrow at the right of the Object box  A dropdown will  now appear listing the different trackable object types in the open  Smeadlink database     e Click the desired object type on the submenu   5  Click the OK button or press ENTER     Smeadlink will now generate a Past Due Tracked Objects report using the  date and object type you specified  The example on the following page shows  what the Past Due Tracked Objects Report looks like     The Past Due Report will display all the tracking information in the open  database for each item that has not been returned to its permanent destina   tion by its due back date  Therefore  depending on the number of trackable  item types in the open database  your report may contain a different number  of columns than the report in the example  The next page explains more  about the columns in the Past Due Tracked Objects report     Using the Tracking Features    ioe mas   ete ay   METE Dai  i eas  ie p  fe heas  NAAU pua  fe  ha       aie Pa bai ee  a     r eg ee a Bilal bees Le i id    Derer  Semi r SF ister   hirer iors Homer       Danm ee eee D    fee Lee  Pee i    Deer  Peri dpp  rgenr  Fopecmitet Gin i tigen jam Himani    ORE EEn T    Degas r  aprige  hi T  besmi eni jimin d b  Tegar  Pret apt  i E  Liei ist Od ad    kipo  u eed i   Mae lam Hemd E    bms Loe  Hi      Fim lam Prd BY 1    Past Due Tracked Objects report       311    The Past Due Tracked Objects report contains at least six columns  and pos   sibly m
9.    tronic documents to be scanned with this rule will be taken from     To select a directory  select a drive from the dropdown menu at the top  of this section  All the directories in the selected drive will now be  displayed as folders in the box below it  Click on the folder of the  directory you want the documents to be taken from to select it as the  input directory for this rule     Working with Scanner Rules 143    e The second part of the Select Disk Source Input Settings window is  titled Include Exclude Files  This is where you select which docu   ment files from the selected input directory will be scanned  This is  not a saved setting  because it will most likely change each time you  use the rule to scan documents  You will learn how to set these options  in the next chapter     e Press ENTER or click the OK button now to save the input directory  you selected  The Select Disk Source Input Settings window will now  close     9  You have now finished setting the options that are required by the Scan   ner to define a rule  To save the rule     e Open the Scanning menu and click the Rule command  The Rule  submenu will now appear     e Click the Save Active Rule command on the Rule submenu     144 Chapter 9    Renaming a Rule    The next three sections in this chapter will show you how to use the features  that are available in the Scanner for working with entire rules  This section  will begin by showing you how to rename an existing rule  You can use the  informa
10.   6  Click the Go  button in the lower left corner of the PC Files window     The PC Files window will now close  and a LinkScript window will appear  if the selected LinkScript needs some identification information to index the  document  The exact appearance of the LinkScript window will vary from  LinkScript to LinkScript  The example on the following page shows what a  typical LinkScript window looks like     332 Chapter 17       PC Files LinkScript window  7  Enter the appropriate information in the LinkScript window   8  Click the OK button at the bottom of the LinkScript window     PC Files will now use the information you entered in the LinkScript window  to index the selected document in Smeadlink  If you try to attach the selected  document to a row that already has a PC Files attachment  then a message  window will appear asking if you want to save the document or abort the  procedure  If you choose to save the document  a second window will ap   pear asking if you want to save the document as a new version of the exist   ing document or as an additional page  s  in the existing document     If PC Files cannot find the row that you want the document to be attached to   then it will orphan the document and it will display a message to that effect   If PC Files is able to index the document correctly  then it will display a  message to let you know that the process has been completed  The example  below shows what this message looks like        Process completed mess
11.   Print Setup issccisscciescetieriesssbdseitie dd estinse ean espere ENaren EENE EEEE 109  Printing REPOS ss 5 5 5 s2iss eset sacaeevetbaedytaesniss nana sais sbactieee nasties 112  Printing Images icc  scies cercaridadaniencaveio dea  117  Fax Sep oissstessset  aedecsastinivesvesise ss eectedtebindesees EEr ENE 119  Faxing images  eeure ictesnsescvetecbsssatescesssavessiscsdivenevacotvens aeto 121  Printing Labels sisien aree r Ea eaa EEA UAE 123  Exporting ROWS  ccssici   ces ccensehetssceiesvec tana vateerseeevaheeicemesenes 127   8  Introduction to Smeadlink Imaging               ccsscccsssccsssresssreee 129  EMAON n A ene A errr eee tee tre E oer ye er eran nrc mereee 130  Basic Imaging Concepts   0 0 0    cceeceseseeeeerceseeerereeeceeeaeeeeeaceas 131  Scanner System Requirement    0      ccsseeseeceesceesseeeeeeeeeeeees 136   9  Working with Scanner Rules               ssccsssssscssesscseessseeesseeees 137  Tritrod  CtlON escris sesenst nica een eves ar eh cine 138  Creating a Basic Rule 2 3  tsi sdsdsicsarudiiacsiaienuens 139  Renaming a Rule  ssc  sss scisesscisn tii cevaseusree sl neisnceanee neeedis 144  Cloning a RNS assess hae  estes te  Mesias ssc atkesas nee ce EEE 146  Deleting  a Rule sic5  ccc love nda acnca ean  147  Using Load Last Batch  2    3  5 6352i 0iiseteistoineieseieveleeiadie 148  Extending Rule  ssc sscscevecessdsbeeteaieciessisesaseacte ness snes inne veel 149  Options on the Image Processing Submenu               eeeee 159   10  Scanning and Vi
12.   There are two ways to send a group of  documents to Smeadlink  Both procedures are explained below     e First  you can drag the documents from Windows Explorer or My  Computer to the Smeadlink shortcut on your desktop  if you have a  Smeadlink shortcut      e Second  you can use the Send To utility  To use the Send to utility   you will need to make sure that your C  Windows SendTo directory  contains a shortcut to the Smeadlink  exe file  s135 exe   A shortcut to  the Smeadlink  exe file is automatically created during the Smeadlink  installation process  but you may want to check it to make sure it is  pointing to the correct file     Now locate the documents you want to index  select them and click  the right mouse button once  Select the Send To option on the popup  menu that appears  and then select the Smeadlink option on the Send  To submenu     Once you send the documents to Smeadlink  the Smeadlink Login window  will appear  if Smeadlink was not already open      338    Chapter 17    4  If Smeadlink was not already open  then open the desired database from  the Login window     Once you have opened a database  the Login window will close and the PC  Files window will appear  The PC Files window lists all the LinkScripts in  the open Smeadlink database  and it allows you to select which LinkScript  will be used to index each document  The example below shows what the  PC Files window looks like     Note  The PC Files window will only appear if the open database con
13.   Tp fades doha Donarai    Dinie          Program shortcut    Edit PC File links    Name and location of Smeadlink document copy    Once the document shortcut is displayed in the Image Viewer  then you can  click the shortcut to open the document  The program the document was  created in will then automatically opened  and the document will be selected  in it     Note  The Image Viewer functions as described above for all documents  except image documents  When you index an image document with PC Files   a copy of the document is created in Smeadlink just like a normal PC Files  document  However  when you click the row the image document is attached  to  the image is simply displayed in the Image Viewer  so long as your  organization owns and is licensed to use the Smeadlink Imaging module      there is no shortcut to whatever program the image was created in  This  provides a third way to index images in Smeadlink  in addition to the Scan   ner program and the Import Wizard program      Using PC Files 329    PC Files Setup Option    As we covered earlier in this chapter  PC Files allows you to index electronic  documents of any format in Smeadlink  Once a document has been indexed  by PC Files  any Smeadlink user can open it  locate the row that is associated  with the document and then use that row to open the document in the pro   gram it was written with  For instance  if you used PC Files to index a Word  document  then any user could open the document in Word from Smea
14.   Viewer s toolbar  and explain how each option can be used to manipulate  the open image document     Note  The Image Viewer s toolbar can be optionally switched to a tradi   tional toolbar by clicking on the Main Toolbar option on the Image Viewer  Submenu     210    Chapter 11    Window   Add Attachment Window    The Add Attachment Window option on the Window submenu allows you  to display multiple image documents at once in the Image Viewer utility   When you click option  a new window will appear in the Image Viewer   The new window will be automatically selected  so if you click a row that is  attached to an image document  the first page of that image document will  be displayed in the new window  The example below shows what the Image  Viewer looks like with multiple viewer windows in it  The Image Viewer in  the example contains two attachment windows                 Multiple viewer windows in the Image Viewer    You can use the Add Attachment Window option to create any number of  viewer windows in the Image Viewer  but the maximum number of usable  windows will depend on the size and resolution of your monitor  When the  Image Viewer contains multiple viewer windows  you will need to select a  window before you can begin manipulating the image it contains  You can  select a viewer window by placing the mouse pointer anywhere over the  window and clicking the left mouse button once  The title bar of the win   dow will then turn blue to indicate that this is the acti
15.   When a rule is cloned in the Scanner program  a new rule is created with the  exact settings of the cloned rule  You can clone any existing rule in the open  Smeadlink database  This section will show you how to clone a rule     To clone a rule     1  Open the Scanning menu and click the Rule command  The Rule sub   menu will now appear     2  Click the Clone Rule command on the Rule submenu  The Clone Existing  Rule window will now appear as shown below     Fa Clone Existing Rule    Existing Rules Selection        Select Existing Rule ID  ECC Scaner e ee eee en           New Rule Creation    New Rule ID       Cancel _     Clone Existing Rule window                   3  Select the rule that you want to clone  To select a rule     e Click the down arrow at the right of the Select Existing Rule ID box to  display a list of existing rules in the open Smeadlink database     e Click the desired rule     4  Enter the identification information for the new rule that will be created   To enter the identification information     e Type a name for the new rule in the New Rule ID box   5  Press ENTER or click the OK button     A new tule will now be created with the name you specified and identical  settings to the rule it was cloned from     Working with Scanner Rules 147    Deleting a Rule    Sometimes you may create a rule in the Scanner that is only applicable for a  certain situation  For instance  you may set up a rule that you will only use  once to scan a group of documents in
16.   all rows of data from the top level of your data structure down into one  folder     Chee bom poe gari be Fidija im   Hore che pon mami  Pobioh bo pubbeh pour TIAL  peg f      Miihe alem bore miha tabi dar ric ona Poti  ja  Fotiri    Ribisi a eea poa raacb labin eme m ppa a hiar bed  ip pave l hi ji Fiian  Patches       The    Separate    format publishes all rows of data from the top level of your  data structure down into separate folders  The wizard will guide the user to  choose individual tables and views to display  and the destination directory  on the network where the published information will be stored  In addition  the user can add an image of the company logo to the page if desired  and  then finally they can select the color scheme of the site     Appendix A  Smeadlink System Requirements 331    Appendix A  Smeadlink  System Requirements    Minimum Hardware   Pentium II 266 MHz or greater   128 MB RAM   4x CD ROM  Unless connected to network   40 MB free disk space   256 colors at 800x600dpi    Recommended Hardware   Pentium II 450 MHz or greater   256 MB RAM   8x CD ROM  Unless connected to network   40MB free disk space   256 colors at 800x600dpi    Operating System   Windows 98SE   Windows XP   Windows NT 4 0 Workstation  Service Pack 6A   Windows 2000 Professional  Service Pack 1     Servers  Windows NT 4 0 Server  Service Pack 6A   Windows 2000 Server Edition  Service Pack 1     Database   Access 98   Access 2000   Microsoft SQL Server 7 0  SP2    SQL Ser
17.   display it in the subfolder along with all the other rows in the subfolder  this  is the only time you will ever see all the rows in a subfolder displayed at  once      Note  When you enter an ID number in the Jump To utility  you need to enter  the number as it is stored in the database  In other words  if the ID column of  the row you want to find has a display mask  then you will need to enter the  ID number as it looks without the mask     Viewing Rows in Smeadlink 75    To locate a row using Jump To   1  Select the desired Jump To options     The options you select will determine the scope of Jump To s search  and the  way the Jump To results are displayed  There are five Jump To options  and  the example below shows where they are located on the Jump To utility           Seach x  Find   dump Tn    Jug                         __ Jump To box  C Dip Remis iy   D Dipy i a Pea niae   c Seanch cuevend Vak gap      Seuech ompi Table   F emch entre Dashare    dhanp Ain      Jump To options    As you can see in the example  the five options are located immediately  below the Jump To box  which is where you enter the ID number you want  Jump To to locate  Each option is explained below     e Display Results Only   If you select this option  then when Jump To  finds a row that matches the ID number you entered  it will display  the row by itself in its folder or subfolder  In other words  you will not  see the other rows in the folder or subfolder that contains the row     e Dis
18.   e Place the mouse pointer in the Due Back Date box immediately to the  right of the date  Now click the left mouse button once  A blinking  cursor will now appear in the box and the year component of the date  will be highlighted  Delete the current date and type in the new one     e Click the down arrow at the right of the Object Due Back Date box  A  calendar will now appear  You can use the scroll bar at the bottom of  the calendar to display dates up to January 1  2029  Click the desired  date in the calendar to select it     Important  If the destination that you are assigning objects to is a con   tainer  then if you move the container and assign it to a destination the  Tracking program will update the due back dates of any objects it contains   As long as an object in the container has a due back date later than the due  back date of the container itself  the due back date of the object will be  updated to match that of the container  If an object in the container has an  earlier due back date than the container itself  the object s due back date  will remain unchanged     Note  If you want to assign a different due back date for each object that  you will assign to this destination  then you will need to specify the appro   priate due back date before you enter each object s bar code     5  Enter the bar codes of the objects you want to assign to the destination   To enter each object bar code     e Type the bar code in the Object section of the Tracking window  an
19.   each filter line in the window includes a button called Remove in  the lower right corner of the line  Clicking the Remove button for a  line will permanently remove that filter     e Second  clicking the Remove All button at the bottom of the Filter  window will remove all the filters in the window at once     The example below shows what the Remove and Remove All buttons look  like in the Filter window     Remove button for one filter line       Remove All button    Note  If you make a mistake removing filters from the Filter window  just  click the Cancel button at the bottom of the window  The Filter window will  now Close  and any changes you made since it was last opened will be dis   carded  You can then reopen the Filter window and continue working     88    Chapter 5    Using the Filter Window s Advanced Features    As you learned in the first part of this section  the Filter window has an  setting called Advanced Features that gives you several additional capabili   ties for working with filters  These capabilities are mainly intended for work   ing with multiple filters in one view  First  you can use parentheses to adjust  the order that the filters in a view are applied  Second  you can use the logi   cal operators AND and OR to adjust relationships between different filters   Finally  you can use an option called Activate to activate or deactivate any  filter in a view  The following instructions will show you how to use each of  the advanced features on the F
20.   four images     Combining all the images in a document into one file reduces the size of  your Smeadlink database and it also makes it easier for the operating system  to work with your Smeadlink images  The downside is that if a user is on a  WAN network and they want to look at one page in Smeadlink from a mul   tiple page image document  they would have to wait for the entire document  to be downloaded before viewing one page in the document     If the same document had been saved as separate images  the images would  be downloaded individually as the user selected them to view  Regardless of  which storage method you select  the Smeadlink Image Viewer will function  the same from the user s perspective  If you want to save multiple page docu   ments as one file with multiple images  open the Input Output menu and  select Multiple Page Image File     Working with Scanner Rules 159    Options on the Image Processing Submenu       Image Processing submenu  Auto Endorser Annotate    Selecting the Auto Endorser Annotate option on the Image Processing sub   menu will bring up the Automatic Endorser Annotation Properties window  shown below        Automatic Endorser Annotation Properties window    The Automatic Endorser Annotation Properties window allows you to auto   matically endorse paper documents or annotate scanned images  Automatic  endorsing means that the scanner you use to scan paper documents will print  a short text string on the documents as they are scanned  Aut
21.   so it was explained in  the Creating a Basic rule section of this chapter  The Include Exclude sec   tion changes with each scanning session  so it is explained in the next chap   ter  which is about the actual scanning process     Working with Scanner Rules 157    Output Settings    Selecting the Output Settings option on the Input Output submenu will bring  up the Output Settings Selection window  Clicking the Add or Edit button             Output Settings window    will display a window similar to the one shown above     The Image Output Directory option is a required setting for Scanner rules   so it was explained in the section Creating a Basic Rule earlier in this  chapter  The File Prefix  File Extension and Next Doc Num options deter   mine how images scanned with the current rule will be named  Each time  an image is scanned  the Scanner names the image by converting the cur   rent Next Doc Num setting to base 36  adding this number to the specified  file prefix and then using the specified file extension  The Scanner then  increments the Next Doc Num setting by one so the next image will have a  slightly different name     To modify the current File Prefix  File Extension or Next Doc Num set   tings  click the mouse pointer in the appropriate box and then type in the  desired setting  If you are modifying the Next Doc Num setting  type in the  new number in standard decimal notation  base 10   When the Scanner  uses this number to name images  it will automaticall
22.   then any user could open the document in Word from Smeadlink  as long as  that user had Word installed on their computer      The PC Files program serves two general purposes  First  it makes docu   ments that would normally be available to just one person available to every  Smeadlink user on your network who has the appropriate access rights  Sec   ond  it makes documents easily accessible  For instance  suppose an em   ployee in a company writes a letter to one of the company s customers  and  the letter needs to be available to other employees in the company so that  they know what their standing is with the customer  Since the letter is saved  on the employee s C  drive  which is only visible to that employee  no one  else can open the letter and view it  Even if that C  drive was visible to other  employees  however  they would still need to sort through the contents of  the drive to find the letter     Indexing the letter with PC Files can easily solve both of these issues  First   by making the letter accessible through Smeadlink  it becomes available to  anyone on the network who has Smeadlink on their computer  Second  by  placing the row associated with the letter in an obvious location  like a Cus   tomer Relations folder  it becomes easy to find for the other Smeadlink  users on your network     There are three ways to index an electronic document with PC Files  The  first way to index a document with PC Files is to drag the document from  Windows Explorer  or 
23.  4  If you would like your image documents to be faxed in landscape mode   check the Landscape option under Orientation     The image to the left of the two Orientation options will change to reflect  how the data will appear on each page of the fax     5  Click OK or press Enter to save the setup information     The Print Setup window will now close and you will be finished with the fax  setup process     Scanning and Viewing Images 201    Faxing an Image    Once you have gone through the fax setup process explained in the previous  section  you will be able to fax single or multiple page image documents  from the Scanner program  This section will show you how to fax an image  document  You can use the information in this section to fax any image  document in the open Smeadlink database     Note  This section assumes that you have already gone through the fax setup  process for the Scanner program  For information about the fax setup pro   cess  see the previous section in this chapter     To fax an image document     1  Select the image document that you want to fax  To select an image docu   ment     e Click the row of the desired document in the Scanner s records grid   2  Click the Fax Image command on the File menu     The Print window will now appear as shown below  just like it would if you  were printing the document instead of faxing it        Print window    e Make sure that the Name box in the Print window contains the name of  the fax machine that you want to us
24.  Indexing utility will be resized to the corresponding height and  width  The percentage you selected will also be displayed in the Zoom win   dow     Lock Zoom    When you resize an image using the normal Zoom feature  the Zoom per   centage you selected will only be applied as long as the original image is  displayed in the Manual Indexing utility  If you bring up a different image in  the viewer  either a different page in a multi page image document  a differ   ent version in a multi version image document or an altogether different  image document  then the Zoom percentage you selected will be discarded   The new image will be displayed in the Manual Indexing utility using Fill  Viewer with Image     242    Chapter 12    The Lock Zoom button allows you to keep the specified Zoom percentage  and use it to view any number of different images in the Manual Indexing  utility  When Lock Zoom is enabled  you can bring up different pages  dif   ferent versions and different image documents in the viewer  and each im   age will be displayed using the same Zoom percentage  To enable Lock  Zoom for the Manual Indexing utility  click the Lock Zoom button on the  Image Viewer s toolbar once     Rotate Image 90 Degrees    The Rotate Image 90 Degrees button allows you to rotate the current image  in the Manual Indexing utility in 90 degree increments  This feature is help   ful if a document was scanned in upside down  and you would like to view  the image document right side up  To r
25.  Smeadlink folder or subfolder is based on one table of data in a data     Introduction to Smeadlink 43    base  but it can display multiple views of the data in that table  Each view is  a distinct arrangement of rows  Although all the views in a folder are based  on the folder s database table  they can also contain data from other tables   For instance  one view in a folder could contain all the rows in the folder s  database table and organize them by an ID column  whereas another view  could contain all the rows in the folder s database table and also include  some data from another table     The examples below show what two different views look like in the same  folder  The folder in the examples is called Client  and it contains a number  of client rows  The first view contains all the rows in the folder s database  table organized by their client names  The second view contains only the  rows where the Client s state is Arizona  AZ      EE F mnm m l Ml MT             Two different views in the same Smeadlink folder    44 Chapter 3    Basic Smeadlink Concepts    This section will introduce you to the basic concepts for using Smeadlink  It  describes each of the different components in Smeadlink and explains how  they are typically used     As you learned in chapter 1  Smeadlink s database displays data in the form  of rows using a system based on a filing cabinet  It allows you to edit exist   ing rows or add new rows to any folder in any workgroup  You can also sort  
26.  a format   ted report  The Print Preview window will now appear as shown be   low  with a preview of what a printed report for the open view will  look like  The report in the example below is a basic report        Print Preview window    e If the report has multiple pages and you would like to see what the  other pages will look like  click the Next button at the bottom of the  Print Preview window until the desired page is displayed     e Once you are finished looking at the preview  click the Close button at  the bottom of the Print Preview window  The Print Preview window  will now be closed     Data Output from Smeadlink 115    4  Click the Print command on the File menu  The Print submenu will now  appear as shown below        Print submenu    5  Click the appropriate command on the Print submenu for the type of re   port you want to print     e For a basic report  click the Grid  All Rows  or Grid  Selected Rows   command  The Print window will now appear as shown below     e For a formatted report  click the Formatted Report  All Rows  or For   matted Report  Selected Rows  command  The Print window will now  appear as shown below     Note  If no formatted reports have been created for the open view  then the  Formatted Report command will be unavailable on the Print submenu        Print window    116    Chapter 7    6  Set the options on the Print window to the desired settings     e If you would like to print this report using a printer other than the  default prin
27.  and Comment options underneath Name will now  be filled in according to the fax machine you chose     120    Chapter 7    3  If you would like to adjust specific settings for the fax machine you chose  in step 2  click the Properties button to the right of the Name box     A properties window will now appear that you can use to adjust specific  settings on your fax machine  The exact appearance of the properties win   dow will vary depending on what type of fax management program you are  using  The example below shows what the RightFAX properties window  looks like  Once you have set the options on your properties window  click  the OK button to save your changes and close the window     AlephF ast Fae Puree  on PEAS Proerione Fi     Fro   nohia   Fete   Devon Odor    Paper ge Lote H lTi Ha       RightFAX properties window    4  If you would like your image documents to be faxed in landscape mode   check the Landscape option under Orientation     The image to the left of the two Orientation options will change to reflect  how the data will appear on each page of the fax     Note  The Size and Source options on the Print Setup window are not appli   cable to faxing images  so you can ignore these options     5  Click OK or press ENTER to save the setup information     The Print Setup window will now close and you will be finished with the fax  setup process     Data Output from Smeadlink 121    Faxing Images    Once you have gone through the fax setup process explained in th
28.  annotations  hold down the CTRL key  while you click the row selector of each annotation  Once you have the  selected the annotations to delete  press the DELETE key  A popup  message will now appear asking if you want to delete the selected  rows  Click the Yes button or press the ENTER key to delete the se   lected rows     View Redlining    The View Redlining button allows you to view any Redlining objects on the  current image in the Manual Indexing utility  Redlining objects are shapes   lines or text added to an image using the Redlining Edit Mode features  As  the name implies  these objects are all red  They are typically used for mak   ing notes on an image  or drawing attention to certain parts of an image     The View Redlining button works like a toggle switch  As long as it is acti   vated  you will be able to see all the Redlining objects that have been created  for the current image in the Manual Indexing utility  Once you deactivate it   however  you will no longer be able to see any Redlining objects  For more  information about the Redlining Edit Mode features  see the next section in  this chapter     246    Chapter 12    Magnify    The Magnify option allows you to zoom in on any part of the current image  in the Manual Indexing Viewer  It is useful for viewing portions of an image  that are otherwise too small to read  To activate the Magnify mode  simply  click the Magnify button on the toolbar  You will now need to locate the  area on the image that you
29.  are using a scan source   e Click the Modify command on the Scanning menu     e Select either Reprocess Disk Image or Rescan Image from the Scanner s  Modify menu     The document will now be processed according to the current rule settings   and it will replace the original version that was scanned  For more informa   tion  see the section Reviewing a Batch later in this chapter     Scanning and Viewing Images 183    Using the Scanner s Image Viewer    The Scanner s Image Viewer displays images of documents as they are  scanned in the Scanner program  and it can also be used to view images of  documents that were scanned in previous scanning sessions  Unlike  Smeadlink s Image Viewer  the Scanner s Image Viewer cannot be turned on  or off   it is always displayed in the Scanner window  This section will show  you how to use the Scanner s Image Viewer  The first part explains how to  adjust the position of the Image Viewer in the Scanner window  and the  second part explains how to use the different features on the Image Viewer s  toolbar     Adjusting the Position of the Image Viewer    The following instructions will show you how to adjust the position of the  Image Viewer in the Scanner program s window  You can use these instruc   tions to place the Image Viewer in the top  bottom  left or right side of the  Scanner s window     To adjust the position of the Image Viewer     1  Open the Tools menu and click the Options command     The Options window will now appear as sh
30.  assigned to the locked destination     7  Repeat steps 1   6 until you have scanned all the desired objects and desti   nations     8  To review your tracking session     e From the main menu  press the 2 button  The tracking list will now  appear     e Press F5 and F6 to scroll through the tracking list     e Once you have verified that the objects in the session were tracked  correctly  press the C button to return to the main menu     Tracking Smeadlink Objects 285    Uploading Tracking Information    The following instructions will show you how to upload tracking informa   tion from the Denso scanner to Smeadlink  There are two basic steps to up   loading tracking information  The first step is to create a Denso import in the  Import Wizard utility that specifies how to import the data  and the second  step is to run the Denso import  The following instructions explain both  steps     In order to upload tracking information from the Denso scanner  you will  need to use the Import Wizard utility  The Import Wizard is an administra   tive utility in Smeadlink  so your Smeadlink user name may not have access  rights for it  If this is the case  see your Smeadlink system administrator for  help     To create a Denso import   1  Open the Tools menu from Smeadlink s main menu bar     2  Click the Import command on the Tools menu  The Import submenu will  now appear     3  Click the Setup command on the Import submenu  The first Import Wiz   ard window will now appear as shown 
31.  basic troubleshooting for the  Smeadlink Scanner program  If you get an error while you are in the Scanner  program  try performing the steps explained in this section before calling  technical support  If these steps do not solve your problem  you can call  Smead Software Support at  800  800 6131  or you can contact your  Smeadlink reseller     There are several types of errors you can get while running the Scanner  program  The first type of error is called a GPF error  GPF stands for gen   eral protection fault  As the name implies  these are general errors that can  occur in any program  When you get a GPF error in the Scanner  you will  need to restart your computer and reopen the Scanner program  If you made  any changes that you did not save  you will lose the changes you made     The second type of error that may occur in the Scanner program is a  Smeadlink specific error  The example below shows whata typical Smeadlink  error looks like in the Scanner program     Smeadlink    A Eia  AA Comnmuncalion enor in Fundion Piai of     a    Typical Smeadlink error window       For errors similar to this example  press ENTER or click the OK button to  close the error window and then try the troubleshooting steps explained on  the following page     204    Chapter 10    To troubleshoot the Scanner program     1  The first step to try when you get a Smeadlink error in the Scanner pro   gram is to reset your Kofax engine  Resetting the Kofax engine  whether  you are using a Kof
32.  be automatically  selected  To indicate that the objects are selected  small  white squares will  appear at the corners of each object     3  Press the DELETE key on the keyboard  All the Redlining objects on the  current image will now be deleted     Using the Image Viewer 229    Saving Changes and Exiting Redlining Edit Mode    Once you have used the various Redlining buttons to edit an image  you will  probably want to save the changes you have made  This section will show  you how to save any Redlining changes that have been made to the image in  the active viewer window  This procedure will also exit Redlining Edit Mode     To save Redlining changes and to exit Redlining Edit Mode     e Simply select another option on the Mode submenu     There are three other options on the Mode submenu  These three are Mag   nify  Drag and Clip Rectangle To Clipboard  The four options on this  submenu are mutually exclusive  so only one option can be selected at a  time  After you select a different option in this toolbar group  any changes  you have made with the Redlining features will be saved     230 Chapter 12    12  Using the Manual Indexing Utility      E bor   M  2595 G40 tH Bit  LLEI       Chapter contents    Introduction   Opening the Manual Indexing Utility   Options on the Manual Indexing Utility s Toolbar  Using Redlining Edit Mode    Using the Manual Indexing Utility 231    Introduction    The previous chapter showed you how to use the Smeadlink Image Viewer   You learne
33.  box  The Tracking program has sev   eral features that make this process as easy as possible  The example below  shows what the Tracking program looks like     Se ee See HH Fi m       Introduction to Smeadlink 15    In addition to entering bar codes of objects and destinations in the Tracking  program  Smeadlink also allows you to enter object and destination bar codes  with a portable scanner  At the present time  Smeadlink supports the Denso  BHT 6000 portable scanner  which is a compact  lightweight unit  The ad   vantage of tracking objects with the Denso scanner is that you do not have to  be by your desk  Instead  you can track objects at the most convenient loca   tion  and then download the tracking information from the Denso scanner  into a computer with Smeadlink on it  The Import Wizard  which is a  Smeadlink administrative utility  is the tool you will use to download track   ing information from the Denso scanner into Smeadlink     Once you have entered an object and its destination into Smeadlink Track   ing  either with the Tracking program or the Denso scanner   then anyone  with access to Smeadlink can view the current location of that object  Track   ing information for objects in Smeadlink is displayed in an add on utility  called the Tracking Viewer  which is shown here     Tracking diagram    Bag LEE       a et ee       Tracking Viewer within Smeadlink    After you click the row of a Smeadlink object  the Tracking Viewer will  display the tracking status
34.  col   umn heading  name  or ID number  Finally  Smeadlink allows you to export  data from any folder to a standard  comma delimited text file  You can then  import Smeadlink data into other programs such as Microsoft   Word or  Excel     Name of open workgroup    Paras WEA       Folders in open workgroup    12    Chapter 1    Imaging Module    The Smeadlink Imaging module includes the Scanner program and two add on  utilities for Smeadlink  The purpose of the Imaging module is to give mul   tiple users easy access to a large number of documents  The Scanner pro   gram allows you to scan images of both paper and electronic documents   and then attach the images to rows in Smeadlink or leave them unattached   You can then use the Imaging add on utilities in Smeadlink to view both  attached and unattached images     The main component in the Imaging module is the Scanner program  The  role of the Scanner program is to scan images of paper or electronic docu   ments  and attach these images to rows in Smeadlink  The Scanner program  can scan images of electronic documents on its own  and images of paper  documents when used with a scanner  Any image that you scan with the  Scanner program can be viewed in the Scanner s image viewer  If you find  that an image was not scanned correctly  you can rescan the original docu   ment and the new  correct image will be saved in place of the old one  The  example below shows what the Scanner program looks like     i he p  yra Mim meis     
35.  consider the box to be the object and the shelf to be the  destination  Tracking uses an internal hierarchy to determine which items  can be used as containers     Basic Tracking concepts    As you learned in chapter 1  the main purpose of Smeadlink Tracking is to  monitor the locations of physical objects  Tracking uses bar codes to moni   tor the location of each object and its current destination  In order to track  objects with Smeadlink Tracking  there needs to be a row for the object and  a row for the object s destination in Smeadlink     Objects are assigned to destinations in the Tracking program or the Denso  BHT 6000 portable scanner  Using the example above  suppose you want to  use Smeadlink Tracking to monitor the location of a file folder that you just  put into a box  Since the box is close to your Smeadlink workstation  you  want to use the Tracking program instead of the Denso scanner     After opening the Tracking program  the first step is to enter the bar code of  the destination  In this case the destination is a box  so you enter the box s  bar code in the destination section of the Tracking window  The next step is  to enter the bar code of the object you want to track  In this case the object is  a file folder  so you enter the folder s bar code in the object section of the  Tracking window  The example on the following page shows what the des   tination and object sections look like on the Tracking window     262 Chapter 13       e tee ob files mis 
36.  different  folder setup than the typical parent child relationship  In a typical parent   child relationship  the child folder can only be accessed by going through  the parent folder  so it will never display all the rows it contains at once   Instead  when the child folder opens  it will only display the rows it contains  that are attached to the parent row it was opened from     Because a dropdown column allows you to do everything related to creating  and attaching child rows from the child folder  it is most helpful when the  child folder displays all the rows it contains  not just a selected group of  rows that have the same parent  Child folders can easily be set up in this way  using the Database Map utility  which is an administrative utility in Smeadlink   Once a child folder has been setup for dropdowns  then the name and icon of  the folder will be displayed on the Navigation Bar  just like it is for standard  folders  When you open the child folder from the Navigation Bar  you will  then see all the rows it contains  This section will show you how to work  with dropdowns     Editing Rows in Smeadlink 101    Attaching and Adding Rows with Dropdowns    A dropdown is a column in a folder that meets two conditions   e it contains data from a column in one of the folder s parent folders    e it can be used to attach rows in the folder to rows in the parent folder it  contains data from    To quickly verify whether or not a column is a dropdown  simply click in  one o
37.  ee ee LLE  ss i ee ae  veer FSI       About window    The version number of your Smeadlink system is displayed at the bottom of  the About window  The registration information for your Smeadlink system is  displayed in the middle     36 Chapter 2    Exiting a Smeadlink Program    There are two ways to exit a Smeadlink program and return to Windows   Both methods are explained below  You can use these methods to exit any  Smeadlink program  whether it is an end user program of an adminis   trative utility     To exit a Smeadlink program   1  Open the File menu from the program s menu bar     2  Click the Exit command at the bottom of the File menu  The program will  now close     OR    e Click the Close  X  button in the upper right corner of the program s win   dow  The example below shows what the Close button looks like on a  Smeadlink program s window     Close button 7       Introduction to Smeadlink 37    3  Introduction to Smeadlink       Chapter contents  Introduction  Basic Smeadlink Terms  Basic Smeadlink Concepts    38 Chapter 3    Introduction    The first two chapters in this manual introduced you to the end user mod   ules in your Smeadlink system  and showed you how to open a Smeadlink  program  The information covered in these chapters is general information   so it applies to all the end user modules in your system     The remaining chapters in this manual will show you how to use each end   user module that is available in Smeadlink  The chapters are divided
38.  eirese rise seeroete baths ecco teres 68  Adjusting the Size of Rows in a View eseese 69  Sorting ROWS 11a  VIEW s vccscsiesesiesspaceasece besa cnssdubeveacesavecouedeaeues 70  Using Jump To to Locate a ROW       ccecceeeecceseeeeereeeeeteeeeeeeeees 74    Using Find to Locate Rows in a View       e eeceeseeseereeeeeeeeteeees 77    20    37    53      67    iv Contents       Freezing Columns 1n a VIEW sscsssssresesisseresrosiisssrerssisresreses rosteru 19  Moving Columns 1n a VieW 0     eceecsessesececeeeeeseceeeecerenaeaeees 81  Filtering ROWS in a VieW          scssceecsesseeeseseesececeecesesaeeerenesaeseees 82  Reloading  VIEW at    2tepthcttostssstearesdessiadtcds iiadel astusevelen iiss 91  Viewing General Information for a View    n    92   6  Editing Rows in Smead link              ccssccccsssccccsscsssssscssssssesseees I3  TREO AUC HOM goss tse ssidecs ots shdestustith raat voice Pees Vaere EErEE PEATEs 94  Editing Existing ROWS               escsesstesssseserseessenersesotensesesonsnses 95  Adding Rows t0 a VIEW       c s   csccseseseeseneosepeosesenstpeesteeeseseosens 97  Working with Dropdown           ecceseeseeeceeeneeeeeeeeneceeseneeeneeates 99  Deleting ROWS x4 sseteieertGetvcicestin tbctesdesibectren ini beens eben tees 104  Refreshing ROWS  sasc  sicctenccsteseish ten evi evavsetbenestiseseuacsasuee maces 106   7  Data Output from Smead link      se sseossoossooesosssssesssesssoossoosssos 107  TACO QUC HOM s eer ipe eano selfestesasiieleieia stig slant  108
39.  following page  The About Kofax window  summarizes the Kofax information on your machine  There are two main  sections in the About Kofax window  Sources and Module Revisions  The  Sources section lists what Kofax devices have been configured on your com     Working with Scanner Rules 153       Heres TAGE     Two FEID   FD  1g BAE Corepaerren  leper  i  14  LD aige BS Jea Dran ie  125  Men HFT bapi HJE farri Den wa C21                            About Kofax window    puter and what Kofax engines are available  and the Module Revisions  section lists the modules that make up your Kofax software and their ver   sion numbers     There are no more options on the Sources submenu  The next part of this  section will explain the options that are available on the Documents sub   menu     154    Chapter 9    Options on the Documents Submenu       Documents submenu    Default LinkScript    Clicking the Default LinkScript option on the Documents submenu will bring  up the Select Default LinkScript window shown below        Select Default LinkScript window    The purpose of the Select Default LinkScript window is to specify which  LinkScript will be used by the current rule  A LinkScript is a custom script  that defines how the Scanner will attach scanned images to Smeadlink rows   Typically  LinkScripts use the bar codes from scanned images to connect the  images to existing Smeadlink rows  LinkScripts can also create new Smeadlink  rows and attach scanned images to these new rows  Ifa
40.  have the  Scanner remember the newest batch that was created  The newest batch is  the last batch that was created  not necessarily the last batch that you scanned  documents in  When this option is selected  each time you open the Scanner  it will automatically open the newest batch for you  This means that the  records grid  Image Viewer and rule settings will be exactly the same as they  were when you last worked with the newest batch     To enable Load Last Batch   e Open the Tools menu and click the Options command     The Options window will now appear  The Scanner folder will auto   matically be opened in the Options window     e Select the Load Last Batch on Scanner Startup option in the Scanner  folder     Working with Scanner Rules 149    Extending a Rule    The first section of this chapter showed you how to create a basic rule in the  Smeadlink Scanner  A basic rule only sets the options that are required by  the Scanner to define a rule  so any images scanned with this rule will not be  modified as they are scanned  and they will all be orphans that are not at   tached to any existing rows     This section will show you how to set the options that are available in the  Scanner for modifying images as they are scanned and for attaching them to  rows in Smeadlink  These options are all contained on the Scanning menu   in the Sources  Documents  Input Output and Image Processing submenus   The options on these submenus that are required by the Scanner to define a  
41.  in the database   one copy could display an Employees folder and another copy could display  a Purchase Orders folder  You could also display the same folder in all three  copies  because they are not mutually exclusive  Each open copy retains all  the original functionality of Smeadlink  The following instructions will show  you how to open multiple copies of Smeadlink  The instructions assume that  at least one copy of Smeadlink is currently open     To open multiple copies of Smeadlink     1  Open the Go menu from Smeadlink s menu bar  and then click the  Smeadlink command at the top of the Go menu     The Smeadlink submenu will now appear  If only one copy of Smeadlink is  currently open  then the submenu will contain one command called New  Smeadlink  If multiple copies of Smeadlink are already open  then the sub   menu will contain the New Smeadlink command and a list of the other open  copies  The copies will be called Smeadlink 1  Smeadlink 2  etc     Clicking the name of an existing copy on Smeadlink submenu will activate  the selected copy and deactivate the other open Smeadlink copies  The ex   ample below shows what the Smeadlink submenu looks like when three copies  of Smeadlink are open  and the submenu is opened from the third copy     2  Click the New Smeadlink command on the Smeadlink submenu     Go  SER ew soon    By Scenrer i Cie Sreadink 1  INE Ber Code Trading   CtrHK Sreedirk 2    1 Records   2 Tracking   3 Mantenance  4H   Sp   6 Correspondence       2
42.  individual files in the directory  click the desired files with the  left mouse button  The files will turn blue after you have clicked on  them to indicate that they will be processed by the Scanner once you  start the scanning process     If you accidentally select the wrong files  you can click on the Clear  All button below the image file list to deselect all files  If you want to  select all the files displayed in the list  click the Select All button  Fi   nally  if you want the Scanner program to delete files after they have  been scanned  check the Remove Files After Processing option  Once  you have set the options on the Disk Source Input Settings window to  the desired settings  press ENTER or click the OK button     3  If an existing batch is currently open  you now have the option to con   tinue scanning documents into the current batch or to clear the current batch  and start a new one  If you clear the current batch  the Scanner will clear its  records grid and its image viewer     e To clear the Scanner s records grid and image viewer if a batch is  currently open  click the Scan command on the Scanning menu  Now  click the New Batch command on the Scan submenu     e If you want to continue scanning documents into the current batch   you do not have to do anything  Once you start the scanning process   the Scanner will add a record for each new document you scan to the  existing records in the records grid and it will display the new images  in the Image View
43.  initials or your actual name     282 Chapter 14    To enter your operator name     e Use the BS  backspace  button to clear the existing name  if one ap   pears     e Enter the desired characters for your operator name  For each charac   ter  press the M1 button one to three times depending on the position  of the character above its number button  i e  left  right or center    When you click the M1 button for the last time  hold it and press the  number button for the desired character     5  Press the ENT button after you have entered your operator name  This  will send you back to the main Smeadlink menu     Tracking Objects with the Denso Scanner    The following instructions will show you how to track objects with the Denso  scanner  You will learn how to assign both single and multiple objects to a  destination  and how to review your tracking session after you finish assign   ing objects to destinations  You will also learn how to enter due back dates  and prefixes or suffixes in the Denso scanner     Note  You will need to start the Denso scanner as explained in the previous  part of this section before you can begin using it to track objects   To track objects     1  If you would like to assign multiple objects to the first destination  then  you will need to enable the lock destination feature  To enable lock destina   tion     e From the main menu  press the 6 button  The Options menu will now  appear     e From the Options menu  press the 1 button  The lock or un
44.  into  sections of several chapters each  and each section explains one module   The first chapter in each section explains the basic information you should  know before you begin using the module  and the remaining chapters walk  you through the different components in the module and the tasks they were  intended for     If you are familiar with earlier versions of Smeadlink  then you may just  want to skim this chapter and go to Chapter 4  If you have not used Smeadlink  before  then reading this chapter should give you a good basic understand   ing of how it works     Note  For a summary of your Smeadlink system  see the sections Smeadlink  Start Up Screen and About Your Smeadlink System in Chapter 1 of this  manual     Introduction to Smeadlink 39    Basic Smeadlink Terms    This section will introduce you to the names of the basic components in  Smeadlink   Some of these terms are new to Smeadlink  even though the  components they refer to are very similar to components in earlier versions     Folder    As you learned in Chapter 1  Smeadlink displays data in a system modeled  after a standard filing cabinet  The main component in Smeadlink s organi   zation system is the folder  A folder in the Smeadlink is very similar to a  folder in a physical filing cabinet  Each folder in Smeadlink contains a group  of related rows of data  and it may also contain one or more subfolders     When a folder contains one or more subfolders  the folder is often referred  to as a parent f
45.  is located at the bottom left hand side of the open screen  If  the Find utility and the Jump To utility are both open at the same time  two  tabs will be available to switch between them  The Find utility consists of a  box for entering data  a box for selecting the column to search through  an  option to start the search automatically and a button to manually start the  search  The example below shows what the main features on the Find  utility look like        Seach   x  Fad lup Ta    Fin      Iry   Chant Nama v  F AgoFid    Frd Nom      The next group of utilities in Smeadlink provides several ways for you to  export data from an open folder or subfolder  First  you can print out a  report for the data in the folder or subfolder  There are two kinds of reports  you can print from Smeadlink  basic reports and formatted reports  Basic  reports are not adjustable in any way   they have a title bar at the top with  the names of the open view and the open database  followed by the selected  data in the open folder or subfolder  In contrast  formatted reports can be  customized in many ways  You can specify the text in the report s header  and footer  you can specify whether or not you want to print images in the  report and you can specify the colors of the different items on the report  to  name a few things     In addition to printing reports  you can also use a feature called Export to  export data from the open folder or subfolder into a standard  comma delim   ited text 
46.  menu when that user logs into Smeadlink   Once an add in is selected  the corresponding program or file will be opened   If the selected add in was for a program  then that program will be opened in  its default mode  if the selected add in was for a file  then that file will be  opened in the appropriate program and if the add in was for a web page  then  that web page will be opened in your default browser  This section will show  you how to open an add in     Note  If no add ins have been created for the open database  then the Add   Ins menu will not be visible in Smeadlink programs  This section assumes  that at least one add in has been created for the open database     To open an add in from a Smeadlink program   1  Open the Add Ins menu from the program s menu bar     The Add Ins menu lists all the add ins that have been created for the open  database  The number of commands on the menu  and the name of each  command  will vary from system to system  The example below shows what  a typical Add Ins menu looks like  The menu in the example contains four  add ins  starting with one called Auction Info     Add Ins    Auction Info   F2 Pagemaker 6 5  ee Outlook Express    l Acrobat        Add Ins menu    2  Click the desired command on the Add Ins menu     Opening a Smeadlink Program 33    Using Smeadlink Help    Selecting Help from the menu bar of any Smeadlink program will bring up  the menu shown below     Help  User Manual  System Manual    About Smeadiink    Help men
47.  move to the row beneath the  edited row     e Click on another row in the open view     After you use one of the methods above to save your row  the pencil at the  left of the row will disappear to let you know that your changes have been  saved     5  If you would like to edit any other rows in the open view  you can edit  them now with the same procedure you used to edit the first row  Remember  to save each row after you edit it     Note  There are three types of columns that you will not be able to edit using  the procedure explained in this section  i e  clicking in one of the column s  cells and typing in the desired information   These are columns that have  had their Editable option turned off by your Smeadlink system administra   tor  columns that are dropdowns and columns that are lookups  If you need  to edit a column that is currently not editable  see your Smeadlink system  administrator  If you need to edit a dropdown or lookup column  see the  section Working with Dropdowns later in this chapter    Editing Rows in Smeadlink 97    Adding Rows to a View    This section will show you how to add one or more rows to a view in Smeadlink   You can use the information in this section to add rows to any view in the  open Smeadlink database  including views in both folders and subfolders     To add one or more rows to the open view     1  Activate add mode for the open view  This can be done in one of two  ways     e Click the New button on the toolbar  This will popup 
48.  of that object  The Tracking Viewer displays track   ing status using a diagram that looks like an outline   This diagram is shown  in the example above   it is located in the upper left corner of the Tracking  Viewer window   The tracking diagram places objects under destinations   and it can have multiple levels depending on the tracking hierarchy set up in  your Smeadlink database and the destination of the selected object  The name  of each destination or object in the tracking diagram is displayed at the right  of its folder s icon     16    Chapter 1    In addition to viewing the tracking status of an item  the Tracking Viewer  also allows you to view two different reports for the items in the tracking  diagram  The Contents report displays all the objects that have been assigned  to an item  and the History report displays all the different destinations that  an item has been assigned to  The example shows what the History report  looks like     CELETTE  Emire B   biim    E amen Criar Fir Soe  SS Pei  fepeee ih E nagn em  leiam a ee       Tracking Status History Report    The last component in the Tracking module is the Past Due Tracked Objects  report  This is another add on utility for Smeadlink  and it works with the  Tracking program to monitor objects that have been temporarily removed  from their permanent locations  For instance  suppose you remove a folder  from a shelf in the filing room  The shelf is the permanent location of the  folder  but it is now tempo
49.  on  scanned images  The Scanner program accomplishes these tasks by process   ing scanned images with one or more image filters  The actual edge en   hancement that is performed on the images depends on which filter or filters  you have selected     If you would like the Scanner program to perform edge enhancement on  images that you scan  check the Enable option at the top of the Image Filter  Properties window  Now click on the filters in the list under the Enable op   tion that you want the Scanner to process your images with  The filters will  turn blue when you click on them to indicate that they have been selected   You can select any group of filters from the list  Select the filters according  to the guidelines below  Once you have selected the filters that you want the  Scanner program to process your image with  press ENTER or click the OK  button to save your changes        The Character Smoothing filter always increases the quality of scanned  images  This filter can be used together with any other image filters        The Smooth and Clean filter should be used with deshading  despeckling  and line removal  It further enhances images that have been modified  with these features  but it is not meant as a replacement for any of  these other features     170    Chapter 9    e The Smooth  Clean and Preserve filter works like the Smooth and Clean  filter except that it preserves horizontal and vertical black line seg   ments that are one pixel wide     e The Thinning 
50.  on each label   and how the information will be positioned on the label  If you are unsure which  design to select  check with your Smeadlink system administrator     5  If you would like the labels to be printed on a different type of stock than the stock  specified in the design  then select the desired label stock now  To select a stock type     e Click the down arrow at the right of the Stock box  to display a list of available  stock types     e Click the desired stock type on the list     If you would like to make the new stock type the default type for the selected label  design  click the Set to Default button under the Stock box     126    Chapter 7    6  The next option on the Smeadlink Label Printer window is Start Printing  with Label  This option is only applicable if the specified stock type con   tains multiple labels on each page  If you specified a stock type that contains  multiple labels on each page  then you can use the Start Printing with Label  option to avoid wasting label stock     For instance  the stock type Avery 5160 Address 3 Up contains three col   umns of ten labels on each page  If you printed five labels with this stock it  would take one page  but the page would still have 25 blank labels left on it  after you printed and removed the five labels you wanted  To avoid wasting  the 25 unused labels on the page  you could reinsert the page into your printer  and then set the Start Printing with Label option to 6  Next time you needed  to print 
51.  on the Print window     3  Click the OK button in the lower right corner of the Print window  The  Past Due Tracked Objects report will now be printed according to the cur   rent settings on the Print window     To export the Past Due Tracked Objects report     1  Click the Export button at the bottom of the Contents window  A window  will now appear asking if you would like to export the rows in the Contents  report     2  Click the Yes button on the window     3  Now go to the section called Exporting a Records Grid in chapter 7 of this  manual  Go directly to step 4 in the section  and continue from there  The  remaining steps will walk you through the export process     Introduction to Retention    313    16  Introduction to Retention    Eetentio Cede Minh ennce    INT    I5   Act    ACDOUWTING  AKAL SLE Date Pr  ACDOURTING   CAPITAL PROPERTY  ACTOUNTING   SEMEFRAL    ADMIN TRATION    ADMIN TRATION    ADAM FST PLA TID      ADMIHE TRATION    ADIN ET LATION    SDHIHG T RATION    ADMISE T RATIOR    ADMIMES TFLATION      ADMIHE TRATION    ADMIME TRACTION      INTERNAL SERVICES  PLANKING FORCAS TING  PROPERAT  HAMSI HENT  FROFEATT HAMAGEHENT COWS TF  POWOE SPA OCD AES   POLICIES PROCEDURES AUNTS   POUDES PAOCEO UAES COMPLIAt  SECURITY   GENERAL   GEKE Rad  CHA DKCLOQICAL FLES    ERMA UNHEHT   TESTING  ERMIR OKHEHT  HATMA DOLS SUES TANCES    Sun Re  iia TARA A ee amna P      H   Edt   Bea         Chapter contents    Introduction   Retention Concepts   Using Retention Codes  Us
52.  or images  This  section will walk you through the print setup process in Smeadlink  If you  will be printing both reports and images  then you will need to go through  this process twice   once for each type of print document     To perform print setup     1  Open the appropriate print setup window  To open the print setup win   dow     e Click the Print Setup command on the File menu  The Print Setup  submenu will now appear as shown in the example below           Fie  GS DrenDeisbee   ie  Chae Database  i Pini F  Print Prewiees    D ausan 29 Fo Sette Foon orien   od Bo ere For  mage Printing     cha Fare Setup   Epot    Ei    Print Setup submenu    e Click the command in the Printer Setup submenu that corresponds with the  type of document you are setting up a printer for     The Print Setup window will now appear  The example on the following  page shows what the Print Setup window looks like     Chapter 7    Prt Saup       Print Setup window    2  The first option on the Print Setup window is Name  This option deter   mines which printer will be used to print either reports or images  To select  a printer     e Click the down arrow at the right of the Name box to display a list of  printers that are available on your computer     e Click the name of the desired printer to select it  The Status  Type   Where and Comment options underneath Name will now be filled in  according to the printer you chose     3  If you would like to adjust printer specific settings for the pr
53.  rule does not specify  a LinkScript  then any images scanned with the rule will be scanned as or   phans     LinkScripts are customized for each Smeadlink system using the Indexing  Wizard  so their exact capabilities will be different from one to the next  A  standard Smeadlink system will not come with any LinkScripts  so the sys   tem administrator  or the technician who installs your system  will need to  run the Indexing Wizard to create one if desired     To select the LinkScript that will be used by the current rule  click the down  arrow at the right of the Default Script box  All the available LinkScripts in  the open Smeadlink database will now be listed in a dropdown menu  Click  on the desired LinkScript to select it  and then press ENTER or click the  OK button to close the Select Default LinkScript window     Working with Scanner Rules 155    New Document Rule    Selecting the New Document Rule option on the Documents submenu will  bring up the submenu shown below        New Document Rule submenu  The New Document Rule options allow you to define a document in the  Scanner program  A document in the Scanner is similar to a paper docu   ment  It can be one page  like a purchase order  or multiple pages  like a  long letter  When a multiple page paper document is scanned  it becomes a  multiple image Scanner document  The Scanner attaches documents  not  just single images  to Smeadlink rows  so if you have multiple page docu   ments you will have rows in Smeadli
54.  state  If you have magnified the image in  the active viewer window and you would like to return it to its original size   click the Fit to Viewer option  The magnified image will now be resized so  that it fits entirely in the viewer window     Zoom   Fit to Width    The Fit to Width option  on the Zoom submenu  allows you to resize the  image in the active viewer window so that the width of the image takes up  the entire width of the viewer window  Fit to Width works the same with  both magnified and unmagnified images  To resize the image in the active  viewer window so that it takes up the entire width of the viewer  click the  Fit to Width option once     Zoom   25   50   75        The Zoom options on the Zoom submenu allows you to resize the entire  image in the active viewer window  This is different than the Magnify but   ton  which only allows you to resize a certain part of an image  The Zoom  feature is also different than the Magnify button because it allows you to  shrink an image as well as enlarge it  To resize the image in the active  viewer window using Zoom  choose one of the magnification options listed  on the submenu     Using the Image Viewer 213    Each percentage in the Zoom dropdown is relative to the size of the origi   nal document  So if you select 100   for instance  you could view the docu   ment at the size it was originally scanned  Now click one of the percentage  options in the Zoom dropdown  Once you click a percentage  the image in  the ac
55.  systems that do not have to scan  very many images  However  for scanning large numbers of images  requir   ing someone to enter information for each image becomes very tedious and  time consuming  To eliminate the need for user interaction during the scan   ning process  most larger Imaging systems use separator sheets for entering  LinkScript information  A separator sheet is a sheet of paper with one or  more bar codes printed on it  The bar codes on the separator sheet contain  the information that the LinkScript needs to process the following image     Note  Although many rules specify a LinkScript for attaching images to rows   this is not always the case  When you scan images with a rule that does not  specify a LinkScript  the images are scanned in as orphans  They can then  be manually attached to rows with the Manual Indexing Viewer utility     Introduction to Smeadlink Imaging 133    Once you have specified a rule  then you can begin scanning your docu   ments  As the documents are scanned  they will be processed according to  the rule that is currently selected  A row will be created for each document in  the Scanner s records grid  and the document s image will be displayed in  the Scanner s Image Viewer  The example below shows what the Image  Viewer and records grid look like in the Scanner program        T lemmi berein d    lh ir bb   kye pis ymi jiy   arroi i  gt T  riaan s  Shes ae ae     ee eo ee h F i     a 7     ie a i   a   il   ak     re   Faa pa      
56.  that best matches  the data you entered  Continue entering data until Find locates the correct  row     Note  You can have Find wait until after you have entered all data to begin  searching  To do so  un check the Auto Find check box just below the  In   dropdown menu  Now enter your data into the Find box  Once your data  has been entered  click the Find Now button to start the searching process     3  If you would like to close the Find utility after using it  to make more  space on the screen for displaying the contents of the open folder or sub   folder  click the  X  at the top right hand corner of the Search Bar     Viewing Rows in Smeadlink 79    Freezing Columns in a View    Each view in Smeadlink can have any number of columns  However  depend   ing on the number and width of the columns in a view  you may not be able to  see all the columns at once  In views with either a large number of columns or  with very wide columns  you will need to use the horizontal scroll bar to see  all the different columns in the view  When you are using the horizontal scroll  bar to scroll from one side of a view to the other  there may be one or two  columns that you want to keep visible at all times  Smeadlink has a feature  called Freeze that allows you to do just that     Typically  Freeze is used on the column or columns that best identify the  rows in the view  For instance  in a view that contains customer rows  you  may want to freeze the Customer Name column  This way  if yo
57.  the  Clip Rectangle To Clipboard button  The four buttons in this toolbar group  are mutually exclusive  so only button can be selected at a time  After you  select a different button in this toolbar group  the Redlining section will be  removed from the toolbar  any changes you have made with the Redlining  features will be saved and the Redlining button will be deselected     Introduction to Tracking    259    13  Introduction to Tracking    Pokey Fobie 1  Tons bryg ere armi  EI Pokies Priim I  beeen Braiens    E  Pubie Psie T   emahin Pangei    ZI epee bp ee ioe 1E  ee Piim IU L miai Epari  Z  Fobie Piim 11 Laimi i perinpinms          Chapter contents  Introduction    Tracking Terms and Concepts    Tracking Requirements    260 Chapter 13    Introduction    The previous chapter concluded the Imaging section of this manual  The  next three chapters will show you how to use the Smeadlink Tracking mod   ule  This chapter will introduce you to Smeadlink Tracking  chapter 14 will  show you how to track objects with the Tracking program or the Denso  portable scanner and chapter 15 will show you how to view the tracking  status of items in Smeadlink     As you learned in chapter 1  the Smeadlink Tracking module includes the  Tracking program and several add on utilities for the Smeadlink program   The purpose of the Tracking module is to help you monitor the location of  physical objects like folders or boxes  If you are already familiar with  Smeadlink Tracking  then you may wa
58.  the Tracking Status of an Object    295  Viewing the Contents of a Destination          ccceeeeeeeereeeeeee 296  Tracking Viewer Submenu             esceeceseeceeceeeeceeeeseeerensesenee 297  Viewing the History of an Object oes eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeens 301  Setting up and using additional tracking properties              304    Using the Tracking Requestor           c cececseseeeeereeneeeeerereeeeees 307    vi Contents    Running the Past Due Tracked Objects Report               0 309  16  Introduction to Retention              ssssccsscssscssssesssessssssssseees OLS  Tinto Gu cti  th TANEN E E eteazt EEE Siahedi sve doth 314  Retentions Concepts siiin aroei EE 315  Using Retention Codes         ccceeccesseeseesseeseeeeeeseeeeeeseeesecseenaes 316  Using Citation Codes sicsiccccssesetetens in etets eavinsen des cteneeecsesnceeees 318  Using Destruction Reports           ccccccceseceeceteeeeeeseeteeeteeeeeeseens 320  Enabling Retention for Smeadlink Folders 0 0    ee eeeeeeee 322  17  Usmo PC Dies cicscisctesscrccinineustearmiienttineninnanniunuaws 023  TMEEO GUC EON AEE T sucnteoeapendexssssveemtrasenceens 324  PC Files  Concept  i  iesc dcs seis ccssesiereviediesescuteeesseecaeeiaiin dias 325  Indexing a Document c e aeii 330  Indexing Multiple Documents with one LinkScript                333  Indexing Multiple Documents with Multiple LinkScripts       337  Viewing a PC Files Document in Smeadlink         eee 341  Using iAccess and 1Publish on    ee eeceeceseerceeseeneen
59.  the desired setting for each op   tion in the appropriate box     Working with Scanner Rules 161    Note  Both the Top and Left options in the Text Definition section are speci   fied in pixels  The scanner you are using will determine how many pixels are  in one inch  For instance  if your scanner scans at 200 DPI your images will  have 200 pixels in one inch     The Font Setting section determines the font type and orientation of the text  string  Click the down arrow at the right of each box to display the available  options  Click again on the desired option to select it     After you have specified a text prefix and determined how the text string  will appear on the page  the next step is to specify how the counter will  operate  In the Counter Start section  enter the number you want the counter  to start at in the Starting Number box  The Digit box determines how many  digits will be in the counter  For example  if you set Digit to 4 your counter  will be four digits long  0001  0002  etc    Check the Skip First Patch code  option if you want the first patch code designated to increment or reset the  counter to be ignored     The Counter Increment options determine when the Smeadlink Scanner will  increment the counter  The Increment Value setting determines how much  the counter value increases each time it is incremented  For example  if you  set Increment Value to 1 the counter could count 1  2  3  4  etc  You can have  the counter incremented after a specified num
60.  want to zoom in on and make a box around it  To  make the box  follow the steps below     e Click the upper left corner of the area on the image that you want to  zoom in on     e Drag the mouse pointer down and to the right so that a box is made that  contains the desired area     e Once the box encloses the area you want to magnify  let go of the  mouse button  The area in the box will now be enlarged to fill the  entire image viewer window     Note  Once you have magnified an area in an image  you can return the  image to its original size by clicking the Fill Viewer with Image button on  the toolbar     Drag    The Drag option allows you to move a magnified image around in the Manual  Indexing utility  This feature only works on magnified images  because nor   mal images are already entirely displayed in the image viewer window  To  activate Drag mode  click the Drag button on the toolbar  Once Drag mode  has been activated  move the mouse pointer over the image viewer window   press and hold the left mouse button and drag the mouse in the direction you  want the image to move     Clip Rectangle to Clipboard    The Clip Rectangle to Clipboard button allows you to copy any part of the  image document in the Manual Indexing utility to the Windows Clipboard   You can then paste the image data into another program such as Microsoft  Word  To copy part of the image document in the active viewer window to  the Windows Clipboard  click the Clip Rectangle to Clipboard button  No
61.  will show you  how to assign single and multiple objects to a destination in the Tracking  program     Each destination in Smeadlink Tracking can have a status of In or Out  A  destination with In status is a permanent destination  and a destination with  Out status is a temporary destination  For instance  in a library books are  stored on shelves  The permanent destination of any book in the library is  one of the library s shelves  A book may be checked out by someone  or it  may be in a book return somewhere  but it will eventually be put back onto  its shelf     The shelf in this example is a destination that would have In status  and the  person that checked out the book and the book return are destinations that  would have Out status  When you assign an object to a destination that has  Out status  you will need to assign a due back date for the object  The due  back date is the date that the object needs to be returned to its permanent  destination  The example below shows what the Object Due Back Date fea   ture looks like in the Tracking program       E he eo A ee m                Pies Qe eee See AGP       Object Due Back Date feature  in the Smeadlink Tracking program    264    Chapter 13    Once you have used the Tracking program to assign due back dates for ob   jects with Out destinations  then you can run the Past Due Tracked Objects  report from the Tracking program or the start up screen  This report will  display each object that has not been returned to it
62.  window shown below     flack Border Propertiee  ena             F Enana  M Crop    White Hose Gapipasit  5      Black Border Properties window             The options on the Black Border Properties window allow the Scanner to  remove black borders from scanned images  Black borders sometimes ap   pear on images as a result of capturing images with scanners that have black  drums or belts  You can remove black borders with black border removal or  black border cropping  Black border removal removes a black border by  changing all the border pixels to white  This removes the black border and  preserves the original size of the image  Black border cropping removes a  black border by removing all the pixels in the border  This reduces the height  and width of the image by the size of the black border     The Scanner removes a black border by starting from the outside edges and  working its way in  It uses the White Noise Gap setting to determine what  part of the page is black border and what part is the actual image informa   tion  White noise is any number of white pixels that occur in the border  If  the Scanner encounters a series of white pixels that is greater then the White  Noise Gap setting  it will assume that it has found the start of the actual  image information and it will stop removing the black border  If the Scanner  encounters a series of white pixels that is less than the White Noise Gap  setting  the Scanner will assume the pixels are white noise and it will 
63. Annotations window will appear as shown below        EEH BSG IE H S Ph   Tey e oie Yee    Smeadlink Annotations window    Using the Manual Indexing Utility 245    As you can see in the example on the previous page  the Smeadlink Annota   tions window contains three columns  Date Time  Memo and Author  The  Date Time column lists the date and time each annotation was created  or  last modified   the Memo column contains the actual text of each annotation  and the Author column lists the user name of the person who made each  annotation  or last modified it      The annotations in the Smeadlink Annotations window form a records grid   that works just like the records grid in a standard layout     e To create a new annotation  simply click in the Memo cell of the blank  annotation at the bottom of the records grid  and type the desired text  for the annotation  Once you have finished typing  save the new anno   tation by clicking a different annotation in the records grid  The  Date Time cell and the Operator cell of the new annotation will be  filled in automatically once it is saved     To edit an existing annotation  click in the Memo cell of the desired  annotation  and then edit the existing text as desired  Once you have  finished editing the text  save your changes by clicking a different  annotation in the records grid  The Date Time cell and the Operator  cell of the edited annotation will be filled in automatically once it is  saved     e To delete one or more existing
64. EM o o i  EI fecais  Domm          View Settings submenu    3  Click the Reload View command on the View Settings submenu     The open view will now be restored to the state it was in when it was last  saved  Any temporary changes that have been made to the view like filters   sorts or frozen columns will be discarded     92 Chapter 5    Viewing General Information for a View    The Information command on the View menu allows you to view basic in   formation about the open view  For instance  you can see the SQL statement  used to display rows in the view  and you can see the available indexes in the  view  This information is sometimes helpful for basic troubleshooting     To view information about the open view   1  Open the View menu from Smeadlink s main menu bar   2  Click the Information command at the bottom of the View menu     A Smeadlink window will now appear that displays information about the  open view  The example below shows what the view information window  looks like        View information window    Editing Rows in Smeadlink    6  Editing Rows in Smeadlink    et Die bee    Chapter contents    Introduction   Editing Existing Rows  Adding Rows to a View  Working with Dropdowns  Deleting Rows  Refreshing Rows       93    94 Chapter 6    Introduction    The previous chapter showed you how to use the features in Smeadlink for  viewing rows  You learned how to resize the rows in a view either horizon   tally or vertically  how to organize rows using primary and s
65. Fax Image    The Fax Image option is similar to the Print Image button   it works ex   actly like the Fax Image command on the Printing menu  When an image is  in the active viewer window  clicking the Fax Image option will start the  process for faxing that image  For step by step instructions about the pro   cess for faxing an image document in Smeadlink  see the section called  Faxing an Image in chapter 7     Image Information    The Image Information feature allows you to view the name  location and  scanning information of the image in the active viewer window     Using the Image Viewer 215    Copy to Clipboard    The Copy to Clipboard option allows you to copy the entire image in the  active viewer window to the Windows Clipboard  You can then paste the  image into another program such as Microsoft Word  Copy to Clipboard  will only copy the current image in the active viewer window  so if the  image is part of a multi page image document the remaining pages in the  document will not be copied  To copy the current image in the active viewer  window to the Windows Clipboard  click the Copy to Clipboard option once     Delete Image    The Delete Image option allows you to delete the current image in the ac   tive viewer window  This is helpful for deleting individual pages out of  multi page orphan image documents  When you click the Delete Image  option  a window will appear asking if you want to delete the current im   age  You can then click the Yes button or press EN
66. If your image output directory dropdown menu is blank and you do  not have access to the Directory Manager program  contact your Smeadlink  administrator  If you do have access to Directory Manager  open it now  and specify an image output directory  For information about using Direc   tory Manager  see the Smeadlink System Administrator manual     Important  When you are using the Scanner program to scan documents   you should always be aware of how many images have been scanned into  the selected image output directory  In most cases  you will be able to scan  about 10 000 images into a directory before it starts to become difficult to  work with     142    Chapter 9    8  If you selected a scan source  skip this step and go straight to step 9  If  you selected a disk source  you will now need to specify the image input  information  This information determines which directory the electronic  documents you want to scan will be taken from  To specify the image input  information     e Open the Scanning menu and click the Input Output command  The  Input Output submenu will now appear     e Click the Disk Source Input Settings command on the Input Output  submenu  The Select Disk Source Input Settings window will now  appear as shown below         Demers ier ate Pacaran    _ om   o     Select Disk Source Input Settings window       e The first part of the Select Disk Source Input Settings window is titled  Folder Selection  This is where you select the directory that the elec
67. Laber iimeaiis j  ime  EE Lee Pari  ANE Liberii hee  i a       Menu tip for highlighted menu command    Opening a Smeadlink Program 31    Monitor for Labels on Startup    If this setting is activated  then the Data Director format that was open when  Smeadlink was last shut down will be automatically reopened the next time  Smeadlink is opened  This setting only applies if a format was open when  Smeadlink was last shut down   if no formats were open at that time  then  no formats will be automatically reopened the next time someone opens  Smeadlink     This setting is helpful if you have a Smeadlink workstation dedicated exclu   sively to Data Director  and if you use the same format on a regular basis to  capture label data and print labels  Monitor for Labels on Startup saves the  user from having to reopen a Data Director format each time they reopen  Smeadlink     Note  For more information about Data Director  see chapter 14 in the Sys   tem Administrator s Guide     Monitor Imports on Startup    If this setting is activated  then the import or load that was running with  Quiet Processing when Smeadlink was last shut down will be automatically  reopened the next time Smeadlink is opened  If no imports or loads were  running with Quiet Processing when Smeadlink was last shut down  then no  imports or loads will be automatically reopened the next time someone opens  Smeadlink     This setting is helpful if you have a Smeadlink workstation dedicated exclu   sively to Impor
68. My Computer  to the Smeadlink icon on your desk   top  The second way is to select the document in Windows Explorer  or My  Computer   and then use the Send To utility to send the selected document  to Smeadlink  The third way is to chose the Attach PC File option on the  Smeadlink right click submenu     Once you drag or send the document  using the first two options mentioned  above   the standard Smeadlink Login window will appear  if Smeadlink  was not already open   You will need to select a database and login to it just  like you do when opening Smeadlink  Once you have logged in to a data   base and the Login window has disappeared  the PC Files window will  appear  The example on the following page shows what the PC Files win   dow looks like     326    Chapter 17    fa PC Fitz  Smeadlink   PC FILES  hioen whl you would ike to do with this PE File     File To Process What Mew 11 vanton 2 feeparded  dot    PCD ocunerd     ine thes action  ocript  bai all PC File in hit baich    PC Files window       The purpose of the PC Files window is to specify which LinkScript will be  used to index the selected document  A LinkScript is a custom Smeadlink  script  PC Files will use a LinkScript to determine how the selected docu   ment should be indexed in Smeadlink  i e  whether to attach the document to  an existing row in the open database  or to create a new row in one of the  database s folders and attach the document to the new row      Once you have selected the desired Lin
69. OLICIES PROGECHURES SUITS   ADHINE TRATION  POUOES PAOCEO UAES COMPLE  SDHING TRATION  SUFITY  ADMIN GT RATION   GENERAL  i AUD AM ST POTION   GERERAL CHAOKOLODICAL FLES  ER 1000 ERMTADRNENMT   TESTING  ERS ERMAOKNENT  HASAAD OLE SUES TANCES    Pup ees f See  Ae ee Pee PP    fot   Em   Beea    C ma        This window contains a number of text fields to be used in setting up  Retention Codes  including the Retention Code  Description  Department  of Record and any associated Notes as needed     Clicking the Add button allows the user to enter new retention codes  At  the bottom of the window are two sections which will contain the informa   tion to automate the retention process  On the left side is the Inactivity  feature  This allows any record to stay in the database for a predetermined  amount of time  It will override the retention options  leaving the record  off the destruction report list     On the right side of the Retention Code Maintenance window is the Reten   tion Period  The user will enter in the Event Type  which will be used as  the starting point when calculating how long the record is to be retained   How long the documents need to be retained legally will be added next     Introduction to Retention 317    Then the user s own requirements will be added  Smeadlink will total up  these two lengths of time and hold the documents in the system until the  longer span of time has elapsed  Below is an example of the Retention  Code Maintenance window     Note  Use
70. Phone    Ad   dress  City and State  Now suppose you want to view only the rows in this  folder for patients who live in the state of Illinois  The easiest way to do this  is to perform a filter on the State column  The filter will go through each cell  in the State column and  weed out  all patient rows whose cells contain a  different state name than Illinois  When the filter is finished  the folder will  display only rows for patients who live in Illinois     Note  Smeadlink does not delete rows that do not pass a filter  For instance   in the example in the paragraph above Smeadlink would not delete rows for  patients who live in California  When you perform a filter on a column   Smeadlink modifies the current view in the open folder so that it only dis   plays rows that pass the filter  You can restore the view later on so that it  displays all the rows it did before you performed the filter     Each filter in Smeadlink is made up of two components  the operator and the  criteria  The operator determines how each cell in the filtered column needs  to be related to the criteria in order for the cell s row to be displayed  For  instance  in the example in the paragraph above the operator would be      and the criteria would be  IL   Each cell in the State column needs to be  equal to IL in order to pass the filter  When you are creating a filter  you can  choose the operator for the filter from a list of standard mathematical and  text string operators  and you can enter 
71. S sw    Smeadlink submenu    Opening a Smeadlink Program 27    Anew copy  or instance  of Smeadlink will now be opened  The new instance  will appear in front of any previous instances  If five instances of Smeadlink  are already open  then you will get an error message stating that there can only  be five open instances of Smeadlink     3  The default mode for displaying multiple Smeadlink instances is a cas   cade mode  This means that the copies appear stacked on top of each other   and the only copy that is fully visible is the active copy at the front of the  stack  If you want  you can rearrange or tile multiple instances using the Tile  All command on the Window menu     28 Chapter 2    Using Smeadlink General Options    Once you have opened a Smeadlink program for the first time  it is a good idea  to look at the general options  The general options can be accessed through  any Smeadlink program s Tools menu  and they allow you to determine what  information will be saved each time a user exits a Smeadlink program  For  instance  you can choose to have a Smeadlink program remember the last user  name that was used to open it  Next time someone opens the program  the last  user name will then be automatically entered in the Login window     This section is divided into two parts  The first part shows you how to access  the general options from any Smeadlink program  and the second part ex   plains what each option does     To activate an option  simply open the Prefere
72. Scanner program s shade detection and removal features  check  the Enable option in the Detection section of the Deshade Properties win   dow  The options in the Removal section that were previously lowlighted  should now become available  Check the Enable option in the Removal sec   tion     Working with Scanner Rules 167    To define the size of the shaded areas you want to remove  enter the mini   mum width and height of the shaded areas in the appropriate boxes of the  Removal section  Both of these options are defined in terms of pixels  The  number of pixels in one inch is determined by the scanner you are using  For  instance  if you are using a scanner that scans documents at 200 DPI  then in  your case there are 200 pixels in one inch     Note  Setting the Minimum Height and Minimum Width settings too small  could cause the deshade feature to remove text objects     To define the size of the speckles in the shaded areas that you want to re   move  enter the maximum width and height of the speckles in the appropri   ate boxes of the Removal section  For instance  if all your speckles are size  3 pixels by 3 pixels  you would specify maximum width and height as three  and the Scanner program would remove all speckles up to size 3x3 pixels   The Speckle Width Compensation and Speckle Height Compensation op   tions determine how accurately the Scanner will follow your maximum  speckle width and height settings  For instance  if you set the compensation  settings to 0  th
73. Smeadilink     i  express    User s Guide    ii Contents    No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any  means  electronic or mechanical  for any purpose  without prior written permission  from Records Management Automation Group  LLC  RMAG   The information in  this document and the product it describes are subject to change without notice   Companies  names and data used in examples herein are fictitious unless otherwise  noted  The software program described in this document is provided to its users  pursuant to a license or nondisclosure agreement  Such software program may  only be used  copied or reproduced pursuant to the terms of such agreement  This  manual does not contain or represent any commitment of any kind on the part of  RMAG       2002 Records Management Automation Group  LLC  All rights reserved   Smeadlink is a trademark of Smead Manufacturing Company     Other products and company names herein may be the trademarks of their respec   tive owners     Printed and bound in the United States of America     Contents    Smeadlink User s Guide    Contents    Introduction             ccccsssssssccccccccescssscsccccccccesecccsscececscceseseees    1  Introduction to Smead dink              cccsscscssccscescescsscesseeeeseeees  MME GUC OM 32352 seca  site sss piceseetggeetcsieec A 6  About Your Smeadlink System   0       ceccecceeseesceseeeseceeenseeneeesees 7  New Features in Smeadlink 00 0 0    ceececceeseeceeeeeeeeeesecseeeeeene
74. TER to delete the image     Annotations    The Annotations option allows you to view and work with the annotations  for the image in the active viewer window  Annotations are notes arranged  in chronological order that are specific to one image  Each Smeadlink image  can have any number of annotations     If one or more annotations have been created for the image in the active  viewer window  then the Annotations option icon will have a yellow back   ground  Otherwise  the background will be white  When you click the An   notations button  the Smeadlink Annotations window will appear as shown  below        TTT a Pd Pee eee    Smeadlink Annotations window    216    Chapter 11    As you can see in the example on the previous page  the Smeadlink Annota   tions window contains three columns  Date Time  Memo and Author  The  Date Time column lists the date and time each annotation was created  or  last modified   the Memo column contains the actual text of each annotation  and the Author column lists the user name of the person who made each  annotation  or last modified it      The annotations in the Smeadlink Annotations window form a records grid   that works just like the records grid in a standard layout     e To create a new annotation  simply click in the Memo cell of the blank  annotation at the bottom of the records grid  and type the desired text  for the annotation  Once you have finished typing  save the new anno   tation by clicking a different annotation in the recor
75. The exact appearance of the window will be determined by your fax  management program  The RightFAX window is shown below        RightFAX fax window    5  Enter the appropriate information into your fax window now  and then  click the Send button to fax the image document     Data Output from Smeadlink 123    Printing Labels    The Print   Labels command on the File menu allows you to print labels  from selected rows in the open view  The labels can be either standard black   and white labels  or color coded strip labels  In order to print labels from a  view  the view s table needs to have at least one label design created for it   The design determines what data will be printed on the labels  and how the  data will be arranged  Label designs for black and white labels are created  in a Smeadlink administrative utility called Label Manager  and label de   signs for color coded labels are set up for Smeadlink in an administrative  utility called ColorBar   Label Integrator    In addition to one or more label designs  you will also need to have the  appropriate printer or printers attached to your computer before you can  begin printing labels  This section will show you how to print labels from  rows in the open view  It assumes that at least one label design has been  created for the view  and that the appropriate printer or printers has been  installed on your computer     To print labels from the open view   1  Select the rows in the view that you would like to print label
76. The example below shows what the Tracking Viewer submenu looks like  when it is opened from a destination  The destination that the Tracking Viewer  submenu in the example was opened from has four types of objects assigned  to it including folders  documents and boxes  Therefore  the Tracking Viewer  submenu contains four tracking reports  including Folders Contained  Docu   ments Contained and Boxes Contained            Rafresh Tracking Infcemation    Bours Cartainad  Tracki Folders Contained   HA Enployees Contsined  Dacunnants Contained     SAUEN Al Contents Contained                     Mange 6054   MARIS PA       Tracking Viewer Submenu    3  Click the command on the Tracking Viewer submenu for the type of con   tents you would like to see     For instance  to see all the folders that the destination contains click the  Folders Contained command  to see all the documents that the destination  contains click the Documents Contained command  etc     Smeadlink will now display the Contents report  The Contents report will  list all the objects of the selected type that are currently assigned to the  destination the Tracking Viewer submenu was opened from  The example  on the following page shows what the Contents report looks like  The Con   tents report in the example lists two objects     298 Chapter 15    Dams Draai  sil epope    agies briis Dasi      Lert  umi Fine Shears get dan      Fe fore er eG eee iga  Riis 4     Loreen oan PLAZA POG eT inga          Contents repor
77. The last section in this chapter will show you how to  use the Redlining Edit Mode features  The Redlining Edit Mode features are  a separate group of features on the Image Viewer s toolbar  and they allow  you to edit images in the viewer with lines  shapes or text  As the name  implies  all Redlining objects are red     Using the Image Viewer 207    Opening an Image Document in the Image Viewer    The Image Viewer utility in Smeadlink can be used to view any image docu   ment that is attached to a Smeadlink row  This section will show you how to  open the Image Viewer  adjust its screen position and use it to view image  documents that are attached to Smeadlink rows     To open the Image Viewer     To open the Image Viewer utility     e Click the Attachments command on the View menu     View  Bttochmerts  Manual Indexing     lv Navigation Bar   Search Bar   Switch to Farm Yiew   V Documents  B Information                Once you use choose View and Attachments  the Image Viewer window  will appear  In the example below  the Image Viewer window is positioned  on the right side of Smeadlink s main window        Image Viewer window       208    Chapter 11    To view an image document in the Image Viewer     After the Image Viewer has been opened and it is positioned correctly in  Smeadlink  you will be able to view any image document that is attached to  a Smeadlink row  To view an image document in the Image Viewer     1  Open the view that contains the row the desired image 
78. a all PC Fides itha batch     PC Files window       5  Verify that you sent the correct files to Smeadlink  To see which files you  sent to be indexed     e Click the Show Files button at the bottom of the PC Files window     The PC Files will now expand to include a box called Files in this batch  The  Files in this batch box will list all the files that you sent to Smeadlink to be  indexed by PC Files  The example on the following page shows what the  Files in this batch box looks like  The box in the example contains two files   starting with one called R  r    What s New in 3 1 Version 2 doc If you would  like to return the PC Files window to its original size after verifying that you  sent the correct files  then click the Hide Files button     Using PC Files 335       Files in this batch box  6  Click the LinkScript that you want the selected files to be processed with     All the LinkScripts in the open Smeadlink database are displayed in the box  in the middle of the PC Files window  In the example above  the PC Files  window displays two LinkScripts  starting with one called Index Correspon   dents     7  Check the option underneath the LinkScript list called Use this action   script  for all PC Files in this batch     8  Click the Go  button in the lower left corner of the PC Files window     The PC Files window will now close  and a LinkScript window will appear  if the selected LinkScript needs some identification information to index the  document  The exact appe
79. a container  you will see a command called Refresh Tracking Information  on the Tracking Viewer submenu  This command can be helpful if your  Smeadlink system is installed on a network and you want to see the latest  tracking status of an object  Clicking the Refresh Tracking Information com   mand will refresh the tracking information in the open view with the most  current information in the database     302    Chapter 15    Finally  regardless of the object s tracking level  and regardless of whether  or not it is a container  then you will see a command called History on the  Tracking Viewer submenu  This is the command you will use to open the  History report     The example below shows what the Tracking Viewer submenu looks like  when it is opened from an object  The object that the Tracking Viewer sub   menu in the example was opened from is not a container  so there are no  ITEMS Contained commands on the submenu  Instead  the submenu simply  contains the Refresh Tracking Information and History commands             Tracking  Employees  Employes  McOougs  Aonad   1              Tiked 3 11 23 1959 07 49 PH    Tieched by Manager bory  u  Out                Que back m 1172499 HR Employees Corteined  Cooumerts Cortana   eG   CAPragram FilseSmeadiirDaticn AM Conteris Corb    Tracking Viewer submenu    3  Click the History command on the Tracking Viewer submenu     The History report will now appear  The History report lists all the destina   tions that the selected object 
80. able to see any Redlining objects  For more  information about the Redlining Edit Mode features  see the next section in  this chapter     Using the Image Viewer 217    Mode   Magnify    The Magnify option allows you to zoom in on any part of the image in the  active viewer window  It is useful for viewing portions of an image that are  otherwise too small to read  To activate the Magnify mode  click the Mag   nify option on the Mode submenu  You will now need to locate the area on  the image that you want to zoom in on and make a box around it  To make  the box  follow the steps below     e Click the upper left corner of the area on the image that you want to  zoom in on     e Drag the mouse pointer down and to the right so that a box is made  that contains the desired area     e Once the box encloses the area you want to magnify  let go of the  mouse button  The area in the box will now be enlarged to fill the  entire image viewer window     Note  Once you have magnified an area in an image  you can return the  image to its original size by clicking the Fill Viewer with Image option     Mode   Drag    The Drag option allows you to move a magnified image around in the  active viewer window  This feature only works on magnified images be   cause normal images are already fully displayed in the viewer window  To  activate Drag mode  click the Drag option on the Mode submenu  Once  Drag mode has been activated  move the mouse pointer over the active  viewer window  press and ho
81. age    9  Click the OK button on the message box  The box will now close and you  will be finished indexing the document     Using PC Files 333    Indexing Multiple Documents with one LinkScript    The previous section showed you how to use PC Files to index one elec   tronic document in Smeadlink  This section will show you how to use PC  Files to index multiple documents at once  There are two ways to index  multiple documents at once with PC Files  indexing all the documents with  one LinkScript or indexing each document with a separate LinkScript  This  section will show you how to index multiple documents at once using one  LinkScript  and the next section will show you how to index multiple docu   ments at once using a separate LinkScript for each document     Note  You will need to have at least one PC Files LinkScript in the open  database if you want to index documents in the database with PC Files     To index multiple documents with one LinkScript     1  Open Windows Explorer or My Computer   2  Locate the desired documents in Windows Explorer or My Computer     3  Send the documents to Smeadlink  There are two ways to send a group of  documents to Smeadlink  Both procedures are explained below     e First  you can drag the documents from Windows Explorer or My  Computer to the Smeadlink shortcut on your desktop  if you have a  Smeadlink shortcut      e Second  you can use the Send To utility  To use the Send to utility   you will need to make sure that your C  Win
82. ally include one or  more optional modules  Unlike the start up screen module  which only in   cludes the one module  the optional modules include several components  each  The first component in each optional module is a separate program for  data input  The remaining components are add on utilities for Smeadlink  that allow you to view data input with the first component  For instance  the  Imaging module includes the Scanner program and an image viewer for the  start up screen  The Scanner program allows you to scan images of paper or  electronic documents into Smeadlink  and the image viewer allow you to  view the scanned images in the start up screen     Finally  each Smeadlink system includes a number of administrative utili   ties  Together  these utilities allow you to perform setup and maintenance on  your Smeadlink system  For instance  the Security Manager utility allows  you to create the user names and passwords for accessing your system  and  the Database Toolkit utility allows you to repair your database if it becomes  corrupted  The Smeadlink administrative utilities cannot be accessed with  the standard Guest or Editor user names  so they are not explained in this  manual  For more information about the Smeadlink administrative utilities   see the Smeadlink System Administrator s Guide     8 Chapter 1    New Features in Smeadlink    This version of Smeadlink contains enhancements to the user interface and  additional options designed to make Smeadlink even mo
83. also need to have a tracking hierar   chy in it  The tracking hierarchy determines which objects can be assigned  to which destinations  For instance  a tracking hierarchy would make sure  that a warehouse could not be assigned to a box  The tracking hierarchy for  a database is set up in the Database Map program  which is a Smeadlink  administrative utility  For more information  see step 10 in the section Modi   fying Existing Items in a Database in chapter 10 of the System Administrator s  Guide     When you purchase a Smeadlink system with the Tracking module  it will  not come set up for Tracking  You can have your Smeadlink sales represen   tative set up the database for you at an additional cost  or you can have  someone else set up your database for you  Either way  your database will  need to be properly set up before you can begin using Smeadlink Tracking     Setting up your database is the only thing you need to do before you start  using Tracking  However  there are several tools you can buy that will make  Tracking easier and more convenient to use  These tools are explained be   low     e Welch Allyn SCANTEAM 3400 DO CCD    This is a hand held bar code reader that attaches to your computer   It allows you to scan bar codes into the Tracking program instead of  typing them in with the keyboard  This reader is attached to your  computer with a cord  so you must remain at your desk while scan   ning bar codes  For more information about the 3400 CCD  go to  the Wel
84. and Jump To options  These two features will allow you to quickly  locate data in your Smeadlink databases  By entering text strings  ID num   bers  or any other fields  you can immediately access any data contained in  the Smeadlink database     The Find option is also useful to sort or review information by searchable  field such as ID number  Status  Customer  etc  You can also click Auto  Find  to automatically search once the information has been entered into the  Find window and the In pulldown options have been fixed     Jump To allows immediate access to data by searching the entire workgroup  or database  depending on the criteria selected  Again  Jump To can search  based on a text string or numeric string of information  you do not need to  enter complete names or numbers     Note  The Jump To and Find options will be explained in greater detail in  Chapter Five     Moving Around in Smeadlink 55    Opening the Navigation Bar    The second navigation utility in Smeadlink is the Navigation Bar  The Navi   gation Bar is the tool you will use to open the different folders in the open  database  It provides a quick shortcut to selecting the view you want to  immediately open  You can also use the Navigation Bar to display the differ   ent workgroups in the open database  and the different folders in the open  workgroup     To open the Navigation Bar   1  Open the View menu from Smeadlink s menu bar   2  Click the Navigation Bar command on the View menu     The Navigatio
85. any combination of text and numbers  as the criteria  The example below shows what the window looks like that  you use to create filters           Filter window    50    Chapter 3    Often when you are working in Smeadlink  you will need to find a specific  row or group of rows  Smeadlink has two search utilities called Jump To and  Find that allow you to do just that  Each of these utilities has a different  searching range  and together they allow you to find rows in any folder or  subfolder in the open database     Jump To is a general search utility that you can use to locate a row in any  folder or subfolder in the open database  Jump To locates individual rows  by matching an Id number that you enter with the Id numbers of the rows in  the open database  Jump To now includes several options that you can use to  determine the scope of its search  For instance  you can have Jump To search  just the rows in the open folder  or you can have it search just the rows in the  open workgroup     The Jump To utility is located on the Search Bar at the bottom left hand  side of the screen  when turned on in the Options screen   The Jump to  utility consists of a box for entering ID numbers  and several options that  you can use to determine the scope of Jump To s search  The example below  shows what the main features on the Jump To utility look like        F Digw Rendeonp   I Diy i a hew betes     Banah oneri Workgroup  C Seech nerd Tab   TE Seerch evire Detahate    dure Hgm     
86. ar codes  on the pages it scans     Note  The more options you select on the Bar Code Properties window  the  longer it will take the Scanner to process bar codes  If you do not set enough  options  though  the Scanner may not find some bar codes  You will need to  find a good balance between processing time and ability to locate bar codes    To enable all the options on the Bar Code Properties window that are avail   able to you  check the Enable option in the top left corner of the window   The next step is specify the characteristics of the bar codes that you want the  Scanner program to recognize  Enter the desired bar height and bar width in  the appropriate boxes of the Bar Size section  bar height and bar width refer  to the size of individual bars in a bar code  not the entire bar code   If the  bars can be any width  check the Any Width option  If the wide bars in the  bar codes are twice as thick as the narrow bars  check the 2 to 1 Ratio option     After enabling the Bar Code Properties options and specifying the charac   teristics of the bar codes you want the Scanner to recognize  the next step is  to specify the search attributes that the Scanner will use to look for bar codes   If you want the Scanner to interpret any bar codes it finds as patch codes   click the down arrow at the right of the As Patch Code box in the top right  corner  When the dropdown appears  click the name of the desired patch  code type  The Scanner will then use the settings you specify 
87. arance of the LinkScript window will vary from  LinkScript to LinkScript  The example below shows what a typical Link   Script window looks like        PC Files LinkScript window    336    Chapter 17    9  If the LinkScript you selected has displayed a window like the one shown  on the previous page  then enter the appropriate identification information  in the window for the first document to be indexed  and then click the OK  button at the bottom of the window     PC Files will now index the document in Smeadlink  If you try to attach the  document to a row that already has a PC Files attachment  then a message  window will appear asking if you want to save the document or abort the  procedure  If you choose to save the document  a second window will ap   pear asking if you want to save the document as a new version of the exist   ing document or as an additional page  s  in the existing document  If PC  Files cannot find the row that you want the document to be attached to  then  it will orphan the document and it will display a message to that effect     10  Once the document has been indexed  the LinkScript window will be  closed  It will then reappear so that you can enter the identification informa   tion for the next document to be indexed  Keep entering the identification  information for a document and clicking the OK button until all the docu   ments in the batch have been indexed     11  Regardless of whether the selected LinkScript has displayed a Link   Script w
88. arch Direction feature determines the angle in degrees that the Scan   ner uses to look for bar codes on a scanned image  For instance  if you set  Search Direction to 180 the Scanner would start at the left side of a page and  work its way towards the right looking for bar codes  Select the appropriate  options  You can select multiple angles if the bar codes on your page are  oriented in different directions     The last section on the Bar Code Properties window is called Type  This  section is where you specify the type of bar code that you want the Scanner  to look for  Available types are listed in a box on the left side of the Type  section  You can double click on a type or highlight it and click the Add  button to tell the Scanner that you want it to look for this type  The selected  type should then appear in the In Use box  You can select multiple types  but  some types are not compatible with each other  Once you have selected a  type  the Scanner will not let you select another type that is incompatible  with the first one  The incompatible bar code types are listed below     e Interleaved 2 of 5 and Linear 2 of 5  e UPC A and UPC E   e Postnet and any other type   e UPC A and EAN    There are no more options on the Bar Code Properties window  so press  ENTER or click the OK button to save the changes you have made     Working with Scanner Rules 165    Black Border    Selecting Black Border on the Image Processing submenu will bring up the  Black Border Properties
89. as i 1 scone Fr ok   Em eo ne oe To ij mes aE     h   EE  1 u a          eat   le       LETI E PAE eed ee   a cm e   ne Fi B a I      u ARSTER   FE  m UL   re     a       ld uj  Be eee S EER    Records grid  Image Viewer    The Scanner s records grid lists basic information about each image scanned   like whether or not the image is an orphan  The Scanner s Image Viewer  allows you to view each image as it will be saved  You can choose how you  want the records grid and the Image Viewer to be positioned in the main  program window  In the example above  the Image Viewer is on the right  side of the window and the records grid is on the left  You could reverse this  order if you wanted  or you could put one in the top half of the main program  window and one in the bottom half     All the documents scanned during one session make up a batch  The Scan   ner saves all your batch information  so you can open old batches and work  with existing images in them or scan new images into the batch  When you  are working with existing images  you can reprocess the images if they were  originally scanned electronically off a hard drive  or you can rescan the im   ages if they were originally scanned with a scanner  Either way  the images  will be processed according to the rule that is currently selected  not the rule  that was selected when they were originally scanned     134    Chapter 8    After you have scanned images with the Scanner program and the images  have been attached to ro
90. ast Batch   Extending a Rule   Options on the Image Processing Submenu    138 Chapter 9    Introduction    The previous chapter introduced you to the Smeadlink Imaging module  You  learned about basic Imaging concepts  you also learned about the external  components necessary to run the Scanner program  The next four chapters  of this manual will show you how to use the Imaging module  This chapter  will show you how to work with Scanner rules  chapter 10 will show you  how to scan documents and chapters 11 and 12 will show you how to view  scanned images in Smeadlink     As you learned previously  a rule is a collection of settings that determines  how documents are scanned and what is done with the document images  after they have been scanned  All the settings that define a rule are contained  on the Scanning menu  in the Sources  Documents  Input Output and Image  Processing submenus  You will not have to set many of these options  but  they are available so that you can fine tune the scanning process and pro   duce the best images possible     The first section of this chapter will show you how to create a basic rule   This rule will only set the features that are required by the Scanner to define  a rule  The next several sections of this chapter will then show you how to  use the features in the Scanner that are available for working with rules as a  whole  For instance  you will learn how to rename a rule and how to clone a  new rule from an existing one     The last 
91. at a  cell looks like in Smeadlink        A cell in Smeadlink    Introduction to Smeadlink 41    Column    You can think of a row as a horizontal line of cells in a Smeadlink folder  A  column then is a vertical line of cells  The difference between a row and a  column is that a row contains different types of cells that all relate to one  item  whereas a column contains one type of cell from different items     For instance  each row in a customer folder could contain a customer name  cell  a customer address cell and a customer phone number cell  Each row in  this folder would then be made up of three different cells about one item   which in this case is a customer  The rows in this folder would make up three  columns  The first column would contain all the customer name cells in the  folder  the second column would contain all the customer address cells and  the third column would contain all the customer phone number cells  The  example below shows what a column looks like in Smeadlink     Name of column    Shank Fire PO  Urii ota       Manda PO 01011873     Trp    Pink PO On cosa          a Peestr o    ie en Pica BEE  Hit  nieo    Data in column  Workgroup    As you learned in chapter 1  Smeadlink organizes related folders into groups  called workgroups  A workgroup in Smeadlink is very similar to a drawer in  a real filing cabinet  For instance  just as you could have a drawer in a real  filing cabinet that contains a group of financial folders  you could have a  workg
92. at steps 6 8 for the second document in this  batch  Keep repeating these steps until all the files in the batch have been  indexed     10  Once all the selected documents have been indexed  a message will  appear to indicate that the process is done  Click the OK button on the mes   sage box  The box will now close and you will be finished indexing your  documents     Using PC Files 341    Viewing a PC Files Document in Smeadlink    The previous three sections in this chapter showed you how to index single  and multiple electronic documents in Smeadlink  This section will show you  how to view a document in Smeadlink that has been indexed with PC Files   Remember that image documents indexed with PC Files are not displayed  like other types of documents  is you are using Smeadlink Imaging in addi   tion to Smeadlink PC Files   The first part of this section will show you  how to view anormal PC Files document in Smeadlink  and the second part  will show you how to view an image document that has been indexed with  PC Files     To view a normal PC Files document in Smeadlink     1  Open the Image Viewer utility  To open the Image Viewer     e Click the Attachments command on the View menu     Mae Leet tos Lite    EP LS eer ok       eb ie       Image Viewer utility in Smeadlink    2  Now select the row that the desired document is attached to  To select a  row     e Click the row selector of the desired row     The row selector is the gray box at the very left of each row  Onc
93. at the very left  side of each row      The row will appear highlighted after you click it  to indicate that it is  selected  You can select multiple rows at once by holding the down  the CTRL key while you click row selectors  The example below shows  what a row selector and a group of selected rows looks like     tS irona Patent Apeicatan  SEP OEM Apo  Ti      SPSS Hj erga seth Ors  eat            A selected row    A row selector    2  If there are any columns in the open view that you do not want included in  the report  then minimize each one of those columns now  To minimize a  column     e Place your mouse pointer over the right edge of the column s column  header     e When the mouse pointer changes to the horizontal resizing cursor   drag the column edge as far left as possible     114 Chapter 7    3  Check the print preview for the report     It is a good idea to always look at the print preview for a report before print   ing  to make sure that the report will be printed the way you want  This is  especially the case in longer reports that can waste substantial printer time  and resources if printed incorrectly  To check the print preview for the re   port     e Click the Print Preview command on Smeadlink s File menu  The Print  Preview submenu will now appear     e Click Grid  All Rows  or Grid  Selected Rows  if you will be printing  abasic report for the open view  and click Formatted Report  All Rows   or Formatted Report  Selected Rows  if you will be printing
94. available if the image document in the  Manual Indexing utility contains more than one page  and if a page other  than the first page is currently being displayed  This button will be grayed  out if it is not applicable to the current image document  If the image docu   ment in the active viewer window contains more than one page  and if the  page that is currently being displayed is not the first page  than you can see  the previous page of the document by clicking the Previous Page button  once     Page Number    The Page window displays the page number of the current image document  in the Manual Indexing utility  If the current image document contains only  one page  than the Page window will display the number 1  If the image  document contains more than one page  the Page window will display the  number of the page that is currently being displayed in the viewer window     Next Page    The Next Page button will be available if the current image document in the  Manual Indexing utility contains more than one page  This button will be  grayed out if it is not applicable to the current image document  If the cur   rent image document contains more than one page  you can view the next  page of the document by clicking the Next Page button once     Fill Viewer with Image    The Fill Viewer with Image button allows you to return a magnified image  to its original state  If you have magnified the current image in the Manual  Indexing utility and you would like to return it to 
95. ax card or Kofax software  will clear the Kofax cache  and restart the internal Kofax program that operates the engine  To reset  your Kofax engine     e Open the Scanning menu and select the Source command  The Sources  submenu will now appear     e Click the Reset Kofax command on the Sources submenu  The Reset  window shown below will appear for several seconds while the Kofax  engine is being reset  Once the Kofax engine has been reset  the Reset  window will disappear       EE HA kolm imaga Precht brageContalr Tonki  Eeee vane    Faia Engra Lork Sucos uly       Reset window    2  If resetting the Kofax engine does not solve your problem  then the next  step is to turn off your computer  let the hard drive spool down and turn the  computer back on again  This will clear all the temporary memory in your  computer  which can easily get corrupted  Turning off the computer and  turning it back on again will also get rid of GPF errors     Important  Selecting Restart from the Shut Down Windows box is not the  same as physically turning the computer off  letting it spool down and then  turning it back on again  Restarting the computer  or turning it off and then  on again without letting it spool down  will not always clear all the tempo   rary memory in the computer     3  The last step you can try before calling technical support is to make sure  that all your hardware is plugged in correctly  If any of the cords are not  plugged in all the way  you may lose communication bet
96. ay need to print the report  several times  Before you print the report again  you can either reposition  the columns in the view so that the columns that were not printed the first  time will be printed now  or you can minimize the columns that were printed  the first time   A minimized column is a column that has been resized to the  minimum column width   these columns are not printed in reports      This section will show you how to print a basic or formatted report for the a  view  You can use the information in this section to print a report for any  view in the open Smeadlink database  Remember that if you want to print a  formatted report for a view  the report will have to be created by someone  with Manager level access rights  typically  your Smeadlink system admin   istrator      Note  Before printing a report for the open view  it is a good idea to go  through the print setup process for reports  This will set all the default print  settings used to print reports from Smeadlink  For more information about  the print setup process  see the previous section in this chapter     Data Output from Smeadlink 113    To print a report for the open view   1  Select which rows in the view you want included in the report     By default  a report will include every row in the open view  If you want  only certain rows included in the report  then you will need to select those  rows before printing  To select a row     e Click its row selector  the row selector is the gray box 
97. below        First Import Wizard window    286    Chapter 14    4  Click the New button on the Import Wizard window  The New popup  menu will now appear     5  Click the Load from Denso command on the New popup menu  The sec   ond Import Wizard window will now appear as shown below        Second Import Wizard window  6  Click the Acquire button on the second Import Wizard window     A Smeadlink window will now appear as shown below telling you to pre   pare the Denso scanner for transmitting  The data you will transmit here is  not going to be imported into Smeadlink  Instead  it will be used as sample  data to set up the import  You can use either dummy data created expressly  for this purpose  or actual tracking data  once data is transmitted from the  scanner it is not automatically deleted  so you do not have to worry about  losing real tracking information         Smeadlink window    Tracking Smeadlink Objects 287    7  To prepare the Denso scanner for transmitting   e Open the main menu in the scanner   e From the main menu  press the 5 button     8  Click the OK button on the Smeadlink window  then press the ENT but   ton on the Denso scanner     Once data has been transferred from the Denso scanner to Smeadlink  a Trans   fer Completed  message will appear in the scanner  and sample data will  appear in the second Import Wizard window     9  Create break lines between each field in the sample data  Import Wizard  will use the break lines to determine how the data shou
98. ber of pages have been scanned   or after a specified type of patch code has been scanned  If the Inc On Page  option is selected  the Scanner will increment the counter after a certain  number of pages have been scanned  You can enter the desired number in the  box provided  If the Inc On Patch option is selected  the Scanner will incre   ment the counter after a certain type of patch code is scanned  Click on the  down arrow at the right of the Inc On Patch box to display a list of patch  codes you can choose from  and then click again on the desired patch code to  select it     The Counter Reset options determine when the Smeadlink Scanner will re   set the counter  You can have the counter reset after a specified number of  pages have been scanned  or after a specified type of patch code has been  scanned  If the Reset On Page option is selected  the Scanner will reset the  counter after a certain number of pages have been scanned  You can enter  the desired number in the box provided  If the Reset On Patch option is  selected  the Scanner will reset the counter after a certain type of patch code  is scanned  Click on the down arrow at the right of the Inc On Patch box to  display a list of patch codes you can choose from  and then click again on  the desired patch code to select it     162    Chapter 9    You have now specified what the automatic endorser annotation string will  say and how it will appear on the page  The last step is to select whether the  string will b
99. bject and  a note object look like on an image     Using the Manual Indexing Utility 255    Pe ree train Saeed  Sel Fae  i    AT ETE    mAB             P    5 note object  A text object    Eai     Highlight    The Highlight button allows you to highlight any area on the current image  by drawing a yellow rectangle over the area  The area under the rectangle  will then appear to be highlighted  To highlight an area on the current im   age     e Click the Highlight button on the toolbar     e Now position the mouse pointer over the area on the image where you  want the highlighting rectangle to start  hold down the left mouse but   ton and drag the mouse pointer diagonally in the desired direction  As  you drag the mouse pointer  a highlighting rectangle will be drawn on  the image     e Let go of the left mouse button once the rectangle is the desired size  and is in the desired position  The rectangle will now turn yellow     The new highlighting rectangle will be automatically selected once you let  go of the left mouse button  and the area under the rectangle will now stand  out from the rest of the image     256    Chapter 12    Deleting Redlining Objects on an Image    There are several ways to delete Redlining objects on an image  For deleting  individual Redlining objects  you can simply select the desired object and  press the DELETE key on your keyboard  For deleting all the Redlining  objects on an image at once  however  you will need to use the Redlining  popup men
100. by one  using a form  A form for a folder is made up of one  labeled box for each column in the folder  For instance  if a folder contained  a Name column and an Address column  the form for that folder would  include one box labeled  Name  and another box labeled  Address      When you are viewing data with the Form Display option turned on  you can  use the Page Up and Page Down keys to display different rows from the  open folder in the form  As you move from one row to another  the data  from each row will be displayed in the form s boxes  Using a form makes it  easier to work with individual rows in a folder  because you can only see  data in the row you are working with   there is no possibility to be dis   tracted by data in other rows  The example below shows what a row looks  like in a form     Name of open folder           Fnr we 1 faacartiat bao    Be Yam Go  ool Bows  Ratertion Regts addins window Help    Request Trntke   Slisoieante   Daso       Smeadlink Form View    48    Chapter 3    Smeadlink allows you to edit any existing row in a folder  You can also add  new rows to any existing folder  or delete existing rows  Many times  in   stead of modifying actual data  you will want to modify how existing data is  displayed  For instance  you may want to organize all the rows in a folder  called Client by their client names  or you may want a folder that contains  purchase order rows to display only purchase orders that were received in  the past week  Smeadlink ha
101. cans  in the box provided that you want maintained in Kofax     152    Chapter 9    The second option in the Options section of the Source Properties window  is called Page Timeout  This option determines how long the Scanner pro   gram has to process an image  If the specified time limit expires  a Device  Timeout error will appear and the scanning process will be stopped  To  enter a page timeout setting  enter the number of the desired timeout in the  box provided     Once you have set all the options on the Source Properties window to your  desired settings  press ENTER or click the OK button to apply the settings to  the current rule     Reset Kofax    The Reset Kofax option on the Sources submenu allows you to reset your  Kofax hardware  software or utility  This is often helpful in troubleshooting  the Scanner  If you get an error while scanning documents with the Scan   ner program  the first thing you should do is reset Kofax  This will clear the  Kofax cache and reload the appropriate software  When you select the Re   set Kofax option  the Reset window will appear as shown below  This win   dow has a status bar in the middle of it to indicate how much progress has    SI ITE fodar mage Preetict mageiorimh Preda       eg ee a    aie Boge Lined fucceishale       Reset window    been made  and it will disappear once your Kofax utility has been fully  reset     About Kofax    Selecting About Kofax on the Sources submenu will bring up the About  Kofax window shown on the
102. ceivable documents have a gray border that you want re   moved from the scanned images  and both types of documents need to be  scanned into their own directory     To accomplish this  you could create one rule for each document type  The  accounts receivable rule would include the settings for removing the gray  border of scanned images  and it would store the images in the accounts  receivable directory  The accounts payable rule would not include any set   tings for modifying images  and it would store images in the accounts pay   able directory     One of the main components in each Scanner rule is the rule s LinkScript   The LinkScript determines what rows the images scanned with the rule will  be attached to  You can think of a LinkScript as a small  custom program that  the Scanner executes each time it scans an image  The LinkScript may at   tach each image to a row automatically  or it may require some identification  information about the row the image should be attached to     132    Chapter 8    If a LinkScript requires some identification information about the row an  image should be attached to  it will either display a window that you can  enter the information into or it will require you to use separator sheets  The  exact appearance of a LinkScript window will differ from LinkScript to Link   Script  but the example below shows what a typical LinkScript window looks  like     TEENIE       A typical LinkScript window    LinkScript windows work well for Imaging
103. cessary for your specific scanner  The documentation that came with your  scanner will show you how to install it and perform any necessary setup     Scanning and Viewing Images 177    Scanning Documents    This section will show you how to scan documents with the Scanner pro   gram  In order to scan documents  there will need to be at least one created  in the open Smeadlink database  The rule tells the Scanner program how  documents should processed as they are scanned  For information about  creating a rule  see chapter 9  You will also need to install a physical scanner  if you want to scan paper documents  This section will walk you through the  process of scanning documents in the Scanner program once a scanner has  been installed and a rule has been created     To scan documents with the Smeadlink Scanner program     1  Select the desired rule to scan documents with  To select a rule     e Click the Rule command on the Scanning menu  The Rule submenu  will now appear as shown below  The top section of the Rule submenu  lists all the different rules that have been created in the open Smeadlink  database  In the example below  the only rule in the open database is  called Direct from Disk     Scanning  Rule 1 Direct from Disk    Sources                 gt   New Rule      Documents  gt  Save Active Rule   Aput  Wl utout  gt   Inyput Sutae Delete Rule     Image Processing    peon Clone Rule     scan  gt   Modify  gt  Rename Rule           Rule submenu  e Click the desired 
104. ch Allyn website at www dcd welchallyn com     e Symbol Technologies LS 1004 1100 Spark    This is another hand held bar code reader that is supported by  Smeadlink Tracking  Like the Welch Allyn 3400  it attaches to your  computer with a cord  so you must remain at your desk while scan   ning bar codes  For more information about the Symbol Spark  go  to the Symbol Technologies website at www symbol com     268 Chapter 13    e Denso BHT 6000 portable scanner     This is the portable scanner that is currently supported by Smeadlink  Tracking  Unlike the two bar code readers  the Denso scanner has  all the functionality of the standard Smeadlink Tracking program   You can use it to assign single and multiple objects to a destination   and you can also assign due back dates on it for destinations with  Out status     The Denso scanner can typically hold around three or four thou   sand bar codes  and it allows you to track objects anywhere and  then upload the tracking information from the scanner to Smeadlink   For more information about the Denso BHT 6000  go the Denso  website at www denso id com     If you decide to buy one of the hand held bar code readers or the Denso  portable scanner  contact your Smeadlink representative  Equipment that you  buy from non Smeadlink sources may not be supported by Smeadlink     Tracking Smeadlink Objects 269    14  Tracking Smeadlink Objects    1 Som edtin b Bur Cock  Ti aud  traf Erect bh Expire  Dev  Ioi ere Bho SH Uy          Faw tes 
105. ck  the Jump To box to activate it  and scan the desired bar code  The bar code  will then be automatically entered into the Jump To box     3  Click the Jump Now button below the Jump To options  or press the EN   TER key     Jump To will now search through the specified range  trying to find a match  for the ID number you entered  If no match is found  Jump To will display a  message to that effect  Otherwise  Jump To will display the matching row  according to the selected Jump To options  i e  in anew instance of Smeadlink   etc       Note  Jump To handles duplicate ID numbers the same way Smeadlink Track   ing does   it uses the bar code search order specified in the Database Map  utility  If the number you enter in the Jump To box has multiple matches in  the open database  then Jump To will display the first matching row it finds  using the bar code search order     4  If you would like to close the Jump To utility after using it  to make more  space on the screen for displaying the contents of the open folder or sub   folder  click the  X  at the far right of the Jump To utility     Viewing Rows in Smeadlink TI    Using Find to Locate Rows in a View    There is no limit to the number of rows that a view can contain  so some of  the views that you work with in Smeadlink may eventually contain hundreds  of thousands or even millions of rows  When a view contains this many  rows  using the vertical scroll bar to move from one row to another can take  an extended length o
106. column is sortable  the name will be underlined  If the column is not  sortable  the name will not be underlined     72    Chapter 5    Performing a Primary Sort    The following instructions will show you how to perform a primary sort on  a view in Smeadlink  The primary sort will organize all the rows in the view  according to the data in one of it s columns  You can perform primary sorts  on any view in the open Smeadlink database     To perform a primary sort on the open view     1  Locate the column in the view that you want to sort by  and place your  mouse pointer over that column s column header     The column header is the top cell in the column  and it contains the column s  name  or heading  The example below shows what a column header looks  like in Smeadlink                 A column header in Smeadlink    2  Once your mouse pointer is over the column header  click the left mouse  button once to sort in ascending order  or twice to sort in descending order     The rows in the open view will now be sorted in either ascending or de   scending order according to the cells in the selected column  To indicate  which column the rows have been sorted by  a plus sign will appear in the  column header of the primary sort column if you chose to sort in ascending  order  and a minus sign will appear if you chose to sort in descending order   The plus or minus sign will appear to the right of the name in the column  header  and it will be surrounded by parentheses     The exa
107. con   tinue removing the black border     To enable the options on the Black Border Properties window  click the  Enable option at the top of the window  If you want to crop black borders  instead of just removing them  check the Crop option  Enter the desired  White Noise Gap setting in the box provided  Press ENTER or click the OK  button to save the changes you have made     166 Chapter 9    Deshade    Selecting the Deshade option on the Image Processing submenu will bring  up the window shown below     Dashade Pospestess    Detector  F ratk   Herera  I Ejib    Hirm    width ol Anes jahi  Miu High of Ania  peaks   Heareum 5 pack da With  pate    gainers g peajkbe Hekghi ipni  Bostik whith Donien ain pas   Beck le Height Compensation rien    Deshade Properties window          The options on the Deshade Properties window allow the Scanner to per   form shade detection  shade correction and shade removal  Shaded areas on  a scanned image are rectangular areas containing a pattern of black speck   les  The deshade feature allows you to remove shaded areas from scanned  images while preserving the text inside the shaded areas     The basic procedure to remove shaded areas from a scanned image consists  of three basic steps  First  you enable the Scanner program s shade detection  and removal features  Second  you define the size of the shaded areas you  want to remove  And third  you define the size of the speckles in the shaded  areas that you want to remove     To enable the 
108. corner      Viewing Rows in Smeadlink 67    5  Viewing Rows in Smeadlink                   Chapter contents    Introduction   Adjusting the Size of Rows in a View  Sorting Rows in a View   Using Jump To to Locate a Row   Using Find to Locate Rows in a View  Freezing Columns in a View   Moving Columns in a View   Filtering Rows in a View   Reloading a View   Viewing General Information for a View    68 Chapter 5    Introduction    The previous chapter showed you how to move around in Smeadlink  First   you learned how to open the Navigation Bar  You then learned how to use  these utilities along with the Go menu and the toolbar to open folders and  subfolders  Finally  you learned how to open the different views in a folder  or subfolder  You should now feel comfortable moving around in Smeadlink     This chapter will take you a step further and show you how to use the fea   tures that are available in Smeadlink for viewing rows  The purpose of these  features is to customize the way rows in a folder or subfolder are displayed   For instance  you can use the features explained in this chapter to modify  things like which rows are displayed in a folder  what order the rows are  displayed in and the size of each row in the folder s records grid     None of the features explained in this chapter can modify the actual data that  is contained in a Smeadlink folder or subfolder  Instead  these features modify  the folder or subfolder s open view  Recall from chapter 3 that each Smea
109. d  then press the ENTER key or click the OK button     Tracking Smeadlink Objects 277  OR    e Scan the bar code with a hand held bar code reader  such as the Welch  Allyn SCANTEAM 3400 or the Symbol Technologies Spark       The object will now appear on the Tracking diagram underneath the locked  destination and a prompt will appear above the object as shown in the ex   ample below  The prompt indicates that the Tracking program is waiting  for the next object that you want to assign to the locked destination  You  can assign as many objects as you would like to the locked destination   using the same procedure you used to assign the first object     6  If you enabled the Hold Destination Detect Change option in step 2   then you can now enter the bar code of the second destination using the  same method you used to enter the bar code of the first one     The new destination will now appear on the Tracking diagram above the  first destination that you entered  You can assign as many objects as you  would like to the second destination  just like you did with the first one  As  long as Hold Destination Detect Change is enabled  then each time a desti   nation is entered it will be locked  You can then assign as many objects as  you would like to it     278 Chapter 14  Adding Additional Fields to Barcode Tracking    In addition to tracking the location of the object  Smeadlink allows you to  supply additional information about the object at tracking time  These ad   ditional f
110. d how to open an image document in the Image Viewer  and you  learned how to work with the image document using the features on the  Image Viewer s submenu  toolbar      This chapter will show you how to use the Manual Indexing utility  which is  another utility for viewing images in Smeadlink  The Manual Indexing utility  is the third component in the Imaging module  The difference between the  Image Viewer and the Manual Indexing utility is that the Image Viewer only  allows you to view attached images  while the Manual Indexing utility only  allows you to view orphan images  Remember from chapter 8 that an attached  image is an image that has been attached to a row in Smeadlink  and an  orphan image is an image that is not attached to a row     The first section in this chapter will show you how to open the Manual  Indexing utility and adjust its position in the main Smeadlink window  The  second section will then explain each of the general options on the Manual  Indexing utility s toolbar  These options allow you to do things like view all  the orphan image documents in a database  and fax or print orphan image  documents  They also allow you to attach orphan image documents to rows  in Smeadlink  This process is called manual indexing  and it is what gives the  Manual Indexing utility its name     The last section in this chapter will show you how to use the Redlining Edit  Mode features  The Redlining Edit Mode features are a separate group of  features on the Manual I
111. d ip    T dngan san bdd Us  Fismes ee ot T am hrag  gt     Erste hrp ls asim      ilaga  varke Lir  ID    L   ee   Focprn Cietmar     Options window       280    Chapter 14    3  Click the COM Ports tab in the Options window  The COM Ports folder  will now open     4  Click the Denso Setup button in the COM Ports folder     A Smeadlink window will now appear with instructions for downloading  the latest tracking program to the Denso scanner  The example below shows  what the Smeadlink window looks like        Smeadlink window    5  Follow the instructions on the Smeadlink window to prepare the Denso  scanner     In step 4 on the Smeadlink window  the    DRIVE A    option refers to the  Denso   s RAM drive  and the    Drive B    options refers to the Denso   s ROM  drive  Drive B is recommended  because installing Smeadlink in ROM will  make it more stable than installing it in RAM  For more information  see  Flash ROM and RAM in chapter 2 of the BHT 6000 User   s Manual     6  Click the OK button on the Smeadlink window  Smeadlink will now down   load the latest version of the tracking program to the Denso scanner     Tracking Smeadlink Objects 281    Tracking Objects with the Denso Scanner    This section will show you how to track Smeadlink objects with the Denso  scanner  You will learn how to assign both single and multiple objects to a  destination  You will also learn how to enter a due back date for objects  assigned to Out destinations  and how to enter a prefix or su
112. d the screen now features a smaller menu bar for workgroup use   Users will now be able to request files  transfer files and perform a variety of  functions using the new menu bar     Introduction to Smeadlink 9    Smeadlink Modules    Smeadlink is a modular software system  This means that a number of sepa   rate Smeadlink end user modules are available  and customers pick the mod   ules that best fit their application  The advantage of this approach is that  customers know exactly what their system will be capable of  and the sys   tem overhead  unused features and their associated cost  will be substan   tially reduced  In addition  if a customer ever wants to expand the function   ality of their system  they can purchase additional modules from their dealer  whenever they wish     Note  For more information about Smeadlink modules and the other com   ponents in a Smeadlink system  see the section About Your Smeadlink Sys   tem earlier in this chapter     The rest of this section will introduce you to each module in Smeadlink that  is intended for typical users  these are called end user modules   Each end   user module is explained in its own subsection  The subsection explains the  purpose of the module  and what components it includes  Remember that  the number of modules in Smeadlink varies from system to system  so your  Smeadlink system may not include all the modules explained in this section     10    Chapter 1    Smeadlink Start Up Screen    Smeadlink displays row
113. dexing Viewer  The red  objects in the example are rectangles     SEVGO  1   BP  ate    ae ome    aan  s Oo0C es yng               Using the Manual Indexing Utility 249    Line    The Line button allows you to draw any number of lines on the current  image  To draw a line on the image     e Click the Line button on the toolbar     e Now position the mouse pointer over the place on the image where  you want the line to start  hold down the left mouse button and drag  the mouse pointer in the desired direction  As you drag the mouse  pointer  a line will be drawn on the image     e Let go of the left mouse button once the line is positioned correctly and  is the correct length     The new line will be automatically selected once you let go of the left mouse  button     Rect    The Rect button allows you to draw any number of rectangles on the current  image  To draw a rectangle     e Click the Rect button on the toolbar     e Now position the mouse pointer over the area on the image where you  want the rectangle to start  hold down the left mouse button and drag  the mouse pointer diagonally in the desired direction  As you drag the  mouse pointer  a rectangle will be drawn on the image     e Let go of the left mouse button once the rectangle is the desired size  and is in the desired position     The new rectangle will be automatically selected once you let go of the left  mouse button     250    Chapter 12    Ellipse    The Ellipse button allows you to draw any number of elli
114. dlink   as long as that user had Word installed on their computer      Smeadlink also gives you an option to enhance the connectivity with other  Microsoft Office applications such as Excel  Word and Outlook  Users with  Microsoft Office 200 and Office XP will see a  Send to Smeadlink  icon on  their Office toolbar  Users will be able to send Office documents directly to  the Smeadlink database     Users can save documents as documents  templates  rich text format  web  page  or text only files from within Smeadlink  These files can be attached  to rows and displayed in the Image Viewer as any other PC Files document   To enable this connectivity  you   or your Smeadlink system administrator    need to turn on the MS Office Connectivity using the tab on the Options  window as shown below     Seo   EOP  BETES Sa         PC Files also allows users to edit documents attached to existing records   and save them  in place   or as a new version  To edit a document  simply  click on the appropriate link in the Image Viewer  as shown in the example  on the previous page     330 Chapter 17    Indexing a Document    As you learned in the previous section  the main purpose of the PC Files  program is to index electronic documents in Smeadlink  Indexing electronic  documents makes the documents available to every Smeadlink user on the  network  and it also makes the documents easy to find     This section will show you how to index an electronic document in Smeadlink   You can use the in
115. dlink  folder or subfolder is based on one table of records in a Smeadlink database   but it can contain multiple views of the rows in that table  Each view is a  distinct arrangement of the table s rows  When you perform an operation  that modifies the open view in a folder or subfolder  like sorting its rows by  a certain column or filtering the rows so that only several are displayed  that  operation only affects the open view  The other views in the folder or sub   folder remain unchanged     Note  Although the features explained in this chapter can be used to tempo   rarily modify a Smeadlink view  these changes will not be permanent unless  the view is saved using one of the Save View features  The Save View fea   tures are managerial level features in the Smeadlink  so they will not be  available to you unless your Smeadlink login name has managerial access  rights  If your login name does not have managerial access rights  then any  view changes you make will be removed once you close the Smeadlink     Viewing Rows in Smeadlink 69    Adjusting the Size of Rows in a View    When you open a folder or subfolder in Smeadlink  all the cells in the open  view will be the same height and all the cells in each column of the view will  be the same width  As you begin to work with the view  there may come  times when you would like to resize its rows to accommodate different  amounts of data  This is a quick and easy process in Smeadlink  You can  modify both the height and wid
116. document is  attached to     2  Click the row in the view that the desired image document is attached to     The first page of the document will now be displayed in the Image Viewer   as shown below  The next section in this chapter will show you how to use  the options on the Image Viewer s toolbar to make viewing images as useful  as possible        An image in the Image Viewer    Using the Image Viewer 209    Image Viewer Options    The previous section in this chapter showed you how to open the Image  Viewer utility in Smeadlink  adjust its screen position and open an image  document in it  This section will show you how to use some of the Image  Viewer s options to work with image documents     The Image Viewer options  or its toolbar  is located on a submenu   which is  displayed by clicking your right mouse button on the image  It allows you  to manipulate image documents that are currently open in the Image Viewer   For instance  you could use the toolbar to zoom in on a certain part of an  image  or you could use it to rotate an image  The example below shows  what the toolbar looks like in the Image Viewer s window     corres ee med FF    marri ung eed FTL PT Piei    Same ngs Liners      pnl   LE map ers   i pen coe   K   A armi   E qe       h Lot E meeer  iak teapa jimm aa jaj i       Image Viewer Submenu  toolbar     The toolbar in the example above contains six sections of options and addi   tional submenus  This section will review different options on the Image
117. documentation  that comes with your scanner will show you how to set its patch code recog   nition features     If your scanner does not have patch code recognition capabilities or if it does  and you do not want to use them  check the Enable Scan Stop option in the  Stop on Patch Code section  Now select the patch code types that you want  to use to tell the Scanner program to stop the scanning process  Double click  on the desired types or click the Add button  The types will appear in the box  on the right side of the Stop on Patch Code section once they have been  selected  Once you have finished setting the options on the Patch Code Prop   erties  Advanced  window  press ENTER or click the OK button to close the  window     174 Chapter 9    Streak Removal    Selecting Streak Removal on the Image Processing submenu will bring up  the window shown below     Shpat Propeler                      Streak Properties window    The options on the Streak Properties window allow you to have the Scanner  program remove streaks on scanned images  Streaks can occur on scanned  images as a result of marks on the original page  dust in the scanner assem   bly or a faulty scanner camera     Ifyou want the Scanner program to remove streaks on scanned images  check  the Enable option on the Streak Properties window  Now enter the maxi   mum width of the streaks you want removed in the box provided  The streak  width option is entered in pixels  The number of pixels in one inch depends  on t
118. dows SendTo directory  contains a shortcut to the Smeadlink  exe file  s135 exe   A shortcut to  the Smeadlink  exe file is automatically created during the Smeadlink  installation process  but you may want to check it to make sure it is  pointing to the correct file     Now locate the documents you want to index  select them and click  the right mouse button once  Select the Send To option on the popup  menu that appears  and then select the Smeadlink option on the Send  To submenu     Once you send the documents to Smeadlink  the Smeadlink Login window  will appear  if Smeadlink was not already open      334    Chapter 17    4  If Smeadlink was not already open  then open the desired database from  the Login window     Once you have opened a database  the Login window will close and the PC  Files window will appear  The PC Files window lists all the LinkScripts in  the open Smeadlink database  and it allows you to select which LinkScript  will be used to index each document  The example below shows what the  PC Files window looks like     Note  The PC Files window will only appear if the open database contains  multiple LinkScripts  If the open database contains just one LinkScript  then  that LinkScript will be run automatically and you will not see the PC Files  window           Ea PC Files    Smeadilink   PC FILES    Chee whet you rhaid Eke to do with this PC Fie      thes click    or    Fils To Process  Whats Hew in 31 Venon 2  epended  doc    I Use het seton  script  b
119. ds grid  The  Date Time cell and the Operator cell of the new annotation will be  filled in automatically once it is saved     e To edit an existing annotation  click in the Memo cell of the desired  annotation  and then edit the existing text as desired  Once you have  finished editing the text  save your changes by clicking a different  annotation in the records grid  The Date Time cell and the Operator  cell of the edited annotation will be filled in automatically once it is  saved     e To delete one or more existing annotations  hold down the CTRL key  while you click the row selector of each annotation  Once you have the  selected the annotations to delete  press the DELETE key  A popup  message will now appear asking if you want to delete the selected  rows  Click the Yes button or press the ENTER key to delete the se   lected rows     View Redlining    The View Redlining option allows you to view any Redlining objects on the  image in the active viewer window  Redlining objects are shapes  lines or  text added to an image using the Redlining Edit Mode features  As the  name implies  these objects are all red  They are typically used for making  notes on an image  or drawing attention to certain parts of an image     The View Redlining option works like a toggle switch  As long as it is  activated  you will be able to see all the Redlining objects that have been  created for the image in the active viewer window  Once you deactivate it   however  you will no longer be 
120. dth     Sorting Rows in a View    Sometimes you may want to organize all the rows in a view according to the  data in one of its columns  For instance  suppose you have a view ina folder  called Customers  and one of the columns in this view is called State  The  view contains one row for each of your company s customers  and the State  cell of each row contains a two digit abbreviation of the state that customer  is located in  Now suppose that you want to organize all the rows in the view  according to their State cells  so that you can see how many customers you  have in each state  You want all the rows for customers in Alabama to ap   pear at the top of the records grid  followed by all the rows for customers in  Alaska  followed by all the rows for customers in Arizona  etc     Viewing Rows in Smeadlink 71    The procedure described in the example above  where you organize all the  rows in a view according to the data in one of it s columns  is called sorting   Smeadlink has two features for sorting rows  Primary Sort and Secondary  Sort  Both features allow you to sort in either ascending or descending order   Ascending order sorts from 0 9 and from A Z  Descending order sorts from  9 0 and from Z   A   The difference between these two features is that Pri   mary Sort is a general sort that you can use on any sortable column in a view   and Secondary Sort is a specific sort that you can use to further sort rows  after performing a primary sort  You can only have one pr
121. duction to Tracking 265    Once you have tracked some objects  either with the Tracking program or  the Denso scanner   then anyone with access to the Smeadlink can view the  current location of each object  Tracking information for rows in the  Smeadlink is displayed in an add on utility called the Tracking Viewer  The  example below shows what the Tracking Viewer looks like in Smeadlink     Tracking diagram       Tracking Viewer within Smeadlink    When you click the row of a tracking destination in Smeadlink  you will just  see the destination item in the Tracking Viewer  However  when you click  the row of a tracking object in Smeadlink  the Tracking Viewer will display  the destination of the selected object  The Tracking Viewer displays tracking  status using a diagram that looks like an outline   This diagram is shown in  the example above   it is located in the upper left corner of the Tracking  Viewer window      The tracking diagram places objects under destinations  and it can have mul   tiple levels depending on the tracking hierarchy set up in your Smeadlink  database and the destination of the selected object  The tracking diagram  has been expanded in Smeadlink 3 5 to include more information about  tracked objects  it now displays the name of the Smeadlink operator who  tracked the object  the date and time the object was tracked and its In Out  status  This information was added to the tracking diagram for reference  purposes     266    Chapter 13    In addit
122. due Fie    be   2    LYH Joss soe    eet Wie  He  it    Co bem iawr     El Verte    he Wow  we    Pyne leet eee Bee purrs direa   OSE   eS       Chapter contents    Introduction   Assigning an Object to a Destination  Assigning Multiple Objects to a Destination  Setting up the Denso Scanner for Smeadlink  Tracking Objects with the Denso Scanner  Uploading Tracking Data to Smeadlink    270 Chapter 14    Introduction    The previous chapter introduced you to the Smeadlink Tracking module   You learned about basic Tracking concepts  and you also learned about the  optional hardware that can be used with Smeadlink Tracking  This chapter  will show you how to track objects in Smeadlink using the Tracking pro   gram or the Denso BHT 6000 portable scanner     As you learned in the previous chapter  the main purpose of the Tracking  program and the Denso scanner is to assign Smeadlink objects to Smeadlink  destinations  Once you have assigned objects to their destinations in the Track   ing program or the Denso scanner  then you can use the different Tracking  utilities in the Smeadlink to view the location and the tracking status of each  object     This chapter is divided into two main parts  each part consisting of several  sections  The first part will show you how to track objects in the Tracking  program  You will learn how to assign single and multiple objects to a des   tination  and you will also learn how to assign a due back date for objects  assigned to Out destinations  
123. dule  which  consists of one component   the PC Files program  As you learned in chapter  1  PC Files is a program that allows you to index electronic documents of any  format in Smeadlink  Once a document has been indexed with PC Files  any  Smeadlink user can open the document from Smeadlink in the program it  was originally created in     The first section in this chapter will explain the basic concepts for using PC  Files  If you have not used PC Files before  then reading this section should  give you a basic idea about what PC Files looks like and how it is used  The  next three sections will show you how to use PC Files to index single and  multiple documents in Smeadlink  You can use the information in these sec   tions to index documents of any format  i e  Word  Excel  PageMaker  etc     Finally  the last section in this chapter will show you how to view PC Files  documents from Smeadlink     Note  For a summary of the PC Files module and its function in your  Smeadlink system  see the sections PC Files Module and About Your  Smeadlink System in chapter 1     Using PC Files 325    PC Files Concepts    PC Files is a program that allows you to index electronic documents of any  format in Smeadlink  Once a document has been indexed by PC Files  any  Smeadlink user can open it  locate the row that is associated with the docu   ment and then use that row to open the document in the program it was  written with  For instance  if you used PC Files to index a Word document 
124. e   EEE huam       Tracking Viewer Detailed View    Using the Tracking Features 295    Viewing the Tracking Status of an Object    The Tracking Viewer is used to view the tracking status of any trackable  object in Smeadlink  All details regarding the tracking of an object are shown  here and includes items such as the date and time the object was tracked   the user name the object was tracked with  the In or Out status of the object s  destination and the object s due back date  This section will show you how  to use the Tracking Viewer to view the tracking status of an object     To view the tracking status of an object     1  Make sure the Tracking Viewer is expanded to show the detailed view      If it is not  click the Plus button on the Tracking Status Viewer  as shown on  the previous page     2  Select the row of the object whose tracking status you would like to view   To select a row in Smeadlink     e Click the row selector of the desired row  the row selector is the gray  box at the very left side of each row      Note  You can also simply click in one of the row s cells     The tracking status of the selected object will now appear in the Tracking  Viewer  As you learned in chapter 13  the Tracking Viewer displays the  tracking status of an object using a number of entries  Each entry contains  information about one object or destination     e If the selected object is a trackable object but it has not been tracked  yet  then you will just see one entry in the vi
125. e  it is more likely that you will be assigning multiple ob   jects to a destination  For instance  if you wanted to track a box with several  folders in it  each folder would need to be assigned to the same destina   tion   in this case  a box     The Smeadlink Tracking program has two features that make it easy to as   sign multiple objects to a destination  Basically  these features remember  the bar code of the destination so that you do not have to enter it again and  again for each object that you want to assign to it  The first feature is called  Lock Destination  and the second feature is called Hold Destination Detect  Change     Lock Destination is for when you want to assign all the objects in a tracking  session to one destination  and Hold Destination Detect Change is for when  you have several destinations and you would like to assign multiple objects  to each one  This section will show you how to use each feature to assign  multiple objects to a destination     To assign multiple objects to a destination     1  Make sure the open Smeadlink database contains bar codes for both the  objects you want to track and the destination you want to assign the objects  to     2  Enable the Lock Destination or Hold Destination Detect Change option  on the Tracking window     Both options are located in the lower part of the Tracking window  immedi   ately under the Due Back Date box  Remember that Lock Destination is for  when you want to assign all the objects in a tracki
126. e  then you can now select which pages to print from the document     e To print all the pages in the document  click the All option     e To print a range of pages in the document  click the Range option and  then enter the desired page range in the from and to boxes     7  Press ENTER or click the OK button to print the selected document     The selected document in the Scanner s records grid will now be printed  according to the current settings on the Print window     Scanning and Viewing Images 199    Fax Setup    Before you can begin faxing images from the Scanner program  you will  need to go through a basic fax setup process  The fax setup process is similar  to the print setup process   it determines the default settings that will be  used to fax image documents  This section explains the fax setup process in  the Scanner program     Before you begin the fax setup process  you will need to have a fax manage   ment program such as RightFAX installed on your computer  You will also  need to have access to a fax machine from your computer  and your com   puter will need to be configured so that it can send faxes using that fax  machine  The documentation that came with your fax machine and your fax  management software will tell you how to install the fax machine  and how  to configure your computer so that it can use the fax machine to send faxes     To perform fax setup     1  Click the Fax Setup command on the File menu  The Print Setup window  will now appear as sho
127. e Check the Current Operator Batches Only  option     The batch list that you see will then be temporarily rebuilt so that only batches  that were scanned with the selected user name are displayed     3  Select the batch that you want to review  To select a batch     e Click the appropriate row in the Locate an old Batch window s batch  list     The Scanner will now open the selected batch  The Scanner s Image Viewer  will display the last image that was open in this batch  and the Scanner s  records grid will display rows for all the documents that were scanned in the  batch     Scanning and Viewing Images 191    Viewing Documents in a Batch    The following instructions will show you how to view the documents in the  open batch  If you would like to view the documents in a different batch   open the desired batch now using the instructions in the previous part of this  section     To view the documents in a batch     1  Click the first row in the Scanner s records grid     The image of the first document in the batch will now appear in the Scanner s  Image Viewer  If the document contains multiple pages  then you will only  see the first page in the document at this time     2  If the document you opened in step 1 contains multiple pages  then view  the remaining pages in the document now     e If the document you opened in step 1 was saved as one file  then the  document s row in the records grid will be connected to multiple im   ages  For instance  if the document is thr
128. e Filter window   Once you click this button  a new filter line will be added to the top of the  Filter window  This line will be used to create your filter  The example on  the following page shows what a new line looks like in the Filter Window     3  Select a column name for the new filter     The column name you select will determine which column the filter will be  applied to  To select a column name     84 Chapter 5       A new line in the Filter window    e Click the down arrow at the right of the first box in the new filter line   A dropdown will appear that lists all the filterable columns in the open  view     e Click the desired column name in the dropdown to select it  The name  that you clicked on will now appear in the column name box of the  new filter line  In the example below  a column called State has been  selected in the new filter line     4  Select an operator for the new filter     The operator determines how the cells in the selected column need to be  related to the criteria in order for their rows to be displayed  If the column       Selected column name for the new filter line    Viewing Rows in Smeadlink 85    that you selected contains numerical data or dates  then you will be able to  choose from a list of standard relational operators like   lt   or   gt    If the  column that you selected contains text  then the operator list will be ex   panded to include the operators IN  contains  and BEG  begins with   To  select an operator     e Click th
129. e Reader from your  Smeadlink CD ROM     34 Chapter 2    To install the Adobe Acrobat Reader     1  Place the Smeadlink CD ROM into the CD drive on your computer  The  Smeadlink Installation System window will now appear as shown below        Smeadlink Installation System window    2  Click the Adobe Acrobat Reader command on the Smeadlink Installations  System window  The install wizard will now walk you through the process  of installing the Acrobat Reader on your computer     To open a PDF version of either manual     1  Open the Help menu from any Smeadlink program     Help  User Manual  System Manual     F  About Smeadiink    Help menu         2  Click the appropriate command on the Help menu for the manual you want  to open  The manual you selected will now open automatically in the Acrobat  Reader     Opening a Smeadlink Program 35    Viewing Version and Registration Information    The second section of the Smeadlink Help menu allows you to view the  version and registration information for your Smeadlink system  Customer  service representatives will often ask you for the version number when they  are helping you with your system  The version and registration information  are both displayed in the About window     To open the About window  click the About command on the Smeadlink Help  menu  The About window will now appear as shown below     fetegrated Dorene Wanaque    Snan    fan perduci  arma is  Fike   Sorel hatar DEY  Paguision Code OTD    SU OR Fiha ii MA ey Ba
130. e Scanner s Image Viewer and a row will be created for it in the Scanner  program s records grid  The example on the following page shows what the  Scanner program looks like after a document has been scanned     Note  If the Multiple Page Image File option is enabled  the Scanner pro   gram will create one row in the records grid each time the first page of a  document is scanned  If a document has multiple pages the Image Viewer  will display an image of each page as it is scanned  but no new rows will be  created in the records grid until the first page of the next document is scanned     182 Chapter 10           je Pao lo fer   eS   Se ee       E b a     E eRe   a   F   TA   a      a      m   jel y St poet   cy  r     G   i   maaa LY                TE  FS eae     fa       1 er Eri     fz L 4 bE   E S   WE nO n rm e S   J     nm   5 a m     aus   ail      g  a ee fe      Image of document  that was just scanned    Row created for  document that was  just scanned    9  If you want to stop the scanning process at any time     e Open the Scanning menu and click the Scan command  The Scan sub   menu will now appear     e Click the Stop Scanning command on the Scan submenu  The Scanner  will now stop the scanning process as soon as possible     10  If a document is scanned incorrectly  you can rescan or reprocess the  original document  To do so     e Set all the rule options to the settings you want the document scanned  with     e Load the paper document in the scanner if you
131. e Scanner will only remove speckles up to the specified maxi   mum width and height  If you set the compensation settings to 1  the Scan   ner would remove speckles up to   pixel larger than the specified maximum  speckle width and height     Once you have set the desired settings on the Deshade Properties window   press ENTER or click the OK button to save the changes you have made     Deskew    Selecting Deskew on the Image Processing submenu will bring up the win   dow shown below     F Erabi F  Miiran Angke degeest  0    Magara Angin dagan   120       Deskew Properties window    The options on the Deskew Properties window allow the Scanner program  to detect skew on scanned images and correct skew up to a specified angle    168    Chapter 9    Because of the way scanners feed in sheets of paper  it is possible that docu   ments can get out of alignment during the scanning process  The resulting  images will then have varying degrees of misalignment  or skew  The Scan   ner can correct up to 12 degrees of skew on scanned images  When an image  is deskewed  it is saved in its corrected state     To correct skewed images  check the Enable option in the Detection section  of the Deskew Properties window  The Enable option in the Correction sec   tion that was previously lowlighted should now become available  Check  the Enable option in the Correction section to enable the remaining options     To define the minimum and maximum skew angles to correct  enter the de   sired ang
132. e down arrow at the right of the middle box in the new filter  line  A dropdown will appear listing the different operators that can be  used with the column you selected     e Click the desired operator in the dropdown to select it  The operator  that you clicked on will now appear in the operator box of the new  filter line  In the example on the previous page for step 3  the      operator has been selected     5  Enter the criteria for the new filter     The criteria that you enter will be used along with the operator to determine  which cells in the selected column pass this filter  You can use any combina   tion of numbers or characters as the criteria for a filter  To enter the criteria  for a filter     e Type the desired criteria in the last box of the new filter line   6  Apply the new filter to the open view  To apply the new filter   e Click the OK button at the bottom of the Filter window     The Filter window will now close  and the rows in the open view will be  filtered according to your filter     86    Chapter 5    Working with Multiple Filters in a View    The previous part of this section showed you how to create one filter in a  view  This part of the Filter section will explain how to work with multiple  filters  After you have created one filter for a view  you can create additional  filters by following the same steps you used to create the first filter  For each  filter that you want to create  simply click the New Line button to create a  new filter l
133. e previous  section  you will be able to fax image documents that are attached to rows in  the open view  This section will show you how to use the Fax Image com   mand to fax an image document from the open view     To fax an image document   1  Open the Image Viewer  To open the Image Viewer     e Click the Attachments command on the View menu  or click the At   tachments button on the toolbar      2  Activate the row that the image you want to fax is attached to  To activate  a row     e Click in one of the row s cells     The image document attached to the activated row will now appear in the  Image Viewer as shown below        An image in the Image Viewer    3  Click the Fax Image command on the File menu  The Print window will  now appear as shown on the following page     122 Chapter 7       Print window    e Make sure that the Name box in the Print window contains the name  of the fax machine that you want to use to fax the image document     e If the image document contains multiple pages  you can choose to fax  a range of pages instead of all of them  To do so  click the Pages radio  button on the Print window and then enter the appropriate page num   bers in the from and to boxes     e If you would like to fax more than one copy of the image  enter the  desired number of copies in the Number of copies box     4  Click the OK button in the lower right corner of the Print window     A fax window will now appear that allows you to specify fax specific infor   mation  
134. e printed onto paper documents or added to images after they  have been scanned  Check the Enable Automatic Annotation option in the  top left corner of the window if you want the text string to be added to  scanned images  Check the Enable Automatic Endorser option if you want  the text string to be printed onto the paper documents  Checking both op   tions means that your scanned images will always match the paper docu   ments they were originally taken from     Bar Code Properties    Selecting Bar Code Properties on the Image Processing submenu will bring  up the window shown below          pte fmo  Pa                         Bar Code Properties window    The options on the Bar Code Properties window allow the Scanner program  to recognize bar codes on scanned images  As you scan in documents that  have bar codes on them  the Scanner uses the Bar Code Properties settings to  read the bar codes and then processes the documents according to the Link   Script that is currently selected  If there is no LinkScript currently selected  or if the Scanner is unable to read the bar codes  then the documents will  simply be scanned in as orphans     Working with Scanner Rules 163    There are three basic steps to using the Bar Code Properties window  The  first step is to enable bar code recognition  the second step is to specify the  characteristics of the bar codes that will be processed and the third step is to  specify the search attributes that the Scanner will use to look for b
135. e to fax the image document     202    Chapter 10    e If the open image document in the Image Viewer contains multiple  pages and was saved as one file  then you can choose to fax a range of  pages instead of all of them  To do so  click the Pages radio button on  the Print window and then enter the appropriate page numbers in the  from and to boxes     e If you would like to print more than one copy of the image  enter the  desired number of copies in the Number of copies box     3  Click the OK button in the lower right corner of the Print window     A fax window will now appear that allows you to specify fax specific infor   mation like who you want the image document faxed to  The exact appear   ance of the window will be determined by your fax management program   The example below shows what the RightFAX window looks like     Fan ioheaheon   PAO  1S  on ER Sees Ge ml          De E i a T Oma Ping t  ent   aate  one FTI  tm T   Tassin Deb Hinks  Fom Tepes   HOTLZED B  e   Pin Se a  Maie  Hama   l  kaip    A Hii tia Pht             RightFAX fax window  4  Enter the appropriate information into your fax window now     For information about the options on the fax window  see the documenta   tion that came with your fax management software     5  Click the Send button to fax the selected image document according to  the current settings on the Print and fax windows     Scanning and Viewing Images 203    Troubleshooting the Scanner    This section will show you how to perform
136. e viewer  window  You may want to use the Text button to label objects that you draw  using buttons like Line or Rect  To type some text on the image in the active  viewer window     e Click the Text button on the toolbar     e Now place the mouse pointer in the desired position  and drag it to  create a rectangle  When you let go of the left mouse button after cre   ating the rectangle  the letters AaBbYyZz will appear in the top left  corner of the window  followed by a blinking cursor     Note  If the text in the rectangle is too small to read  you can make it  larger by selecting a higher Zoom percentage     e Press the DELETE button on your keyboard to delete the computer   generated text  and then begin typing in your desired text     The text you type in will automatically wrap when it reaches the right  border of the rectangle you drew  but you can press the ENTER button  on the keyboard if you want the text to start on a new line before it  reaches the right border  You will be able to type any number of lines  in the text rectangle  because the window will be expanded if you reach  the lower border and you continue typing     e Once you have finished typing  place the mouse pointer somewhere  outside the text rectangle and click the left mouse button once  The  text rectangle will now disappear  and the text inside it will change  from black to red to indicate that it is finished     Note    The Note button is very similar to the Text button  in that it allows you t
137. e you click  a row selector  a white arrow will appear in it and the row will turn blue to  indicate that it is selected  The example on the following page shows what a  selected row looks like     342 Chapter 17           Cii Files  june 107    Inactive Ciri Fea   Novernbar 1950                                    A row selector  A selected row    Once you select a row that has a PC Files document attached to it  a shortcut  to the program the document was written with will appear in the Image  Viewer  The Image Viewer will also display the name and location of the  document  in case you need to work with it outside of Smeadlink     The example below shows what the Image Viewer looks like when a PC  Files row has been selected  The PC Files document in the example was  written with Notepad  so a shortcut to Notepad is displayed in the Image  Viewer     Dist iiiki acti pele ladis lee iether    hea  lich kon ki ae Paala      Te fates doha Dinard    Eili tace  Ca ress vaio       Program shortcut    Edit PC File links    Name and location of Smeadlink document copy    3  Click the shortcut to the program the document was written with     The document will now be opened in the program it was written with  If you  make any changes to the document and save them  then the Smeadlink copy  of the document will be updated with your changes  When the next user  opens the document from Smeadlink  they will see the updated version of  the document     Using PC Files 343    To view a PC Fil
138. econdary sort   ing and how to locate rows using Find and Jump To  You also learned how to  prevent columns from scrolling off the screen by freezing them  and you  learned how to display a select group of rows in a view with one or more  filters     All of the features you learned about in the previous chapter can only be  used to modify how the rows in a view are displayed   they cannot be used  to modify the actual data that the rows contain  This chapter will take you a  step further and show you how to use the different Smeadlink editing utili   ties  which allow you to modify the actual data in a view s rows  For in   stance  you can use these features to edit existing rows or add new rows to  any view in the open database  You can also use them to delete individual  rows or groups of rows from a view     Note  In order for you to edit a view in Smeadlink  your Smeadlink user  name needs to have editing rights for the view you wish to edit  The editing  rights for each Smeadlink user name are specified in the Security Manager  program  which is a Smeadlink administrative utility  Depending on how  your user name is set up in Security Manager  you may only have editing  rights for certain views in Smeadlink  See your Smeadlink system adminis   trator for information about the views you can edit     Editing Rows in Smeadlink 95    Editing Existing Rows    In earlier versions of Smeadlink  you needed to turn on a feature called Edit  Mode before you could edit existing row
139. ects report  the second part explains how to  print the contents of the report and the third part explains how to export the  contents of the report to a standard text file     Note  You can also use the instructions in this section to run the Past Due  Tracked Objects report from the Tracking program   To run the Past Due Tracked Objects report     1  Open the Reports menu from Smeadlink s main menu bar     2  Click the Past Due Tracked Objects command on the Reports menu  The  Smeadlink Past Due Report Options window will now appear as shown be   low        ie aGnk lianan Pal Dus Mapmi phras      r Die Ea      Diet  Pi Cesc Tyran       Lm  tw      Smeadlink Past Due Report Options window       3  Select the desired due back date for the report  There are two ways to  select a due back date  Each method is explained below  To select a due  back date        Type the desired date in the As Of Date box   OR    e Click the down arrow at the right of the As Of Date box  A calendar  will now appear  The example on the following page shows what the  As Of Date calendar looks like     310    Chapter 15    Smeesdbink Liian Fast Dus Rept DHH             As Of Date a    e Drag the scroll bar at the bottom of the calendar to select the desired  month  then click the desired day in the month     4  Select the desired object type for the report  You can select one type of  object for the report  such as folders or boxes  or you can select all trackable  objects  To select an object type  
140. ed to know in order to use a module are explained in  the introductory chapter of that module s section  Any optional hardware  that can be used with the module will also be listed and explained in the  introductory chapter  The remaining chapters in the section will then explain  how to use all the features that are available in the module for typical  Smeadlink users     Introduction to Smeadlink 7    About Your Smeadlink System    Smeadlink is a complete 32 Bit modular software system for managing both  electronic and paper documents  The main module in Smeadlink is a power   ful database browsing program  Smeadlink uses an intuitive system to orga   nize rows of data and display them in a way that is both informative and  easy to use  You can add additional modules to your Smeadlink system to  enhance its functionality and give it the features that best fit your applica   tion     Each Smeadlink system includes the start up screen  a database  any op   tional modules to enhance Smeadlink s functionality  and a number of ad   ministrative utilities  The start up screen is the central hub of your Smeadlink  system  It is the tool you will use to locate and view data  All data that is  specific to your Smeadlink application is contained in a file called a data   base  In order to view data in the start up screen or other Smeadlink pro   grams  you will need to open the database that contains the data you wish to  view     To enhance the capabilities of Smeadlink  systems usu
141. ee    a    Py ees beastie ar ei  Vee Coe U Dears bram emer  Febin Paie T  Pamer iraire  EF Takipi Piya 1  ecg Pee    F  Pip  m am ai li  5 Temei Foner Lana oboi    Takim  Pode 1  lami Tonm       Destination section  Object section    You can enter bar codes into the Tracking window using either the key   board or a hand held bar code reader  Either way  as you enter bar codes  into the Tracking program  it will automatically create a register of your  transactions  The register is a diagram that shows you what objects have  been assigned to what destinations  and it is displayed in a box on the right    side of the Tracking window  The example below shows what the register  looks like in the Tracking program     B m bee oe H mi       Lp Lees Reine Eee J    lhe Gee U Leapa eee fee  Vedder Fakie T    Pia rie  E Takip Paige 7  egies pee    A  Pip   m jam a ji  Tiimi Famer E La ioiii  Taiim  Fike    Loni ees       Tracking register    Introduction to Tracking 263    Each object that you enter into the Tracking program is assigned to only one  destination  but each destination can have more than one object assigned to  it  For instance  you could assign three file folders to the same box  The  Tracking program has several features that make it easier to assign multiple  objects to the same destination  Basically  these features remember the bar  code of a destination so that you do not have to keep entering it for each  object that you want to assign to the destination  Chapter 14
142. ee document rows and you want to see all the document rows for a  the employee Steve Johnson  This task can easily be accomplished with one  filter  All the rows that you want to see in this view have the same employee  name  which in this case is Steve Johnson  so you specify the Employee  Name column as the column you want the filter to search through  You only  want to display rows whose data in the Employee Name column is equal to   Steve Johnson   so you then specify the operator for this filter as     and  the criteria as  Steve Johnson      Once you create the filter and apply it to the view  Smeadlink will search  through the Employee Name column and weed out any rows with employee  name data that does not match your criteria  The open view will then con   tain only those document rows for the employee Steve Johnson  In this ex   ample  only one filter was used to display the desired data  However  you  can create any number of filters for a view  Once you finish using the filters   you can easily remove them from the open view  The view will then re display  all the rows it contained before you created and applied your filters     Filters are created in Smeadlink with the Filter window  In addition to basic  capabilities for adding and removing filters  the Filter window also has a  setting called Advanced Features that allows you to adjust exactly how the  filters in the open view will be applied  In order to use the Advanced Fea   tures capabilities  you will need 
143. ee pages long and if it was  saved as one file  then three images will be attached to the document s  row in the records grid  To view the remaining pages in the document   click the Previous Page or Next Page buttons on the Image Viewer s  toolbar until the desired page is displayed     e If the document you opened in step 1 was not saved as one file  then  each page will have a separate row in the Scanner s records grid  To  view the remaining pages in the document  simply click the row in the  records grid that corresponds to the page you wish to view     3  View the remaining documents in the batch the same way as you viewed  the first     192    Chapter 10    Correcting Documents that were not Processed Correctly    As you view each of the documents in a batch  you may find that some of the  documents were not processed correctly when they were originally scanned   For instance  a document s image may be upside down or it may still have a  black border on it when you wanted the border removed  The Scanner s  Modify feature allows you to correct images that were not processed cor   rectly when they were originally scanned     The Modify feature allows you to rescan an image if it was originally scanned  with a scanner  or reprocess an image if it was originally scanned from a  disk drive  When an image is modified  it is processed according to the cur   rent rule settings  not the settings it was originally scanned with  The new  image then replaces the original one  Modi
144. eeaees 8  Smeadlink Modules           cccccccecceseceseeseeeeceteeeeeeeeeeceseeeeeeseeneeenes 9  2  Opening a Smeadlink Program              sscccsccssessessssesseeeeee  Jinta notante HON AE TE E T 21  Opening a Smeadlink Program       s sssessessseesseesessrsersersrsrrsrsesss 22  Using Smeadlink General Options             ccccecceeseeteeeeereeeeeenes 28  Opening an Add In from a Smeadlink Program               e 32  Using Sme  adlink Help eserin 33  Exiting a Smeadlink Program             ccccecescesceseeeeeeteeeeceeeeeeeenes 36  3  Introduction to Smead ink               csccssscsecscesceesescessesceeeees  Tint Odi ch OM secesie eree eara sein Garin EES FENET EENE EISE 38  Basic Smeadlink Terms   0        cccceseeseceeeeeeceeceteeeeeeeeeeeeeseeeeeeees 39  Basic Smeadlink Concepts   00    eeecesesseseeeceeeeeeseeaeeeeereaeeeees  H  4  Moving Around in Smead link                cssccssscscessescsseesceeeees  Tint O GU CHOI n A AAEE E AE T 54  Using the Search Options s isssrsssssssiurssssisesusssresssieesasetsi istsrss 54  Opening the Navigation Bar           eceeeesecseceeeeeeeceeeeeeseeeeenees 55  Opening a  Folder sssiscs ses estesencietiesien Gavestectieins retorns Enes PE NESES  56  5G Uc 21h  Co 6 ame erence ee ree ee oe nee 58  Opening a Subfolder sci  c secsscidedaen wdiavtstiaceescavnnrs 59  Openinga VIC W s s5sececeedisizess estviadeaceyiswsedesdd estecdeseadnsiateeeane 6l  5  Viewing Rows in Smeadlink        sessseessoossoossoossssssssesssosssoosso  Mitt OCUCHON a
145. een these two  features is that each shape that you draw with the Polygon button must de   fine a bounded area  In other words  the beginning of the first line in the  shape must be connected to the end of the last line  This is different than the  Polyline button  which does not require a shape to define a bounded area  If  you do not connect the ends of a shape that you create with the Polygon  button  they will be automatically connected for you  Apart from this differ   ence  you create shapes with the Polygon button exactly like you create  shapes with the Polyline button     Pointer    The seventh Redlining button is called Pointer  This button allows you to  draw  pointers  on the current image  A pointer in the Manual Indexing  utility is like an arrow   it is made up of a straight line with a small triangle  on the end of it  To draw a pointer on the current image     e Click the Pointer button on the toolbar     e Now position the mouse pointer over the area on the image where you  want the head of the pointer to be  hold down the left mouse button  and drag the mouse pointer  The head of the pointer will be drawn as  soon as you click the left mouse button  and the line of the pointer will  be drawn as you drag the mouse pointer     e Let go of the left mouse button when the line is the correct length and  in the correct position     The example on the following page shows what several pointers look like  on an image in the Manual Indexing utility     Using the Man
146. eim berinti hiim  i   COL A I Oo  Locari  Dira   ETGT E Teppe Hibai tr  i  TkT EE NE i i   aiki i ai   el H TS   z i   ETER T  janar  Tarei ie Fire      ST 1 aS Sp         Chapter contents    Introduction   Opening the Tracking Viewer   Viewing the Tracking Status of an Object   Viewing the Contents of a Destination   Viewing the History of an Object   Setting Up and Using Additional Tracking Properties  Using the Tracking Requestor   Running the Past Due Tracked Objects Report    292 Chapter 15    Introduction    The previous chapter showed you how to track objects using the Tracking  program or the Denso BHT 6000 portable scanner  You learned how to as   sign single and multiple objects to a destination in either the Tracking pro   gram or the Denso scanner  and you learned how to assign a due back date  for destinations with an Out status  You also learned how to create a track   ing import to upload tracking information from the Denso scanner to  Smeadlink  and you learned how to run a tracking import     This chapter will show you how to use the tracking features in Smeadlink   which allow you to view the tracking status of the items in the open data   base  You will learn how to use the Tracking Viewer to view the tracking  status or the tracking history of an object  and to view the contents of a  destination  You will also learn how to run the Past Due Tracked Objects  report  which displays all the objects in the open database that have not been  returned to their pe
147. eina         Windows printer window    4  If you are going to be printing on a nonstandard paper size or if you will  be printing from a different printer tray than Tray 1  select the appropriate  Size and Source options  To change the Size or Source settings     e Click the down arrow at the right of the option s text box  A dropdown  will appear listing the available sizes or printer trays     e Click the desired item in the dropdown  The dropdown will now close   and the item you selected will appear in the option s text box     5  If you would like the images to be printed in landscape mode  check the  Landscape option under Orientation  The image to the left of the two Orien   tation options will now change to reflect how data will be printed on each    page     6  Click OK or press ENTER to save the setup information  The Print Setup  window will now close and you will be finished with the print setup process     Scanning and Viewing Images 197    Printing Scanned Documents    Once you have gone through the print setup process explained in the previ   ous section  then you will be able to print any image document in the open  Smeadlink database  Printing out a document is helpful if the document was  originally scanned in electronically  and you now want to have a hard copy  of the document  This section will show you how to print documents from  the Scanner program     Note  This section assumes that you have already gone through the print  setup process for the Scanne
148. elete the selected rows     Note  There is no Undo feature in Smeadlink  Once you delete one or  more rows from a view  the rows will be permanently deleted from the data   base and you will not be able to retrieve them     Note  It is not necessary to highlight the row if you only want to delete one  row  Simply make sure your cursor is blinking somewhere on the row you  want to delete  then  start with Step 2 above     106 Chapter 6    Refreshing Rows    If your Smeadlink system is installed on a network  then the Refresh com   mand on the Rows menu will allow you to keep up to date with the latest  changes to the rows in your views  For instance  you may open a view in  Smeadlink  and after you open the view another user may scan some docu   ments into Smeadlink  modifying rows in the view you have open  You could  then refresh the rows in the view  and you would be able to see the new  changes that had just been added  This section will show you how to refresh  the rows in the open view     To refresh the rows in the open view     1  Open the Rows menu from Smeadlink s main menu bar  The example  below shows what the Rows menu looks like                                 F Hean Ficas Cidah   GE Select Aow Ch Space  Gi Select AM lows ChA   Pe Delete Aor   E Saye Row Calas    Ob Erd Tooke  Cater   T dumpToToober Cubed   H Fite   CH Son   3  Rites  Rows menu    2  Click the Refresh command at the bottom of the Rows menu     The rows in the open view will now be refreshed  and 
149. er as they are scanned     4  If you want the Scanner program to just scan one image  either from a  directory or from the scanner  click the Scan command on the Scanning  menu  Now click the Scan Single Image command on the Scan submenu     Note  If you do not select the Scan Single Image command  then when you  start the actual scanning process the Scanner program will scan all the  selected files in the source directory or all the paper documents in the scan   ner     180    Chapter 10    5  If you are scanning electronic documents  you can have the Scanner pro   gram monitor the input directory and scan new documents as they are added  to the directory  To do so     e Open the Scanning menu and click the Scan command   e Now click the Continuous command on the Scan submenu     One situation in which the Continuous option is helpful is if you send in   coming faxes to a directory as they are received  If you wanted to scan the  faxes into Smeadlink  you could have the Scanner program monitor the di   rectory you send the faxes to  As faxes are saved to the directory  they would  then be scanned into Smeadlink     6  If you are scanning paper documents  load the documents you want to  scan into your scanner     Important  If the selected rule specifies a LinkScript  and if the LinkScript  requires separator sheets for processing images  then you will need to load  the appropriate separator sheets into the scanner along with the documents  you want scanned  For more informat
150. eral ways to save your record  and each method is explained below     If you are using the grid   e Click the Save Row command on the Rows menu   e Click the Save button on the toolbar     e Use the Up or Down arrow keys on the keyboard to move to another  row in the open view     e Use the TAB key on the keyboard to move to the row beneath the new  row     e Click on another row in the open view     After you save your row  the pencil at the left of the row will disap   pear to let you know that the row has been saved     If you are using the Zoom Window     e Click the Save  amp  Exit button to save your record and return to the  grid     e Click the Save  amp  Clear button to save your current record  clear the  Zoom Window  and be ready to immediately enter your next record     Note  There are three types of columns that you will not be able to edit  using the procedure explained in this section  These are columns that have  had their Editable option turned off by your Smeadlink system administra   tor  columns that are dropdowns and columns that are lookups  If you need  to edit a column that is currently not editable  see your Smeadlink system  administrator  If you need to edit a dropdown or lookup column  see the  section Working with Dropdowns later in this chapter    Editing Rows in Smeadlink 99    Working with Dropdowns    A typical parent child relationship in Smeadlink includes a parent folder and  a child folder  Each row in the parent folder can be attached to 
151. erform horizontal or vertical character reconstruction  on characters that have had lines running through them removed  check the  Enable option in the appropriate section  You will then need to enter the  minimum height and maximum width of the characters you want recon   structed  Once you have set all the options in the Line Removal Properties  window  press ENTER or click the OK button to save your changes     172    Chapter 9    Patch Code    Selecting Patch Code on the Image Processing submenu will bring up the  window shown below     Piet betta cma es ja                            Patch Code Properties window    The options on the Patch Code Properties window allow you to have the  Scanner recognize patch codes on scanned images  Patch codes are a series  of horizontal black bars separated by spaces  A patch code is usually placed  near the leading edge of a paper document to be scanned  Patch codes can be  used to separate documents or to stop the scanner     The Patch Code Properties window is used in conjunction with the New  Document Rule feature to create a new document each time a patch code is  read  The Patch Code  Advanced  Properties window is used in conjunction  with the physical scanner to stop the scanning process when a patch code is  read  The Patch Code  Advanced  Properties window is explained on the  following page     If you want the Scanner program to create a new electronic document each  time it reads a patch code  the first step is to open the N
152. es image document in Smeadlink     1  Open the Image Viewer utility  as explained in step 1 on the previous  page     2  Now click the row that the desired PC Files image document is attached  to     If you are licensed to use the Smeadlink Imaging module in addition to PC  Files  then the first page of the document will now be displayed in the  Image Viewer  just like a normal image imported into Smeadlink with the  Scanner program or the Import Wizard utility  For more information about  using the Image Viewer to view image documents  see chapter 11     Note  PC Files can index image documents as orphans  The orphan docu   ments can then be viewed with the Manual Indexing utility  just like stan   dard orphan images  For more information about the Manual Indexing util   ity  see chapter 12     344 Chapter 17    Using iAccess and iPublish    iAccess allows you to make your Smeadlink data and attachments available  to authorized users via the Internet  This is done via an iAccess web server  and using the iAccess Configuration Wizard  When you start the configu   ration wizard  you will be prompted to choose the type of configuration   List  Find  or Search  List creates a web page that displays all rows from a  defined top level in the database down  Find allows the user to enter a  primary field and then displays the information that matches the Find crite   ria  Search allows the user to enter one or more fields and then displays all  matching rows     Here s what the iAcc
153. espon   dents     7  Click the Go  button in the lower left corner of the PC Files window     The PC Files window will now close  and a LinkScript window will appear  if the selected LinkScript needs some identification information to index the  document  The exact appearance of the LinkScript window will vary from  LinkScript to LinkScript  The example below shows what a typical Link   Script window looks like     j  aiiidh be  b sH   et 2       340    Chapter 17    8  If the LinkScript you selected has displayed a window like the one shown  on the previous page  then enter the appropriate identification information  in the window for the first document to be indexed  and then click the OK  button at the bottom of the window     PC Files will now index the document in Smeadlink  If you try to attach the  document to a row that already has a PC Files attachment  then a message  window will appear asking if you want to save the document or abort the  procedure  If you choose to save the document  a second window will ap   pear asking if you want to save the document as a new version of the exist   ing document or as an additional page  s  in the existing document     If PC Files cannot find the row that you want the document to be attached to   then it will orphan the document and it will display a message to that effect   Once PC Files has finished the first document  then the LinkScript window  will close and the PC Files window will reappear     9  You will now need to repe
154. ess configuration wizard window looks like     P lkepeees Cenliguimilon Fle         elcome bo ties Access  Configuration wizard    Tiia abia Ded et a ie Cpe er Pe    j Locator     CNP rgeinens F ier rari terme r chy       Users will follow the steps to define the layout of the finished file  Depend   ing on the type of configuration chosen during setup the user will be prompted  to choose the fields to be used for searching  or those fields in the database  that are to be displayed  Once this is accomplished  the user can add an  image of the company logo to the page if desired  and then finally they can  select the color scheme of the site     Once the Configuration Wizard has created the needed files  these can be  placed on your iAccess web server     For more information regarding iAccess and how to use an iAccess web  server in your organization  contact your Smeadlink authorized reseller     Using PC Files 345    iPublish uses iAccess to allow you to publish your data for viewing outside  of Smeadlink  Using data you pre select in the grid  using the techniques  you learned about in Chapter 5   iPublish will create the necessary files  that can be written to a CD so anyone can review the data and attachments     without needing to have Smeadlink     iPublish uses a wizard to help you publish your data  Using the wizard   you can select how to generate iPublish HTML Pages by choosing either  the    Combined    or    Separate    format  The    Combined    format publishes
155. eta tee eea aren Erea ERRET 245  Clip Rectangle to Clipboard isi ssssrsiserresriresrusssrsessrserriisioesesss 246  Using Redlining Edit Mode 00    cece eeeceseeteeeereneceeeaeeneeneens 247  Activating Redlining Edit Mode           ccc ceecceseeceesceeneeereeeees 247  Redlaning Options cist sis iaeeschvessaisensiess estas vets sacatiuestaddarhvousatases 248  Deleting Redlining Objects on an Image    sssr 256  Saving Changes and Exiting Redlining Edit Mode                 257   13  Introduction to Tracking         seesesesssesssesssoossoossoosssosssossssesssee 259  TitrO Wi Ct O10 oy scases casio Ses ck onde ecctas Ss ears ease Be deeavea letseasece 260  Tracking Terms and Concepts           scesssseeceeeeeeneeseeeeeeeeseees 261  Tracking Requirements v  i 0 5ccssises sessions ediansresicstenserntaneees 267   14  Tracking Smeadlink Objects       sesssesssessseossooesoosssossssesssesssoe 269  TMtHOCUCHOM S33 eeaeee ere ea EEE Eee Ee Silkk Eee e EEG 270  Assigning an Object to a Destination        sseseeeerereeeeeeee 270  Assigning Multiple Objects to a Destination 0 0 0    eee 275  Adding Additional Fields to Barcode Tracking               0 278  Setting up the Denso Scanner for Smeadlink 0 0 0    279  Tracking Objects with the Denso Scanner          eeeeeeeeeeee 281   15  Using Smeadlink s Tracking Features             cssssssssseeeee 291  Introduction nase eea erea ME A on ai actiayreiseen  292  Opening the Tracking Viewer ssssrsissiieeeseceitiovsrisrsrecieresvins 293  Viewing
156. ew Document Rule  submenu on the Documents submenu and check the Patch Code option  Now  open the Patch Code Properties window and check the Enable Detection  option  You will also need to specify the distance from the left side of a page  to the center of the patch code on the page  Enter this number in inches in the  box provided  Press ENTER or click the OK button to close the Patch Code  Properties window     Working with Scanner Rules 173    Patch Code Advanced    Selecting Patch Code Advanced on the Image Processing submenu will bring  up the window shown below     Patch Cede Proposes Piudvanced     Detention    FF Enma  Lah Dilsa Te Centar of  lg esac Patch Coc ft 12         Ste  rra        Enable 5ean Siap                               Patch Code Properties  Advanced  window    As you learned on the previous page  the Patch Code Properties  Advanced   window works in conjunction with a physical scanner to stop the scanning  process when a patch code is read     To have the scanning process stop each time a patch code is read  check the  Enable option in the Detection section of the Patch Code Properties  Ad   vanced  window  Now enter the distance from the left side of a page to the  patch code on the page in the appropriate box in the Detection section  If  your scanner has patch code recognition capabilities  you can check the Use  Scanner option  This lets the scanner decide when to stop the scanning pro   cess according to settings made on the scanner itself  The 
157. ewer for the selected ob   ject  The entry will say   Not yet tracked      e If the selected object has been tracked  then you will see one entry for  the object and another entry for the destination that it has been as   signed to  as shown in the example below     Tracking          Entry for selected object  Entry for destination that the object is assigned to    296 Chapter 15    Viewing the Contents of a Destination    This section will show you how to use the Tracking Viewer to display the  contents of a destination  The contents of a destination are all the objects  that have been assigned to that destination  For instance  the contents of a  box might be all the folders that have been assigned to that box     The Contents report is the tool you will use to view the contents of a destina   tion  This section is divided into three parts  the first part explains how to  open the Contents report  the second part explains how to print the Contents  report and the third part explains how to export the data in the Contents  report     To open the Contents report     1  Make sure that an entry for the desired destination is displayed in the  Tracking Viewer     There are two ways to display an entry for a destination in the Tracking  Viewer     e Select the row of the desired destination  just as you select the row of  an object whose tracking status you want to view  After you select the  row of the destination  an entry for it will be displayed in the Tracking  Viewer     OR
158. ewing Images               sccsscccssssecsssecscsesseee 175  TinttO di Ct OM sy  csscsssccecetestevesevseisisbeaneveeveceeeseenest ree evacsansbencteses 176  Scanning IDOCHMENES ie  sccsiseissaxtsenstiv uals  Waesnacaiesiteaveteeseess 177  Using the Scanner s Image Viewer    eeen 183  Reviewing a Bate iope moroso e stdivestisteiide RE eneee OERS 189  Print Setup a isscisex sssessiccesivedevtescintl a hase Savant ha esianesenevees 194  Printing Scanned Document            ccceeecceteeseerenecereeeeeneees 197  BAX  SCUUP evs sesenies ss cccceac resensi ksetra Coord eE VEE ESEESE KESAEN EEEa 199    Faxing an TMA SC eere eeen PEEN EEEE AAR 201    Contents v       Troubleshooting the Scanner  ssssssssssiesivssirvsssresesessesierecsessos 203   11  Using the Librarian Image Viewer   eessoesosssescoesoessessoesossseese 205  Titro dCi sie  fs resres ra aeaaee Er SEESE reeet ERS 206  Opening an Image Document in the Image Viewer                 207  Tia SE VIS WEL OPW ONS x  csebsdseveestenscssuaesiestiescctiustiinatsetveunctees 209  Using Redlining Edit Mode 00    eeceeeeceseeteeeeeeeeecneeeeneeneeas 218   12  Using the Manual Indexing Utility                ecsscssssesssreeseeee 230  Opening the Manual Indexing Utility s es 232  Options on the Manual Indexing Utility s Toolbar                 234  Name of first button on the toolbar      ss  sissespeesrssstsnsnsesasessa 234  Smeadlink Annotations Window            ecceseeceeeeeeeneeereeeeeeeeees 244  PNT OVAULOMS  eerte eare specs te
159. f the column s cells  If the column is a dropdown  then a down arrow  button will appear on the right side of the cell you clicked  If you then click  the down arrow  a menu will appear listing all the current entries in the  parent folder column that the dropdown is attached to     The purpose of dropdowns is to make it easy to set up or modify relation   ships between rows  You can use dropdowns to attach child rows to parent  rows or reattach existing child rows to new parent rows from the child folder  in the parent child relationship  This eliminates the need to go back and  fourth between the parent folder and the child folder when working with  relationships between rows     Dropdowns are dynamically attached to the columns in parent folders that  they pull data from  so when a change is made to the column in the parent  folder  that change will be reflected in the dropdown list  For instance  in the  Doctors and Patients example at the beginning of this section  if a doctor  was added to the Doctors folder then that doctor would immediately become  available on the doctors dropdown in the Patients folder     The following instructions will show you how to use a dropdown to attach a  row in a child folder to a row in a parent folder  You will also learn how to  insert a row in a parent folder from a dropdown     Note  Some columns in Smeadlink contain data from parent folders or child  folders  but the data they contain cannot be modified  These columns are  called loo
160. f time  To make it easier to work with large views   Smeadlink has an automatic search utility called Find that allows you to  quickly locate specific rows in the open view     Find locates rows by matching data that you enter with the data in each cell  of a column in the open view  Once Find locates a cell in the column that  contains data matching the data you entered  it takes you automatically to  that location in the open view s records grid  For instance  suppose you have  a view that contains customer rows  and one of the columns in this view is  called State  Each cell in the State column contains a two digit abbreviation  of the state one of your customers is located in  Now suppose that you want  to look at the row for a customer in the state of Wisconsin  You could enter  the data  WI  into the Find feature  and have it search the State column to  find any cells that contain the data  WI   When Find located the first cell  containing the data  WI   it would automatically take you to that portion of  the records grid     Find can only be used on columns that are sortable and are currently sorted   If a column is sortable but has not been sorted  then Find will sort the col   umn for you  Find requires a column to be sorted before it starts searching   because this streamlines the searching process and makes it as efficient as  possible  The In box contains a pulldown menu which contains a listing of  the searchable fields  In addition  once you locate a row using F
161. features that are available in the module for typical  Smeadlink users     22 Chapter 2    Opening a Smeadlink Program    This section will show you how to open a Smeadlink program  In Smeadlink   the first step in opening a program is to open the Smeadlink start up screen   You can then open other Smeadlink programs  including both end user pro   grams and administrative utilities  from here  The first part of this section  will show you how to open Smeadlink  the second part will show you how to  open other Smeadlink end user programs and the third part will show you  how to open multiple copies of Smeadlink at once     Opening Smeadlink  The following instructions will show you how to open Smeadlink     To open Smeadlink     1  Double click the Smeadlink icon on your desktop  The example below  shows what the Smeadlink icon looks like     P      Smeadlink desktop icon    If you do not have a Smeadlink icon on your desktop  then you will need to  use the Start menu as explained below     e Click once on the Start button  The Start menu will now appear     e Select the Programs command on the Start menu  The Programs sub   menu will now appear     e Select the Smead Software Solutions command on the Programs sub   menu  The Smeadlink submenu will now appear     e Click the Smeadlink command on the submenu     Once you double click the Smeadlink desktop icon or click the Smeadlink  submenu command  then the Smeadlink Login window will appear  The  Login window allows you to s
162. ffix for tracked  objects     This section assumes that the latest version of the Smeadlink tracking pro   gram has already been installed on the Denso scanner you will be using to  track objects  If you are unsure whether your scanner has the current track   ing program on it  then install the tracking program now following the in   structions in the previous section of this chapter     Starting the Denso Scanner    The following instructions will show you how to start the Denso scanner  and enter your operator name  The Denso scanner does not use the operator  name to determine security levels  as Smeadlink does  Instead  it uses the  name to identify who performed the tracking assignments  This can be use   ful information later on     To start the Denso scanner   1  Press the PW button  orange  on the scanner     The Smeadlink main menu will now appear  or the function that was active  when the scanner was last turned off     2  If the main menu is not open  then open it now  To open the main menu   e Press the C button if any function except Total Trx or Operator is open   e Press the ENT button if Total Trx or Operator is open    3  With the main menu open  press the 7 button    4  Enter your operator name in the space provided     Your operator name is not the same as your typical Smeadlink user name  and password  because its only purpose is to identify who performed the  tracking assignments in this session  Typically  the operator name is either  your first and last
163. fication information about the row the image document needs to be  attached to  Ifa LinkScript requires information from the user  it will display a  window prompting you for the required information  Once you enter the  information in the window  the LinkScript will use it to find the desired row in  the open database and attach the current image document to that row     236    Chapter 12    To attach the current orphan image document to a row in the open database  using a LinkScript     Click the Link Using LinkScript button     If the open database contains one LinkScript  that script will now be  automatically executed  However  if the database contains multiple  LinkScripts  a Select Script window will now appear listing all the  LinkScripts in the database  The example below shows what the Select  Script window looks like        Select Script window    Click the desired script in the Select Script window     If you want this script to be run automatically each time the Link Us   ing LinkScript button is selected  i e  if you do not want the Select  Script window to appear   check the Use this action  script  for all  option at the bottom of the window     Click the OK button or press ENTER to execute the selected script     Once the LinkScript begins executing  it will display a window if it  requires some information from the user  The window will prompt  you for any information that the LinkScript requires  The exact ap   pearance of the window will vary from LinkScri
164. file  The Export feature is helpful if you want to export data from  Smeadlink and import it into another program such as Microsoft Word or  Excel  You can export data from any folder or subfolder in a Smeadlink  database  The example on the following page shows an text file with ex   ported data  The file in the example contains seven lines of data  the first  line just lists the name of each column in the exported records grid      Chapter 3    Bl aporti   WondPad    Ee Eel Yisa jii Fora Help    Dieta  SI  a  Hel           Harter A    Harter Wee     1939070    Viewsbles Patent Applirstion    US7TS8S   Datalax Copyright      907974    Sntedlink Patent ipplicarian      I9R606    ULldtile Copyright      NAOT 6   TEN bgCeement    eS bse        COpoecnetic Flanges Petent     ag7oo7e   Herger wireh Office Deptt       For Help  peas FT Srp       A text file with exported data from Smeadlink    All Smeadlink components you have learned about so far in this section are  standard features  Regardless of which optional modules you have purchased  for your Smeadlink system  Smeadlink will have all the components and  capabilities described so far in this section     As you learned in chapter 1  however  you can add additional modules to  your system to enhance the functionality of Smeadlink  These modules con   tain add on utilities that give Smeadlink the capability to perform tasks like  imaging and bar code tracking  The add on utilities are described in the sec   tion for their res
165. filter is only intended for images that have elements  ballooned or blended together  If this filter is applied to images that do  not contain ballooned or blended elements  some of the important data  in the images may be lost        The Light Thicken filter is intended for images that have been deshaded  and despeckled  because using this filter may exaggerate background  noise  Light Thicken does not modify an image as much as the Thicken  filter     e Like the Light Thicken filter  the Thicken filter should only be used on  images that have been deshaded and despeckled  The difference be   tween the two is that the Thicken filter is intended for images that  contain light or thin elements like dot matrix characters     e The Fill Line Breaks filter is intended for images that contain lines   This filter may cause parallel lines separated by one pixel to be merged   so for images that contain parallel lines close together the Fill Line  Breaks and Preserve filter should be used     e The Fill Line Breaks and Preserve filter is similar to the Fill Line Breaks  filter  The difference between the two is that the Fill Line Breaks and  Preserve filter will not merge parallel lines that are close together     e The Outline filter extracts an outline of all image elements  This filter  is useful for applications such as desktop publishing applications     Working with Scanner Rules 171    Line Removal    Selecting Line Removal on the Image Processing submenu will bring up the  wi
166. formation in this section to index electronic documents of  any format  i e  Word  Excel  Notepad  etc    Remember that if you are in   dexing an image document  it will behave just like documents indexed with  the Scanner program or the Import Wizard utility   it will simply be dis   played in the Image Viewer when its row is selected  and there will not be a  shortcut to the program the image was created in     Note  You will need to have at least one PC Files LinkScript in the open  database if you want to index documents in the database with PC Files     To index an electronic document in Smeadlink     1  Open Windows Explorer or My Computer   2  Locate the desired document in Windows Explorer or My Computer     3  Send the document to Smeadlink  There are two ways to send a docu   ment to Smeadlink  Each procedure is explained below     e First  you can drag the document from Windows Explorer or My Com   puter to the Smeadlink shortcut on your desktop  if you have a  Smeadlink shortcut      e Second  you can use the Send To utility  To use the Send to utility  you  will need to make sure that your C  Windows SendTo directory con   tains a shortcut to the Smeadlink  exe file  s135 exe   A shortcut to the  Smeadlink  exe file is automatically created during the Smeadlink in   stallation process  but you may want to check it to make sure it is  pointing to the correct file     Now locate the document you want to index  place your mouse pointer  over it and click the right m
167. ft of the row      e Click the Link to Data button     Note  The Link to Data button will not be available if the Allow Attachments  option is not enabled for the open folder or subfolder  The Allow Attach   ments option is a Manager level feature that can be set from the Database  Map utility     The orphan image document will now be attached to the selected row  Be   cause the image document is attached to a row  it will no longer be an or   phan and it will be removed from the Manual Indexing utility  You will  now able to view the image document with the standard Image Viewer   which is explained in the previous chapter of this manual     Link Using LinkScript    The Link Using LinkScript button allows you to attach the current orphan  image document to a row in the open database  As the name implies  the  Link Using LinkScript button uses a LinkScript to attach the orphan to a row  in the database     LinkScripts are scripts created by the Indexing Wizard  used by the System  Administrator or the technician who installed your Smeadlink system    LinkScripts are used by the Manual Indexing utility  the Scanner program and  the PC Files program to attach image documents to rows  The Link Using  LinkScript button will not be available to you if no LinkScripts have been  created for the open Smeadlink database     LinkScripts are not all identical to each other  Some LinkScripts automatically  attach an image document to a row  whereas others will prompt you for some  identi
168. fy part of the open image     e Click the Magnify button     e Click the upper left corner of the area on the image that you want to  magnify     188    Chapter 10    e Drag the mouse pointer down and to the right so that a box is made that  contains the desired area     e Once the box encloses the area you want to magnify  let go of the  mouse button  The area in the box will now be enlarged to fill the  entire image viewer window     Drag    The Drag feature allows you to move a magnified image around in the Im   age Viewer  This feature only works on magnified images because for nor   mal images you can already see the entire image in the Image Viewer win   dow  To drag a magnified image     e Click the Drag button     e Now move the mouse pointer over the Image Viewer window  press  and hold the left mouse button and drag the mouse in the direction you  want the image to move     Clip Rectangle to Clipboard    The Clip Rectangle to Clipboard feature allows you to clip part of the open  image to the Windows Clipboard  You will then be able to copy the image  piece into a document in another program  To clip part of the open image to  the Windows Clipboard     e Click the Clip Rectangle to Clipboard button     e Click the upper left corner of the area on the image that you want to  copy to the Clipboard     e Drag the mouse pointer down and to the right so that a box is made that  contains the desired area     e Once the box encloses the area you want to magnify  let go of 
169. fying an image does not affect its  indexing  so if an image is attached to a row in Smeadlink it will remain  attached to that row after it has been modified  The following instructions  will show you how to modify a document s image in the Scanner program     Note  The Scanner program cannot modify multi page documents that are  stored as one file  This includes all multi page documents scanned with the  Multiple Page Image File option enabled  If you find that one of the images  in a multi page document was not processed correctly  click a cell in the  document s record to select it and then delete the document by pressing the  Delete key on your keyboard  You can now scan the document in as multiple  files using the normal scanning process explained in the first section of this  chapter     To correct a document that was not processed correctly   1  Click the row of the document that needs to be reprocessed   2  Now select the rule you want the document to be processed with     If there is no existing rule that contains the image processing settings that  you want the document processed with  you can create a new rule or you can  select an existing rule and modify its settings     3  Place the physical document in the scanner if you are using a scan source   or select the desired electronic document if you are using a disk source     4  Open the Scanning menu and click the Modify command  The Modify  submenu will now appear     5  Click the appropriate command for the sou
170. g module includes the Scanner program  the Image  Viewer utility and the Manual Indexing utility  The purpose of the Imaging  module is to give multiple users easy access to a large number of docu   ments  To accomplish this  the Scanner program allows you to scan images  of paper or electronic documents into Smeadlink  As the images are scanned   they can either be automatically attached to rows  or they can be left unat   tached     Once the images have been scanned  they can be viewed in Smeadlink with  the Image Viewer and Manual Indexing utilities  The Image Viewer allows  you to view images that are attached to rows  and the Manual Indexing util   ity allows you to view images that are not attached to any rows  these are  called orphan images      The Scanner program is the main component in the Imaging module  The  Scanner program can scan images of electronic documents on its own  and it  can scan images of paper documents when it is used with a scanner  The first  step in scanning documents with the Scanner program is to specify a rule   The rule is a collection of settings that determines things like what type of  scanner to use  which directory the scanned images will be placed in and  how to modify the images as they are scanned     Typically  you would have a different rule for each type of document that  you want to scan  For instance  suppose you want to scan two types of  documents  accounts receivable documents and accounts payable documents   The accounts re
171. g the Jump To utility  and the  next section in this chapter will show you how to locate rows using the Find  utility     Jump To is a general search utility that you can use to locate a row in any  folder or subfolder in the open database  Jump To locates individual rows  by matching an ID number that you enter with the ID numbers of the rows in  the open database  Jump To now includes several options that you can use to  determine the scope of its search  For instance  you can have Jump To search  just the rows in the open folder  or you could have it search just the rows in  the open workgroup     There are several circumstances where the Jump To utility behaves differ   ently than you might expect  The first circumstance occurs when you search  for a row that is contained in the open folder or subfolder  If the open view  in the folder or subfolder contains a yes no column  and if the rows in the  view have been filtered by this column  then the row you are searching for  will be displayed in the view regardless ofits entry in the yes no column  i e   even if you filtered out all the rows that are not active  the row will still be  displayed in the view if it has a no in the column   When this situation oc   curs  the Jump To row will not be permanently added to the open view   it  will be removed as soon as the view is closed     The second unusual Jump To circumstance occurs when you search for a  row that is contained in a subfolder  When Jump To finds the row  it will
172. ge will now be printed according to the current print settings     Data Output from Smeadlink 119    Fax Setup    Before you can begin faxing images from Smeadlink  you will need to go  through a basic fax setup process  The fax setup process is similar to the  print setup process   it determines the default settings that will be used to  fax image documents  This section explains the fax setup process     Before you can begin the fax setup process  you will need to have a fax  management program such as RightFAX   installed on your computer  You  will also need to have access to a fax machine from your computer  and your  computer will need to be configured so that it can send faxes using that fax  machine  The documentation that came with your fax machine and your fax  management software will tell you how to install the fax machine  and how  to configure your computer so that it can use the fax machine to send faxes     To perform fax setup     1  Click the Fax Setup command on the File menu  The Print Setup window  will now appear as shown below     Sivan Dieta porter Reach  Tre RIPE BP    Coane   Po zj Dmi  i irr  i    ai    E    mse  daie Trae  i C pira       Print Setup window  2  Select the default fax machine for faxing images  To select a fax machine     e Click the down arrow at the right of the Name box to display a list of  the printers and fax machines that are available on your computer     e Click the name of the desired fax machine     The Status  Type  Where
173. ges if they contain less than a certain number of  bytes  To set a delete blank page threshold  check the Threshold option in the  appropriate section and then enter the number in bytes that you want the  Scanner to use as a threshold  Any images that contain a smaller number of  bytes than the threshold number will be discarded     The last section of the Source Properties window is called Options  The first  option in this section is called Prescan  The Prescan option determines how  many images are stored in your Kofax scanner controller during the scan   ning process  If you set Prescan to 0  then during the scanning process no  images will be stored in Kofax except for the image it is currently process   ing  Each document will be scanned  processed and saved to disk before the  next document can be scanned     You can use the Prescan feature to have Kofax maintain a cache of images   or prescans  in addition to the image it is actually processing  This way   the scanner could scan a number of documents uninterrupted and send them  to Kofax for processing  The scanner would then continue scanning docu   ments as they are processed by Kofax  This is a much faster process than  waiting for each image to be processed entirely before scanning the next  document  The trade off is that the more images you have waiting in line in  Kofax  the slower Kofax will be able to work with the image it is currently  processing  To set the Prescan feature  enter the desired number of pres
174. has ever been assigned to  The example below  shows what the History report looks like  The History report in the example  lists five destinations     MA Larder Hakam ni  miben node II Lonnie Li commenti  loa jea Leal  Fere   Te       iaiki leppe ahap Praid    itia o   UAE I umbe angh Popes     ELATLAR   N Pepper Sirpa Forai    NALH Pepi Frbuagpi Harmi          History report    Using the Tracking Features 303    As you can see in the example on the previous page  the rows in the History  report are divided into four columns  Each column is explained below     e The first column is called Transaction Time  Like the Transaction Time  column in the Contents report  this column lists the date and time that  each object in the report was scanned        The second column is the ID column  This column identifies each  destination in the report   it contains the same information that you  would see if you tracked an object to one of these destinations and  then looked at the destination entry in the Tracking Status Viewer     e Further out is a column is called Actual Scan  This column lists whether  the selected object was specifically assigned to this destination  an  actual scan  or whether it was assigned to another object that was  then assigned to this destination  passive scan      e The final column is called Scan Operator  Like the Scan Operator  column in the Contents report  this column lists the Smeadlink user    name of the person who assigned the selected object to thi
175. have a good idea about the capabilities of the Smeadlink Scanner     Note  The number of options available to you on your Sources  Documents   Input Output and Image Processing menus will depend on the scanner and  Kofax scanner controller  hardware or utility you are using with the  Smeadlink Scanner program  Unavailable options will be lowlighted and  you will be unable to select them     Chapter 9    Options on the Sources Submenu    Searing    MEST  ots cigrsscace     Documents    Gorca Propala    lpup EO Fasai Koin Che  Aiba Kois         Sources submenu    Source Properties    Selecting the Source Properties option on the Sources submenu will bring  up the Source Properties window shown below  The options on the this win   dow determine how a document is initially scanned  The difference between  these options and the options on the Image Processing menu is that the im   age processing options determine what is done with images after they have  been scanned according to the source properties settings     FES w po A  E Engich ini ia pe g  ATE    P Pei    ri Cs Trin egn E   Feri  ekis Bri Paga Th        o       P iata    ata  E is  e  Pema p O Tea a A     een    Source Properties window             The top two sections on the Source Properties window are called Front Pick   ing Rectangle and Back Picking Rectangle  These options allow you to de   fine a rectangle on the front or back of scanned documents  The information  inside the rectangles will be processed as usual  b
176. he Edit Bar Codes option is activated  you can edit the bar code  of any document in the records grid using the procedure explained above   Once you have finished editing all the document bar codes in a batch  open  the Scanner folder in the Options window again and click on Edit Bar Codes   This will turn off the Edit Bar Codes feature     194 Chapter 10    Print Setup    Before you can begin printing images from the Scanner program  you will  need to go through a basic print setup process  The print process in the Scan   ner is similar to the print setup process in Smeadlink   it determines the de   fault settings for printing images  i e  which printer to use  which orientation  to print images with  etc    This section explains the print setup process in the  Scanner program     Note  In order to print images from the Scanner program  you will need to  have a printer connected to your computer  You will also need to have the  correct printer drivers installed  The printer drivers are included when you  purchase a printer  and the documentation that comes with the printer will  explain how to connect the printer and install the drivers  This section as   sumes that a printer is connected to your computer  and that the appropriate  drivers for that printer are installed as well     To perform print setup     1  Open the Print Setup window  To open the Print Setup window     e Click the Print Setup command on the File menu  The Print Setup  submenu will now appear as shown i
177. he destination will appear above it in the  tracking diagram  The example below shows what the Tracking window  looks like after a destination bar code has been entered     Tracking status of destination      ee Se A ee       Name of destination    Prompt for object    3  If the destination that you entered in step 2 is an Out destination  then you  will now need to specify a due back date for the object you will assign to this  destination  There are two ways to assign a due back date for an object     e Place the mouse pointer in the Due Back Date box immediately to the  right of the date  Now click the left mouse button once  A blinking  cursor will now appear in the box and the year component of the date  will be highlighted  Delete the current date and type in the desired due  back date     e Click the down arrow at the right of the Object Due Back Date box  A  calendar will now appear as shown in the example on the following  page  You can use the scroll bar at the bottom of the calendar to dis   play dates up to January 1  2029  Click the desired date in the calendar  to specify it as the due back date     Tracking Smeadlink Objects 273      e bee Beco bii pis a       Due Back Date calendar    4  Enter the bar code of the object in the Object section of the Tracking  window  To enter the bar code     e Type the bar code in the Object section of the Tracking window  and  then press the ENTER key or click the OK button     OR    e Scan the bar code with a hand held bar c
178. he scanner you are using  For instance  if your scanner scans images at  200 DPI  you will have 200 pixels in one inch on your scanned images     Scanning and Viewing Images 175    10  Scanning and Viewing Images       Chapter contents    Introduction   Scanning Documents   Using the Scanner s Image Viewer  Reviewing a Batch   Print Setup   Printing Scanned Documents   Fax Setup   Faxing Scanned Documents  Troubleshooting the Scanner    176 Chapter 10    Introduction    The previous chapter showed you how to work with rules in the Scanner  program  You learned how to create a basic rule  and how to use the features  in the Scanner that are available for working with entire rules  You also  learned about all the options that are available in the Scanner for extending  the functionality of a basic rule     This chapter will show you how to use the rule you created in chapter 9 to  scan documents with the Scanner program  In addition to scanning docu   ments  you will also learn how to correct images that were not scanned cor   rectly the first time  and how to view images using the Scanner s Image  Viewer  You will also learn how to print or fax images from the Scanner  program  and how to troubleshoot the Scanner if you are getting errors while  scanning     Note  This chapter assumes that you have already created the rule you want  to use for scanning documents  It also assumes that you have installed a  scanner if you want to scan paper documents  and performed any setup  ne
179. heir images do not have     The automatic annotation feature allows you to make post scan endorsers  work like pre scan endorsers  After a paper document has been scanned with  a post scan endorser  the Smeadlink Scanner program can add the same text  string to the image that the endorser printed on the paper document  This  allows your electronic images to always match the paper documents they  were taken from     Both the automatic endorser and the automatic annotation features work with  the same text string  You specify what the text prefix will say  how the final  text string will appear on the page and how the counter will operate  The  endorser and annotation features then either print the text string on the paper  document  add it the scanned image or both  Using both features at once  means that your electronic images will always match the paper documents  they were taken from     The first step in using the automatic endorser annotate feature is to specify  what the text prefix will say  In the Text Definition section of the Automatic  Endorser Annotation Properties window  enter the desired text prefix in the  Prefix box  The remaining text and font options determine how the final text  string will appear on the page  The Top and Left options in the Text Defini   tion section determine where the text string will be placed  The Top setting  specifies an offset from the top of the image  and the Left setting specifies an  offset from the left side of the image  Enter
180. ields are setup on the Application Properties window in Database  Map  Below is an example of this screen     fees    Pcie   kagal Hemi Heyer        lihr Deere  Dirge Dn    Te  rgids bajn F  iring ija at    Heme er Po  Bierma fea fi eels He  iiie lemig  ir    feet Dancap Rasai  Pe T ariii  seed ga  Bm       On the Tracking tab in the Additional Tracking Data area is where you  setup additional fields  You can add a one line Text Box  a Selection List or  a Suggestion List  where you can either type in the desired information  or   pick from a selection list   In the example above  we are adding a one line  text box to capture who received the object being tracked  i e   which nurse  picked up the patient s file    even though the file may have been tracked to  a doctor   To make this field a Selection or Suggestion list  one would  chose the appropriate radio button option     Instead of the one line Text Box  one can add a many line text box  or  memo field  A memo field allows you to type free form text regarding the  object being tracked  For instance  to capture delivery instructions regard   ing the object     Once setup and filled in during Bar Code Tracking  these fields print on  tracking reports  as well as display in the Smeadlink Tracking Viewer    when data is present in those fields     Tracking Smeadlink Objects 279    Setting up the Denso Scanner for Smeadlink    The previous two sections in this chapter showed you how to track Smeadlink  objects with the Track
181. ill show the file s status and all requests for the file  as in the  example        A          rawn hap i baap Mae  larn    kea aera ei mi       308    Chapter 15    Ifa user in possession of the file has completed their work  they can transfer  the file to other users  By choosing the Transfer button  on the Smeadlink  menu bar  they can click and check to see who is next in priority to receive  the file  then transfer the file to the next user     Tee ai fie  lomo  a   eins     aae Taa   caa         Note  Smeadlink can also be set up to allow or not allow multiple requests  for one file   depending on your needs  In addition  Smeadlink can restrict  users to only be able to request items from certain locations  These options  are setup in Application Properties in the Database Map by the System  Administrator     Using the Tracking Features 309    Running the Past Due Tracked Objects Report    As you learned in the previous chapter  whenever an object is assigned to an  Out destination  the object will need to have a due back date assigned as  well  The due back date is the date the object needs to be back to its perma   nent destination  The Past Due Tracked Objects report allows you to view  any objects that have not been returned to their permanent destinations by  their due back dates     This section will show you how to run the Past Due Tracked Objects report  from Smeadlink  It is divided into three parts  the first part explains how to  open the Past Due Tracked Obj
182. ilter window     Note  The following instructions assume that you are familiar with the con   cept of using parentheses to adjust order of operation  and the concept of  using the logical operators AND and OR to adjust argument relationships    To use the Filter window s advanced features   1  Click the Advanced Features check box on the Filter window     The Advanced Features check box is located in the lower right corner of the  Filter window  as shown in the example below        Advanced Features check box    The advanced features will now be added to the Filter window  The example  on the following page shows what the Filter window looks like with the  advanced features      Viewing Rows in Smeadlink 89    Left parentheses box for a filter line  Right parentheses box for a filter line    Active check box for a filter line       Apply Filters check box    OR option for a filter line  AND option for a filter line    2  A small  empty box should now be displayed in the upper left and upper  right corners of each line in the Filter window  The box on the left side of  each filter line can contain any number of left parentheses  and the box on  the right side of each filter line can contain any number of right parentheses   By entering left and right parentheses into these boxes in standard paren   thetical order  you can adjust the order that the filters in the Filter window  will be applied to the open view     3  Typically  the parentheses boxes are used together with the l
183. image document  You can determine how many  pages are in the open orphan image document by looking at the Page Num   ber window on the Manual Indexing Viewer s toolbar  The Page Number  window is the seventh option on the toolbar     The third filter category is RecordTypelD  The record type Id is a number  between   and 5 that determines the type of an orphan image document    is  for documents scanned with Smeadlink Imaging  2 is for documents received  by fax  3 is for ERM  formerly known as COLD  documents and 5 is for PC  Files documents  there is no document type associated with 4   For further  information about filtering  see the section Filtering Rows in a View in chapter  5 of this manual     Using the Manual Indexing Utility 239    Previous Orphan    The Previous Orphan button allows you to view previous orphans in the  open database   Previous  in this situation means an orphan image docu   ment with a trackable Id number one less than the trackable Id number of the  current orphan  For instance  if the current orphan image document in the  Manual Indexing utility has a trackable Id number of 52  then clicking the  Previous Orphan button once will open the orphan that has a trackable Id  number of 51  clicking it again will open the orphan with an Id of 50  etc    remember  the trackable Id number of the current orphan in the Manual  Indexing utility is displayed in a bar at the top of the image      In general  the Previous Orphan button allows you to cycle back 
184. imary sorted col   umn in a view  but you can have any number of secondary sorted columns     For instance  suppose you have a view in an Employees folder that has one  column for the employee s first names and another for their last names  If  you perform a primary sort on the Last Name column  the employee rows  will be sorted according to their cells in that column  However  if three of  your employees have the same last name  Smeadlink will sort this group of  rows in a random order  You could perform a secondary sort on the First  Name column to keep the primary sort order and perform an additional sort  on the three employee rows with the same last name  You can perform any  number of secondary sorts  so if two of the customers in the example above  had the same last name and the same first name  you could perform another  secondary sort by something like middle initial  This section will show you  how to perform both primary and secondary sorts in Smeadlink     Note  Not all columns in Smeadlink are sortable  As you learned in chapter  3  each view in Smeadlink is based on a table of records in your Smeadlink  database  and it can also contain columns from other tables in the database   Ifa view contains columns from other tables in your database  you will not  be able to sort those columns in the open view     Note  Not all columns in Smeadlink are sortable  You can easily see if a  column is sortable by looking at the name of the column in the column header   If the 
185. in Bae Y Irra Doce  IVER TINIE Piim Fie Sod  Draing brvi Digi  M T Piim Fide U   formas Oriy  MYNET Poi  a Feii UL Torea  earum  TLC mi Potten Feie Z Cowen rag beyem Lamar  PUGET Tim fiii biie L Laimi   a mi  Breti Piisi Fim 1  ieai Faad  MW iia Rike T besiis aT  DTS ed Piim Fame J ieii ger  Piet TA Piip 7 emai Pan    r  E     E          E       Expanded Contents report    As you can see in the example above  the columns in the expanded Contents  report are not all the same as the columns in the standard Contents report     e The first column is called Transaction Time  Like the Transaction  Time column in the standard Contents report  this column lists the  date and time that each object in the report was scanned     e The second column is the type of object being reported  just like the  first column in the standard Contents report      e The third column is the ID and description of the content     e The fourth column is called Actual Scan  This column lists whether  each object was specifically assigned to this destination  an actual  scan  or whether it was assigned to another object that was then as   signed to this destination  passive scan      e The last column is called Scan Operator  Like the Scan Operator col   umn in the standard Contents report  this column lists the Smeadlink  user name of the person assigned each object to this destination     300 Chapter 15    To print the Contents report     1  Click the Print button at the bottom of the Contents window  A s
186. in part of  an image  or you could use it to rotate an image  The example below shows  what the toolbar looks like in the Manual Indexing utility s window     ee ee ee ee       OE C hey etd poe Brn    beor      Sh bt eon  steam    CERERILE toa  E  a          Manual Indexing utility s toolbar    The toolbar in the example above contains two lines of buttons and options   Depending on the size of your window  the buttons and options on your  toolbar may be divided into a smaller or larger number of lines  This section  lists each option on the Manual Indexing utility s toolbar  and explains how to  use it to work with orphan image documents     Note  To view the name of an option on the Manual Indexing utility s tool   bar  place your mouse pointer over the desired option for a few seconds   The name of the option will then be displayed under the option in a beige  box  as shown in the example below        Mamualindeseg  S F to    Ras      an SSUES aS ee  Name of first button on the toolbar    Using the Manual Indexing Utility 235    Link to Data    The Link to Data button allows you to attach the current orphan image docu   ment in the Manual Indexing utility to a row in the open folder or subfolder   As you learned earlier  this process is called manual indexing  To attach the  current orphan image document to a row in the open folder or subfolder     e Select the row you want to the orphan to be attached to  remember  to  select a row simply click the gray box at the very le
187. in the Patch  Codes  Advanced  window to work with any bar codes it finds     The Limits section of the Bar Code Properties window is very straightfor   ward  If a bar code does not meet the minimum characters limit it will not be  read  Similarly  if the number of bar codes on a page or line exceeds the  specified limits  the additional bar codes will not be read     The Quality option allows you to customize your scanning process for the  best balance between scanning speed and scanning quality  If your bar codes  are often missing several elements  setting the Quality feature to Poor will  cause the scanner to pass over bar codes more often than normal during the  scanning process  This increases scanning accuracy and quality  If your bar  codes are mainly of high quality  setting the Quality feature to Good will  cause the scanner to pass over bar codes fewer times than normal during the  scanning process  This will allow the scanner to scan and correctly read bar  codes faster than it normally would  Finally  the Normal setting is intended  for bar codes of average quality     164    Chapter 9    The Checksum feature allows you to determine if a checksum is required on  all bar codes to be recognized by the Scanner program  a checksum is a  group of digits added to the end of a bar code that tell whether the bar code  is valid or not   When the Checksum feature is selected  any bar code with   out a valid check sum will not be recognized by the Scanner program     The Se
188. ind  you  know that any other rows with similar data in the Find column will be in the  same area of the records grid     For instance  in the example  Find was used to locate the row for a customer  in Wisconsin  If the open view contained several rows for customers in Wis   consin and the rows were not sorted according to state  then Find would  search through the column and take you to the first matching row  Mean   while  the other rows for customers in Wisconsin could be scattered through   out the records grid and you would not see them  Requiring the Find column  to be sorted means that once you locate a row  any other rows with similar  data will be in the same section of the records grid  This section will show  you how to use Find to locate rows in the open view     78    Chapter 5    To locate rows in the open view using Find     1  The first step in using Find is to specify what you want Find to search  through  Remember that Find can only be used on sortable columns  which  are columns with underlined names  To specify which column to use in the  search  chose a column from the  In  dropdown menu  If the rows in the  open view are not currently sorted by the column you selected  Find will  now automatically sort them for you     2  Begin entering data into the Find box  which is the box immediately  above the  In  dropdown menu     As you enter data  Find will compare the data that you enter to the data in  each cell of the selected column and take you to the row
189. indow or if it has indexed the documents automatically  a message  will appear once all the documents have been indexed to let you know that  the process has been completed  Click the OK button on the message box   The box will now close and you will be finished indexing your documents     Using PC Files 337    Indexing Multiple Documents with Multiple LinkScripts    The previous section showed you how to index multiple documents at once  with one LinkScript  This section will show you how to index multiple docu   ments at once using a separate LinkScript for each document  You can use  the information in this section to index electronic documents of any format  in the open database  Remember that if you are indexing image documents   they will behave just like documents indexed with the Scanner program or  the Import Wizard utility   each one will simply be displayed in the Image  Viewer when its row is selected  and there will not be a shortcut to the pro   gram the image was created in     Note  The first six steps in this section are the same as the first six steps in  the previous section  because the processes explained in these two section  are very similar  The information is repeated in this section so that you do  not have to flip back and fourth between pages     To index multiple documents with multiple LinkScripts     1  Open Windows Explorer or My Computer   2  Locate the desired documents in Windows Explorer or My Computer     3  Send the documents to Smeadlink
190. ine and then fill in the options with the desired settings  As each  new filter is created  Smeadlink will assign it a number for identification  purposes  The number of each filter is displayed in the top left corner of the  filter s line     If you create more than five filters  a vertical scroll bar will appear on the  right side of the Filter window to allow you to view each filter that has been  created for the open view  The example below shows what the Filter win   dow looks like with multiple filters in it  The Filter window in the example  contains three filters                          Multiple filters in the Filter window    When multiple filters have been created for a view  Smeadlink applies the  filters in order starting at the top of the Filter window  Any rows that pass the  first filter are filtered by the second filter  Any rows that pass the first and  second filters are then filtered by the third filter  and so on     Viewing Rows in Smeadlink 87    Removing Filters from a View    After you have created one or more filters for a view and used the view in its  filtered state  you may eventually want to remove the filters and return the  view to its original state  The following instructions will show you how to  remove filters from a view     To remove one or more filters from the open view   1  Click the Filter option on the Tools menu to open the Filter window     2  There are two features on the Filter window that allow you to remove  filters     e First
191. ing Citation Codes  Using Destruction Reports       314 Chapter 16  Introduction    This chapter will show you how to use the Smeadlink Retention Module   The Retention Module has been added to assist users in managing records   and especially in the removal of records from the database and from file  storage     The first section in this chapter will explain the basic concepts for using  Retention  This section should give you a basic idea about what the Reten   tion Module looks like and how it is used  The next two sections will show  you how to use the Retention Module and the Citation features  and will  explain the Destruction Reporting features     Note  For a summary of the Retention module and its function in your  Smeadlink system  see the sections Retention Module and About Your  Smeadlink System in chapter 1     Introduction to Retention 315    Retention Concepts    The Smeadlink Retention Module has been added to enhance records man   agement and especially the removal of records no longer required to be kept  on file  The Retention feature allows users to set up Retention Codes for  documents in the database which determine how long a document has been  active or inactive in the file system  These documents may need to remain in  the database as well as in their respective file folders for a certain length of  time as determined by industry or government regulations  Now Smeadlink  users will be able to automate the management of these files by setting up  and c
192. ing program  You learned how to assign both single  and multiple objects to a destination in the Tracking program  The next three  sections in this chapter will show you how to track Smeadlink objects with  the Denso BHT 6000 portable scanner  This section will show you how to  set up the Denso scanner for Smeadlink  the next section will show you how  to track objects in the Denso scanner and the last section will show you how  to upload tracking information from the Denso scanner to Smeadlink     Before you can begin using the Denso scanner with Smeadlink  you will  need to make sure that the latest Smeadlink tracking program is installed on  it  This section will show you how to install the Smeadlink tracking pro   gram  The procedure explained in this section can be used if you are install   ing the Smeadlink tracking program on the Denso scanner for the first time   or if you are merely installing a newer version of the tracking program   Once you have installed the tracking program on your Denso scanner  then  you can begin using it to track Smeadlink objects     To install the Smeadlink tracking program on the Denso scanner     1  Open the Tools menu from Smeadlink s main menu bar   2  Click the Options command on the Tools menu     The Options window will now appear as shown below  The Smeadlink folder  will be open in the Options window  because it was opened from Smeadlink       Dema   DON Pete   WP Cire Cerei   Pamir T     T Mdai e Gwp hoh    Lijeni ivag pieri fake
193. ink can also track various citations used in the file system by associ   ating these citations with Retention Codes  Citation Codes will be set up  separately for each citation used  and will spell out the legal time periods  necessary for storing the associated record or physical file  Citation Codes  and their maintenance will also be discussed in Chapter 16     18    Chapter 1    PC Files Module    The PC Files module allows you to index electronic documents of any for   mat in Smeadlink  For instance  you could use PC Files to index a Microsoft  Word document or an Excel spreadsheet  When you use PC Files to index a  document  PC Files creates a copy of the document  keeping the document  in its native format  and then attaches the document copy to a row     Any Smeadlink user on your network can then open Smeadlink  locate the  row that is associated with the document and then use that row to open the  document in the program it was written with  For instance  if you used PC  Files to index a Microsoft Word document  then any Smeadlink user on your  network could open the document in Word from Smeadlink  The example  below shows what the PC Files program looks like        PC Files    Smeadlink   PC FILES    Choose what you would like to do with this PC File   then click  Go         Files to Process  C  Documents and Setti     Billings Checklist doc    Folders   HR Employees  Invoices  Packing Slips  Purchase Orders         Use this action  script  for all PC Files in thi
194. inms  Binim im   m Cui   Sinir ben hemet  Fe  Timire Bre Bei Li       Once the records manager has approved all records on the report for de   struction  by printing the report and reviewing each line   they can click  the Destroy button  which in turn creates a Certificate of Destruction Re   port     Certificates of Destruction Report     This report provides an audit trail for  those documents that have been approved for destruction  From here  the  records manager can use the Delete Attachments button to physically and  permanently destroy all records and associated data  such as tracking in   formation and attachments   including images and PC files      Note  records and all data destroyed using the Delete Attachments button  are permanently destroyed and cannot be recovered  Please exercise  extreme due diligence when using this option     On Hold Report     Displays records that have been suspended from the de   struction process  pending further review  Records can be placed on reten   tion hold by locating the record in Smeadlink  choosing Retention Informa   tion on the Right Click submenu  and placing a check mark in the Item On  Hold box  The type  and notes regarding the hold can also be entered     Introduction to Retention 321    Inactive Records Report   This report reflects all records not in Inactive  Storage that have passed the inactivity date     Citations Report     List of current Citations that are in the system     Retention Codes Report   List of cu
195. inted on  it will not show you how  the data will be displayed in each label     10  Once you have set all the options on the Smeadlink Label Printer win   dow  click the OK button to start the actual print process     Data Output from Smeadlink 127    Exporting Rows    The Export command on the File menu allows you to export selected rows  from the open view to a standard  comma delimited text file  This is helpful  if you would like to export some of your Smeadlink data and then import it  into another program such as Microsoft Word or Excel  You can export  rows from any view in the open Smeadlink database     To export selected rows from the open view   1  Select the rows that you would like to export     By default  the Export command will export each row in the open view  If  you would like to only export certain rows in the view  then select the de   sired rows now  To select a row     e Click the row selector of the desired row     The row selector is the gray box at the far left side of each row  Once you  click a row selector  the entire row will become highlighted to indicate that it  is selected  You can select multiple rows at once by holding down the CTRL  key while you click the desired row selectors     2  Click the Export command on the File menu     A Smeadlink window will now appear as shown below  This window tells  you how many rows will be exported  and it asks if you want to continue the  exporting process     Chemo Smecdink Libeaian BE       Smeadlink 
196. inter     e When the line is the correct length and in the correct position  click the  left mouse button once  The line will now turn red to indicate that it is  finished     e As you drag the mouse pointer away from the end of the first line  a  black line will be drawn that is attached to the end of the first line   When this second line is the correct length and in the correct position   click the left mouse button once  This second line will now turn red to  indicate that it is finished     Using the Manual Indexing Utility 251    e When you drag the mouse pointer away from the end of the second  line  a black line will be drawn that is attached to the end of the second  line  When this third line is the correct length and in the correct posi   tion  click the left mouse button once  This line will now turn red to  indicate that it is finished     e Continue this process until you have finished drawing your shape     e When you reach the end of the last line  click the right mouse button  once instead of the left mouse button  The last line will now turn red  and your shape will be completed  The example below shows what  several polyline shapes look like     ee O OOO To oen a  AATOO   En nmm   catia    amo t gir  RE eo            Ten e aE i    palim hya a oe ee    First polyline shape  Second polyline shape    252    Chapter 12    Polygon    Like the Polyline button  the Polygon button allows you to draw shapes  made up of lines connected end to end  The difference betw
197. inter button on the toolbar       Now position the mouse pointer over the area on the image where you  want the head of the pointer to be  hold down the left mouse button  and drag the mouse pointer  The head of the pointer will be drawn as  soon as you click the left mouse button  and the line of the pointer will  be drawn as you drag the mouse pointer     e Let go of the left mouse button when the line is the correct length and  in the correct position     The example on the following page shows what several pointers look like in  the Image Viewer     224 Chapter 11         se s ee ae  Ga ea ee er Cp aE    eee ee          A pointer on an image    Freehand    The Freehand button allows you to draw  freehand  on the image in the  active viewer window  Drawing freehand means that you do not have to  draw a predetermined shape   you can draw any type of line or shape or  curve  To draw freehand on the image in the active viewer window     e Click the Freehand button on the toolbar       Now position the mouse pointer over the area on the image where you  want to start drawing  hold down the left mouse button and drag the  mouse pointer to create the desired line  curve or shape     e Let go of the left mouse button when you have finished drawing the  first object     e You can draw any number of additional objects using the same proce   dure you used to draw the first one     Using the Image Viewer 225    Text    The Text button allows you to type text on the image in the activ
198. inter you  specified in step 2  click the Properties button to the right of the Name box     A standard Windows printer window will now appear that you can use to  adjust specific settings on your printer  The example on the following page  shows what a Windows printer window looks like for the OKIPAGE 8c  printer  Once you have set the options on this window to the desired settings   click the OK button to save your changes and close the window     Data Output from Smeadlink 111    Pacer asta   Cee ym   Paaie      Aare         Windows printer window    4  If you are going to be printing on a nonstandard paper size or if you will  be printing from a different printer tray than Tray 1  select the appropriate  Size and Source options  To change the Size or Source settings     e Click the down arrow at the right of the option s text box  A dropdown  will appear listing the available sizes or printer trays     e Click the desired item in the dropdown  The dropdown will now close   and the item you selected will appear in the option s text box     5  If you would like your Smeadlink documents to print in landscape mode   check the Landscape option under Orientation     The image to the left of the two Orientation options will now change to  reflect how data will be printed on each page     6  Once you have set all the options on the Print Setup window to the desired  settings  click OK or press ENTER to save the setup information  The Print  Setup window will now close and you wil
199. ion about separator sheets  see Basic  Imaging Concepts in chapter 8     7  You are now ready to start the actual scanning process  The options on  the Scan submenu and the tool bar will differ according to whether the rule  you selected uses a disk source or a scan source     e If you are scanning documents from a disk source  open the Scanning  menu now and click Scan  Now click the Start Disk Processing com   mand on the Scan submenu     e If you are scanning documents from a disk source  open the Scanning  menu now and click Scan  Now click the Start Scanning command on  the Scan submenu     Note  In addition to using the Scan submenu to start the scanning process   you can also use the Scanner s toolbar  To do so  click the Start Disk Pro   cessing or Start Scanning button on the toolbar  Both buttons are located at  the far right side of the toolbar     Scanning and Viewing Images 181    8  If the selected rule specifies a LinkScript  and if the LinkScript requires  you to enter some identification information after each image is scanned   then it will display a window after it scans each image for you to enter the  required information  The example below shows what a typical LinkScript  window looks like        A typical LinkScript window    The Scanner will now start to scan in documents from the specified source   The Scanner will process the documents according to the current rule set   tings  As each page of a document is scanned  its image will be displayed in  th
200. ion to viewing the tracking status of an item  the Tracking Viewer also  allows you to view two different reports for the items in the tracking diagram   The Contents report displays all the objects that have been assigned to a  destination  and the History report displays all the different destinations  that an object has been assigned to  You can open either of these reports by  clicking an item in the tracking diagram and selecting the appropriate com   mand on the popup menu that appears  The example below shows what the  History report looks like     Ai Dania spe at F his la o eae  OPH iegeect  i Taree  bem     J   Lasai tipo i  i meee Cees Peli    J bargan Dared Pleo   1    Mbt bere Leine Land oh hie    Hmmm bil magi Brai      Lipsa  as glaia  T iem Lee de   HI  Laspan Cereal aya  T Lickin Coir eee 1  Temp bleh Berend         History Report in Smeadlink    Introduction to Tracking 267    Tracking Requirements    Smeadlink Tracking will only track objects and destinations that are already  in your Smeadlink database  So for example  if you entered the bar code of a  file folder that was not in your Smeadlink database  it would not be recog   nized by the Tracking program  In order to use Tracking  your Smeadlink  database needs to be set up so that each object and destination you want to  track is in the database and has a unique identification number     If you have several levels of trackable items  i e  folders  boxes  shelves   rooms  warehouses   your database will 
201. is section to move any  number of the view s columns     To move a column in the open view     1  Click the column header of the desired column  and hold down the left  mouse button     The column header is the top cell in the column  and it contains the column s  name  or heading  The example below shows what a column header looks  like in Smeadlink        a0 Senet pa tlie  e   ee    A column header in Smeadlink    2  Drag the column left or right to the desired position in the open view     The column will now be displayed in the new location  and the other col   umns in the view will be repositioned accordingly     82 Chapter 5    Filtering Rows in a View    Sometimes when you are working in a view  you will want to adjust which  rows are displayed in the view s records grid  For instance  if you are work   ing ina view that contains employee document rows  you might want to see  all the document rows for a certain employee  You can easily adjust which  rows are displayed in the open view by using one or more filters  Each filter  in Smeadlink is made up of three different parts   a column name  an opera   tor and some criteria  The column name specifies which column in the open  view the filter will search through  The operator and criteria then specify  what type of data the cells in the selected column need to have in order for  their rows to pass the filer and be displayed in the view     Going back to the example in the paragraph above  suppose a view contains  employ
202. its original size  click the  Fill Viewer with Image once  The magnified image will now be resized so  that it fits entirely in the viewer window     Fit to Width    The Fit to Width button allows you to resize the image in the Manual Index   ing utility so that the width of the image takes up the entire width of the  viewer window  Fit to Width works the same with both magnified and  unmagnified images  To resize the current image so that it takes up the en   tire width of the viewer  click the Fit to Width button once     Using the Manual Indexing Utility 241    Zoom    The Zoom feature allows you to resize the entire image in the Manual In   dexing utility  This is different than the Magnify button  which only allows  you to resize a certain part of an image  The Zoom feature is also different  than the Magnify button because it allows you to shrink an image as well as  enlarge it  To resize the current image using Zoom  click the down arrow at  the right of the Zoom window  A dropdown will now appear listing differ   ent percentages  The example below shows what the Zoom window and the  Zoom dropdown look like     Zoom window                         Zoom dropdown    Each percentage in the Zoom dropdown is relative to the size of the original  document  So if you select 100   for instance  you could view the docu   ment at the size it was originally scanned  Now click one of the percentage  options in the Zoom dropdown  Once you click a percentage  the image in  the Manual
203. k the left mouse button once  This line will now turn red to  indicate that it is finished     e Continue this process until you have finished drawing your shape     e When you reach the end of the last line  click the right mouse button  once instead of the left mouse button  The last line will now turn red  and your shape will be completed  The example below shows what  several polyline shapes look like in the Image Viewer           A polyline shape in the Image Viewer    Using the Image Viewer 223    Polygon    Like the Polyline button  the Polygon button allows you to draw shapes  made up of lines connected end to end  The difference between these two  features is that each shape that you draw with the Polygon button must de   fine a bounded area  In other words  the beginning of the first line in the  shape must be connected to the end of the last line     This is different than the Polyline button  which does not require a shape to  define a bounded area  If you do not connect the ends of a shape that you  create with the Polygon button  they will be automatically connected for  you  Apart from this difference  you create shapes with the Polygon button  exactly like you create shapes with the Polyline button     Pointer    The Pointer button allows you to draw  pointers  on the current image  A  pointer in the Image Viewer is like an arrow   it is made up ofa straight line  with a small triangle on the end of it  To draw a pointer on the current image     e Click the Po
204. kScript in the PC Files window  then  PC Files will start the process of indexing the selected document  First  PC  Files will create a copy of the document and save it in a Smeadlink directory  on your network  Smeadlink directories are specified in the Directory Set   tings program  which is an administrative utility   PC Files will then either  attach the document copy to an existing row in the open Smeadlink data   base  or it will create a new row in one of the database s folders and attach  the document copy to the new row     If the selected LinkScript is going to attach the document copy to an existing  row  then you may need to enter some identification information so that PC  Files can find the correct row  Typically  PC Files uses Id numbers to iden   tify different rows in Smeadlink  If PC Files requires some identification  information before it can index the selected document  then it will automati   cally display a LinkScript window after you select the LinkScript in the PC  Files window     Using PC Files 327    The PC Files LinkScript window is very similar to Smeadlink workflow  windows and the Scanner LinkScript window  The PC Files LinkScript win   dow will have labeled boxes on it for you to enter the required information   and it may also have a viewer on it so you can view the selected document  and fax or print it  The exact appearance of the LinkScript window will vary  from LinkScript to LinkScript  The example below shows what a typical  LinkScript 
205. kups  when they contain data from a parent folder  and lookdowns   when they contain data from a child folder   The information in lookups  and lookdowns is for reference purposes only  as it cannot be modified     102    Chapter 6    To attach a child row to a parent row from a dropdown     1  Click the cell in the dropdown column of the desired child row  A down  arrow will now appear on the right side of the cell     2  Click the down arrow     The dropdown list will now appear underneath the selected cell  At the top  of the list  you will see a heading for the column the dropdown is pulling  data from  Underneath the heading  you will see all of the current entries in  that column  Every other entry in the list will be have the same background  color as the rows in its parent folder  The example below shows what a  dropdown list looks like  The list in the example is pulling data from a col   umn called Billing Attorneys  and it currently contains five attorneys     B  F abet  Dard   Fastar  Dara                  Dropdown list    3  Click the entry on the dropdown list of the row in the parent folder that  you want to attach the selected child row to     The dropdown list will now close  and the entry you selected will appear in  the cell the dropdown list was opened from     Note  If the Suggestion Only option is enabled for the dropdown column   then you will be able to see the dropdown list but you will not be able to  select an item on it and have the item automatica
206. l be finished with the print setup  process     Note  Remember that if you will be printing both reports and images from  Smeadlink  you will need to go through the print setup process twice   once  for each type of document     112 Chapter 7    Printing Reports    Areport is a printout of one or more rows from a view  There are two types of  reports that you can print from Smeadlink  basic reports and formatted re   ports  Basic reports are pre formatted  i e  they do not require any setup by  you or your Smeadlink administrator   Formatted reports  on the other hand   are completely customizable  For instance  they can include data from one  or more subfolders in the open view  Formatted reports are created with  Smeadlink s Report Generator  which is an administrative utility  so they can  only be modified by users with Manager level access rights     Basic reports and formatted reports are both printed using the Print com   mand on Smeadlink s File menu  When you print a basic report or a format   ted report for the open view  the data in the view s rows is arranged into  labeled columns on the page or pages of the report  Each report can be at  most one page wide  so the Librarian will only print as many columns in the  report as it can fit horizontally on one page     If you print a report for a view that has either very wide columns or a large  number of columns  then your report will probably not include all the col   umns in the view  In this type of situation  you m
207. labels  the labels would be printed on the partially used page starting  at label 6     7  The next three options on the Smeadlink Label Printer window are read   only options   they cannot be modified by the user     e The Labels option tells you the total number of labels that will be printed   This number will either be the number of rows in the open view  or the  number of selected rows in the view     e The Pages option tells you how many  pages  the labels will be printed  on  The Pages option is only relevant for stock types that contain mul   tiple labels on each sheet     e The Skipped option only applies if there is not sufficient data to print  some of the labels in the open view  for instance  if another user opened  the view after you and deleted some rows that you are trying to print  labels for   If there is not sufficient data to print one or more labels   then Skipped will tell you how many labels will not be printed     8  The Draw Label Outlines option allows you to specify whether or not you  want a black outline printed around each label  This option is only appli   cable for printing black and white labels     9  The last option to set on the Smeadlink Label Printer window is Preview  Data  This option allows you to use the label preview to see how the data  will appear in your labels  If this option is not selected  the label preview on  the right side of the Smeadlink Label Printer window will only display the  shape of the stock your labels will be pr
208. ld be separated into  fields  To create a break line     e Place your mouse pointer over the desired break line position on the  tuler above the sample data  and click the left mouse button once  A  break line will now appear over the sample data  If you need to move  the break line  simply click it and drag it to the desired position  If you  need to remove a break line  simply double click it     You will need to create break lines for five or six fields  Location  Object   Scan Date  Operator  the Transmit Code  T and  if set  the Due Back Date     10  Click the Next button at the bottom of the second Import Wizard win   dow  The third Import Wizard window will now appear as shown below     t Grpnrt Wizard  Dan       Third Import Wizard window    288 Chapter 14    11  In the Destination box at the top of the third Import Wizard window   select the  lt  lt TRACKING IMPORT gt  gt  option     12  Map the fields in the Available Fields box to the Selected Fields box in  the order shown in the example on the previous page  To map a field     e Click the desired field in the Available Fields box     e Click the single right arrow button between the Available Fields and  Selected Fields boxes  The field will now appear in the Selected Fields  box     e You can move a field in the Selected Fields box by clicking it and then  clicking the up or down arrow keys to the right of the box     13  Click the Tracking Date field in the Selected Fields box  and then click  the Properties bu
209. ld the left mouse button and drag the mouse in  the direction you want the image to move     Mode   Clip Rectangle to Clipboard    The Clip Rectangle to Clipboard mode allows you to copy any part of the  image in the active viewer window to the Windows Clipboard  You can  then paste the image data into another program such as Microsoft Word  To  copy part of the image in the active viewer window to the Windows Clip   board  click the Clip Rectangle to Clipboard option on the Mode submenu   Now create a rectangle around the portion of the image that you want to  copy  just like you do when you use the Magnify button  When you let go of  the left mouse button after creating the rectangle  the data inside the rect   angle will be sent automatically to the Windows Clipboard     218 Chapter 11    Using Redlining Edit Mode    Redlining Edit Mode allows you to edit any image that is displayed in the  active viewer window  When you click the Redlining Edit Mode button  a  new option will be added to the Image Viewer s submenu that contains a  number of editing options  You can use these features to edit any image in  the viewer with text  lines or shapes  As the name implies  all the objects  that you add to an image will be red     This section is divided into four parts  The first part explains how to acti   vate Redlining Edit Mode  the second part explains each Redlining feature   the third part explains how to delete Redlining objects on an image and the  fourth part explains ho
210. left corner of the  Filter window     e The check box for activating or deactivating each filter line is called  Active  and it is located in the lower right corner of the filter line   When one or more filters has been marked inactive  they will not be  applied to the open view when you click the OK button on the Filter  window     Viewing Rows in Smeadlink 91    Reloading a View    As you learned earlier  none of the features explained in this chapter are  permanent  When you close Smeadlink after modifying a view by sorting   filtering or any other feature explained in this chapter  the view will return  to the state it was in when it was last saved     Sometimes when you are working in Smeadlink  you may want to restore a  view to its original state without closing the program  For instance  you may  use a very specific filter to locate a small group of rows in the open view   Once you finish using the filtered view  you may want to return the view to  its original state  You can easily restore an open view in Smeadlink to its  original state by reloading it  This section will show you how to reload a  view     To reload the open view   1  Open the Tools menu from Smeadlink s main menu bar     2  Click the View Settings command on the Tools menu  The View Settings  submenu will now appear as shown below     Task    E Directoy Seinge    O fauiy Mansger   E Daaba Ha   T   Clatabarie oski   taf Label Manage    E  Cocker Blew abel Integrator  fa Data Dacin    TH meot      BES
211. les in the appropriate boxes of the Correction section  Both options  are specified in degrees  Once you have set the minimum and maximum  skew angles  press ENTER or click the OK button to save the changes you  have made     Despeckle    Selecting Despeckle on the Image Processing submenu will bring up the  window shown below        Despeckle Properties window    The options on the Despeckle Properties window allow the Scanner to re   move speckles from scanned images  A speckle is a group of black pixels  surrounded by white pixels or a group of white pixels surrounded by black  pixels  The Scanner can remove black or white speckles     The basic procedure for removing speckles is to enable the Scanner program s  speckle removal capabilities and then to define the maximum size of the  speckles you want removed  To enable the speckle removal feature  check  the Enable option in the Removal section  To define the maximum size of  the speckles you want removed  enter the maximum speckle height and width  in the appropriate boxes  Once you have entered the speckle size settings   press ENTER or click OK to save the changes you have made     Working with Scanner Rules 169    Image Filter Properties    Selecting Image Filter Properties on the Image Processing submenu will  bring up the window shown below        Image Filter Properties window    The options on the Image Filter Properties window allow the Scanner to  enhance line edges  smooth characters and remove background noise
212. lick the plus button on  the far right of the parent folder header     Moving Around in Smeadlink 61    Opening a View    Each Smeadlink folder or subfolder can have multiple views  Each view is a  different way of looking at the data in the folder or subfolder s table  This  section will show you how to open a view  You can use the information in  this section to open a view in any folder or subfolder in the open database     Note  For a detailed definition of a view  see the section Basic Smeadlink  Terms in chapter 3     To open a view   1  Open the View menu from Smeadlink s main menu bar     The View menu lists the different viewing items that are currently open in  Smeadlink  The second to last section of the View menu lists all the views  that have been created for the open folder or subfolder  A check mark will  appear to the left of the view that is currently open  The example below  shows what the View menu looks like  The View menu in the example dis   plays the two views that have been created for the open folder  starting with  one called Clients     View         Attachments  Manual Indexing    Vv Navigation Bar  Search Bar    Switch to Form view    IV 1Clients  2 Clients   AZ    Current views in the open folder  2  Click the name of the desired view on the View menu     The view you selected will now appear in the open folder or subfolder  The  name of the view will appear in parentheses to the right of the folder or  subfolder s name  displayed in its top left 
213. line button allows you to draw any number of  polyline  shapes  A  polyline shape is any shape made up of lines that are connected to each other  end to end  The difference between a polyline shape and a polygon is that  the beginning of the first line and the end of the last line do not have to be  connected to each other on a polyline shape like they do on a polygon  In  other words  a polyline shape does not have to define a bounded area  To  draw a polyline shape     e Click the Polyline button on the toolbar     e Now position the mouse pointer over the area on the image where you  want the shape to start  click the left mouse button and drag the mouse  pointer in the desired direction  A black line will be drawn as you drag  the mouse pointer     e When the line is the correct length and in the correct position  click the  left mouse button once  The line will now turn red to indicate that it is  finished     e As you drag the mouse pointer away from the end of the first line  a  black line will be drawn that is attached to the end of the first line   When this second line is the correct length and in the correct position   click the left mouse button once  This second line will now turn red to  indicate that it is finished     222 Chapter 11    e When you drag the mouse pointer away from the end of the second  line  a black line will be drawn that is attached to the end of the second  line  When this third line is the correct length and in the correct posi   tion  clic
214. lly entered into the column   In this case  the dropdown list is for reference purposes only  and you will  need to type the desired entry into the column     Editing Rows in Smeadlink 103    To add a new parent row from a dropdown column     1  Click a cell in the dropdown column  A down arrow will now appear on  the right side of the cell     2  Click the down arrow     The dropdown list will now appear underneath the selected cell  as explained  in step 2 on the previous page     3  Press the INSERT key on the keyboard     The Add a Row window will now appear  This window will contain a box  for each column in the view the dropdown is pulling data from  Columns  that are filled in automatically  like counters or Smeadlink counters  will be  grayed out  The example below shows what the Add a Row window looks  like  The window in the example is for a parent view that contains two col   umns  Id and Name  The Id column is an automatic counter  so it is grayed  out        Add a Row window    4  Type the desired information into the boxes on the Add a Row window   5  Click the OK button or press ENTER     The Add a Row window will now close  and a new row will be added to the  parent folder the dropdown is pulling data from  The cells in the row will be  filled out according to the data you entered in the Add a Row window     104 Chapter 6    Deleting Rows    The Delete Rows command on the Rows menu allows you to delete rows  from the open view  You can delete rows one by one f
215. lock win   dow will now appear     e Press the 2 button to enable lock destination  The lock or unlock win   dow will now close  and you will return to the Options menu     e From the Options menu  press the C button to return to the main menu     Tracking Smeadlink Objects 283    2  If the first destination you will be assigning objects to is an Out destina   tion  then enter the due back date now for this destination  To enter the due  back date     e From the main menu  press the 6 button  The Options menu will now  appear     e From the Options menu  press the 3 button  The due back date box will  now appear     e Enter the desired due back date in mm dd yyyy format   e Press the ENT button to return to the Options menu     3  If the object or objects you will be assigning to the first destination has a  prefix or suffix  then enter the desired prefix or suffix now  To enter the  prefix or suffix     e From the main menu  press the 6 button  The Options menu will now  appear     e From the Options menu  press the 4 button  The Prefix Suffix window  will now appear  This window contains a prefix box and a suffix box     e Enter the desired characters in the prefix box  following the same method  you used in starting the scanner to enter your operator name     e Press the F6 button after you have entered the desired prefix  to move  to the suffix box     e Enter the desired characters in the suffix box  following the same method  you used in starting the scanner to enter yo
216. meadlink system is installed  the latest version of each Smeadlink  program can be downloaded from the Smeadlink website shown below     Website  www smeadlink com    Introduction to Smeadlink    1  Introduction to Smeadlink       Chapter contents  Introduction  About Your Smeadlink System  New Features in Smeadlink  Smeadlink Modules    6 Chapter 1    Introduction    This chapter will introduce you to Smeadlink  You will learn about all the  basic components that make up a Smeadlink system  and you will learn about  all the different end user modules that are available in Smeadlink  By the  end of this chapter  you should have a good basic idea about what compo   nents make up a Smeadlink system and how they all work together     Once you have been introduced to Smeadlink in this chapter  then chapter 2  will show you how to open Smeadlink  You will learn the general procedure  that can be used to open any Smeadlink program  including both end user  programs and administrative utilities  Chapter 2 will also explain some gen   eral features that all Smeadlink programs have in common  For instance   you will learn how to set Smeadlink general options  which can be used to  remember information about previous Smeadlink sessions     After you finish chapter 2  you will know how to open any Smeadlink pro   gram  The remaining chapters in this manual are divided up into sections     one for each end user module that is available in Smeadlink  Terms and con   cepts that you will ne
217. mple on the following page shows what a sorted view looks like in  Smeadlink  The view in the example is in the Client folder  and it is called  All Clients Sorted by Name  The rows in this view have been sorted accord   ing to the Client Name column in ascending order     Viewing Rows in Smeadlink 73    COUTTS       A sorted view in Smeadlink    Performing a Secondary Sort    The following instructions will show you how to perform a secondary sort  on a view in Smeadlink  Secondary sorts are only applicable to views that  have been sorted with a primary sort  Using a secondary sort allows you to  sort rows that have identical data in the column that was used for the pri   mary sort  You can perform any number of secondary sorts in a view     To perform a secondary sort on the open view     1  Locate the column in the view that you want to sort by  and place your  mouse pointer over that column s column header     2  Hold down the CTRL key on your keyboard and click the left mouse  button once to sort in ascending order  or twice to sort in descending order   The affected rows will now be sorted according to the data in the secondary  sort column     74 Chapter 5    Using Jump To to Locate a Row    There are two main search utilities  the Jump To utility and the Find utility   Each of these utilities has a different searching range  and together they al   low you to find rows in any folder or subfolder in the open database  This  section will show you how to locate a row usin
218. multiple rows  in the child folder  and the child folder can only be opened after a row in the  parent folder has been selected  When the child folder is opened  it displays  all the rows it contains that are attached to the selected row in the parent  folder     For instance  a medical office might have a parent folder called Doctors and  a child folder called Patients  The Doctors folder contains one row for each  doctor that has ever practiced medicine at the office  and the Patients folder  contains one row for each patient that has ever been to the office  The Doc   tors and Patients folders are set up in a parent child relationship  so that each  doctor row can be attached to the rows of that doctor s patients     When a new patient comes to the office  a row will have to be created for  that patient and attached to the appropriate doctor row  The standard way to  do this would be to find the row of the patient s doctor in the Doctors folder   and then open the Patients subfolder from that row  A row for the new pa   tient could be added to the Patients subfolder  and it would then be attached  to the appropriate doctor     This standard method for creating and attaching rows works well as long as  there are not many child rows that need to be created and attached  If there  are many child rows  then this method is not very efficient because it re   quires a lot of going back and fourth between the parent folder and the child  folder  i e  you would need to find the app
219. n Bar will now appear in the main Smeadlink window  The  Navigation Bar cannot be placed in different positions in Smeadlink s main  window   it is always placed on the left side     The example below shows what the Navigation Bar looks like  The Naviga   tion Bar in the example contains six workgroups including Records  Track   ing and HR  The Tracking workgroup is currently open  and it contains  three folders called Locations  Employees and Boxes  Smeadlink is ready  for the user to choose which folder they want to open        Navigation Bar    56 Chapter 4    Opening a Folder    The previous two sections in this chapter showed you how to open and set  up the Navigation Bar and the Search options  This section will show you  how to use the Go menu to open a folder in Smeadlink  There are several  ways to open a folder in Smeadlink  and this section will show you each  method     When you first open Smeadlink  you will see the first workgroup in the  open database  Depending on which start up settings are activated  one or  more of the Smeadlink utilities may also be open on the sides of the open  folder  If the Navigation Bar is open  then it will display the workgroups in  the open database and the folders in the open workgroup  The example  below shows what Smeadlink looks like immediately after being opened        Smeadlink program immediately after being opened    Once you open Smeadlink  it should look similar to the example     The rest of this section will show you 
220. n for the new rule  To enter the identifi   cation information     e Type a name for the new rule in the New Rule ID box     4  Press ENTER or click the OK button on the New Rule Creation window   The New Rule Creation window will now close     140 Chapter 9  5  Select a source for the new rule  The source will specify where the im   ages come from that will be scanned with this rule  To specify a source     e Open the Scanning menu from the menu bar  and click the Sources  command  The Sources submenu will now appear     e Click the Select Kofax Configured Source command on the Sources  submenu  The Select Kofax Configured Source window will now ap   pear as shown below     Select kolan Configured Source     F ni 5 pivana hoot Sounce  no maga processing    Camel      Select Kofax Configured Source window       e Click the down arrow in the middle of the Select Source window to  display a list of available sources     e Click the desired source to select it   e Once you have selected a source  press ENTER or click the OK button     Sources are configured outside the Scanner program with the Kofax Source  Manager utility  As you learned in chapter 8  part of installing a Kofax Adrena   line scanner controller is configuring a source  The guide that came with your  Kofax hardware will show you how to configure a source  If you have not  done this yet  you will need to exit the Scanner program now and configure a  source before you can finish your rule  A message will appear whe
221. n the example below       Ee    G   Open Database  Cirle   nse Databaze    d  Pin       Print Setup submenu    e Click the For Image Printing command on the Print Setup submenu   The Print Setup window will now appear as shown on the following    page     Scanning and Viewing Images 195    Prot Shug        Pasis o E       Print Setup window    2  The first option on the Print Setup window is Name  This option deter   mines the default printer for printing images  To select the default printer     e Click the down arrow at the right of the Name box to display a list of  printers that are available on your computer     e Click the name of the desired printer to select it  The Status  Type   Where and Comment options underneath Name will now be filled in  according to the printer you chose     3  If you would like to adjust printer specific settings for the printer you  specified in step 2  click the Properties button to the right of the Name box     A standard Windows printer window will now appear that you can use to  adjust specific settings on your printer  The example on the following page  shows what a Windows printer window looks like for the OKIPAGE 8c  printer  Once you have set the options on this window to the desired set   tings  click the OK button to save your changes and close the window     196    Chapter 10    Prope   Kisuahuen   Denice  pins   Patten   yarn            i   Eea Aiie     A i baaie F f line  Pye pa daha Tii 6  Paper tyre  Ar  el    i ojo ooe   faae
222. n view the previous or next image in the document by clicking  Previous Page or Next Page     Fill Viewer with Image    The Fill Viewer with Image feature automatically adjusts the size of a mag   nified image so that the entire image fits in the Image Viewer window  This  restores the image to its original size  To restore a magnified image to its  original size     e Click the Fill Viewer with Image button     The image that is currently in the Image Viewer will now be resized so that  it fits entirely in the Image Viewer window     Fit to Width    The Fit to Width feature allows you to resize the open image to the width of  the Image Viewer  Depending on the height of the image  it may not fit  vertically in the Image Viewer after it has been resized  To resize the open  image to the width of the Image Viewer     e Click the Fit to Width button     The open image will now be resized so that it takes up the entire width of the  Image Viewer     Scanning and Viewing Images 185    Zoom    The Zoom feature allows you to resize the entire image in the Image Viewer   This is different than the Magnify button  which only allows you to resize a  certain part of an image  The Zoom feature is also different than the Mag   nify button because it allows you to shrink an image as well as enlarge it  To  resize the image in the Image Viewer     e Click the down arrow at the right of the Zoom window     A dropdown will now appear listing different percentages  Each per   centage in the Z
223. n you are  exiting the Scanner that asks if you want to save the changes you have made  to the rule  Click Yes so you can reopen the Scanner later and pick up right  where you left off     6  Set the output settings for the new rule  To set the output settings     e Open the Scanning menu and click the Input Output command  The  Input Output submenu will now appear     e Click the Output Settings command on the Input Output submenu   The Select Output Settings window will now appear  Click the Add  button to display the Output Settings window     Working with Scanner Rules 141       Output Settings window    e Enter the required information  including a name for this new Output  Settings  one or two characters that will be used as the output file s  prefix  the extension for the output file and finally the next number to  be used in the file s name     e The Output Volume option determines what directory the images  scanned with this rule will be saved to  To specify an image output  directory  click the down arrow at the right of the Output Volume box  to display a list of available directories  Now click the desired direc   tory  Once you have selected an image output directory  press ENTER  or click the OK button  The Output Settings window will now close     7  Click the Select button to select the new Output Setting     Note  The image output directories available in the Scanner are specified  with the Directory Manager  which is a managerial level Smeadlink pro   gram  
224. nces menu  place the cursor  over the desired option and click the left mouse button once  The menu will  now close  You can make sure the option was activated by opening the Pref   erences menu again  A check mark will appear to the left of the option if it  has been turned on  You can turn an option off by clicking it again to remove  the check mark  In the example below  the Smeadlink Bar  Save User Name  and Save Database Name options are turned on     Accessing the General Options    The following instructions will show you how to access the Smeadlink gen   eral options  You can use these instructions to access the general options  from any Smeadlink program     To access the general options from a Smeadlink program   1  Open the Tools menu from the program s menu bar     2  Click the Options command on the Tools menu     Opening a Smeadlink Program 29    The Options window will now appear  The folder that is open in the Options  window will be determined by what Smeadlink program you opened it from     3  Click the General tab on the Options window  The General Folder will  now open as shown below     Fa Options     Hena  COM Prats    MS Olioa Connected   Srenadtink 1      5 hiatus  PO Feine pen airos ion Shartup  D Aene liss Manes on 5 baru  D Fethore Posteo on Siaip   T Spd Neirssk Mami ar  Whit Hama   T fterpt Adcinate  Lagin     T Monia in laisk on Staap E running when hadorn      Monitor inpoi  on Shartup  il running ehen shuid     D Aie Epot Column Headers    E Sh
225. ndexing utility s toolbar  and they allow you to edit  images in the viewer with lines  shapes or text  As the name implies  all  redlining objects are red     Note  The Manual Indexing utility is very similar in both form and function  to the Image Viewer  so this chapter is very similar in both layout and con   tent to chapter 11     232 Chapter 12    Opening the Manual Indexing Utility    The Manual Indexing utility can be used to view any orphan image docu   ment in the open Smeadlink database  This section will show you how to  open the Manual Indexing utility  and adjust its position in the main Smeadlink  window     To open the Manual Indexing utility     To open the Manual Indexing utility  click on the View menu  then choose the  Manual Indexing option     After you perform the steps above  the Manual Indexing utility will appear     fia cecr a EET       Manual Indexing utility    Using the Manual Indexing Utility 233     This page intentionally left blank     234 Chapter 12    Options on the Manual Indexing Utility s Toolbar    The previous section in this chapter showed you how to open the Manual  Indexing utility  This section will show you how to use the options on the  Manual Indexing utility s toolbar to work with orphan image documents     The toolbar is located at the top of the Manual Indexing utility  and it allows  you to open different orphan image documents in the utility and manipulate  them  For instance  you could use the toolbar to zoom in on a certa
226. ndow shown below     F pube F T  ie   birani lorg bht w i Maes E    bigas Hirap torent fo H n Ee  Em  Hamam fresh mti E BE  Lip Cer laoa pmke po E ip Gaan Faim jaah   E  Homia hasia hanmi  Veica Chacie hamro   F Enhe    iriran Eagar Hagha  fi E Maar sbi H E  Hanga parahia  O E on a e mia m g    Lo  a    Line Removal Properties window       The options on the Line Removal Properties window allow you to have the  Scanner remove unwanted horizontal or vertical lines from scanned images   These options also allow the Scanner to reconstruct characters after lines  running through the characters have been removed     To have the Scanner remove horizontal lines on scanned images  check the  Enable option in the Horizontal section of the Line Removal Properties win   dow  The remaining options in that section should now become available   Enter the minimum length and maximum height for the lines to be removed  in the appropriate boxes  In the Maximum Break box  enter a number for the  longest series of white pixels that the Scanner can encounter and still con   sider it part of the line  In the Edge Clean Factor box  enter a number for the  maximum number of pixels on the edges of a line that the Scanner program  will remove along with the line itself     To have the Scanner remove vertical lines on scanned images  set the op   tions in the Vertical section of the Line Removal Properties window the  same way that you set the options in the Horizontal section     To have the Scanner p
227. ng session to one destina   tion  and Hold Destination Detect Change is for when you have several des   tinations and you would like to assign multiple objects to each one     3  Enter the bar code of the first destination you would like to assign objects  to  You can do this in one of three ways      e Type the bar code of the Destination and click the OK button     e Pick the destination by clicking the       button to the right of the  Destination section     e Scan the bar code with a hand held bar code reader  such as the Welch  Allyn SCANTEAM 3400 or the Symbol Technologies Spark     276    Chapter 14    The name of the destination will now appear in the tracking diagram on the  right side of the Tracking window  An icon will appear at the left of the  destination that corresponds with the folder that contains the destination row  in Smeadlink  A question mark will also appear below the destination that  you entered  The question mark is a prompt indicating that the Tracking  program is now waiting for you to assign an object to the destination     If the destination that you entered is a container that has a tracking status of  its own  then the tracking status of the destination will appear above it in the  tracking diagram     4  If the destination that you entered in step 3 is an Out destination  then  you will now need to specify a due back date for the objects that you will  assign to this destination  There are two ways to assign a due back date for  an object   
228. nk Program    Opening a Smeadlink Program 21    Introduction    As you learned in chapter 1  Smeadlink is a modular software system  This  means that your Smeadlink system is made up of a number of individual  programs  As a typical Smeadlink user  you will probably be using Smeadlink  on a regular basis  and you may also use other end user programs like the  Scanner program or the Tracking program     This chapter will show you how to open a Smeadlink program  All Smeadlink  programs are opened with the same basic procedure  so you can use the  information in this chapter to open any program in your Smeadlink sys   tem   including both end user programs and administrative utilities  This  chapter will also explain some general features that all Smeadlink programs  have in common  For instance  you will learn how to use Smeadlink general  options  which can be used to remember information about previous  Smeadlink sessions     Once you have gone through this chapter  you will know how to open any  Smeadlink program  The remaining chapters in this manual are divided up  into sections   one for each end user module that is available in Smeadlink   Terms and concepts that you will need to know in order to use a module are  explained in the introductory chapter of that module s section  Any optional  hardware that can be used with the module will also be listed and explained in  the introductory chapter  The remaining chapters in the section will then  explain how to use all the 
229. nk with multiple images attached to  them     To define a document in the Scanner  click on the desired New Document  Rule options  You can select more than one option if you want  If you do  select more than one  a document would only have to pass one of the se   lected criteria to be considered a Scanner document     Save Duplicates    Selecting the Save Duplicates option on the Documents submenu will bring  up the submenu shown below       cecum  Detaull Linktip   Hew Document Aue    Sy     Hew Venton       Save Duplicates submenu    The Save Duplicates options determine what the Scanner does with dupli   cate documents  A duplicate document situation arises when the Scanner  tries to attach a document to a row that already has a document attached to it   The New Page option adds the second document to the first  creating one  new document  The New Version option attaches the second document as a  new version of the first  Smeadlink has tools that allow you to view all  versions of an attached document      156 Chapter 9    Options on the Input Output Submenu    Input Output menu      Selecting Disk Source Input Settings from the Input Output submenu will  bring up the window shown below           Disk Source Input Settings       Disk Source Input Settings window    The two main sections on the Select Disk Source Input Settings window are  called Folder Selection and Include Exclude files  The Folder Selection sec   tion is a required setting if you are using a disk source
230. nt to skip this chapter and go straight  to chapter 14  Otherwise  reading this chapter should give you a good basic  understanding of what the different components in the Tracking module  look like and how they function     Note  For a summary of the Tracking module and its function in your  Smeadlink system  see the sections Tracking Module and About Your  Smeadlink System in chapter 1 of this manual     Introduction to Tracking 261    Tracking Terms and Concepts    This section will introduce you to the terms and concepts you will need to  know in order to use Smeadlink Tracking  The first part of this section ex   plains basic Tracking terms  and the second part explains basic Tracking  concepts     Basic Tracking terms    The two terms that are used most often in Smeadlink Tracking are object and  destination  An object in Smeadlink Tracking is an item that you want to  monitor the location of  and a destination is the location of an object  For  instance  suppose you want to use Tracking to monitor the location of a file  folder that you just put into a box  The object in this example would be the  file folder  and the destination would be the box     Some items may be objects or destinations  depending on the situation  These  items are called containers  For instance  in the example in the paragraph  above the box is considered a destination  If you stored the box on a shelf   though  and used Smeadlink Tracking to monitor the location of the box   then Tracking would
231. o  type text on the image in the active viewer window  The only difference  between the two is that once you finish typing text in a Note rectangle  the  rectangle will not disappear  Instead  the text in the note will change from  black to red just like it does with the Text button  and the rectangle that  contains the note will turn yellow     Apart from this difference  you can create a note for an image using the  exact same process that you use to type text on an image  The example on  the following page shows what a text object and a note object look like on an  image     226    esis      via Seer eer oe eae    Highlight    A note on an image         Apam          6 STRIE m   i i 2    Text on an image    Chapter 11    The Highlight button allows you to highlight any area on the current image  by drawing a yellow rectangle over the area  The area under the rectangle  will then appear to be highlighted  To highlight an area on the current im     age     e Click the Highlight button on the toolbar     e Now position the mouse pointer over the area on the image where you  want the highlighting rectangle to start  hold down the left mouse but   ton and drag the mouse pointer diagonally in the desired direction  As  you drag the mouse pointer  a highlighting rectangle will be drawn on    the image        Let go of the left mouse button once the rectangle is the desired size  and is in the desired position  The rectangle will now turn yellow     The new highlighting rectangle 
232. o read  you can make it  larger by selecting a higher Zoom percentage     e Press the DELETE button on your keyboard to delete the computer   generated text  and then begin typing in your desired text     The text you type in will automatically wrap when it reaches the right  border of the rectangle you drew  but you can press the ENTER button  on the keyboard if you want the text to start on a new line before it  reaches the right border  You will be able to type any number of lines  in the text rectangle  because the window will be expanded if you reach  the lower border and you continue typing     e Once you have finished typing  place the mouse pointer somewhere  outside the text rectangle and click the left mouse button once  The  text rectangle will now disappear  and the text inside it will change  from black to red to indicate that it is finished     Note    The Note button is very similar to the Text button  in that it allows you to  type text on the current image in the Manual Indexing utility  The only dif   ference between the two is that once you finish typing text in a Note rect   angle  the rectangle will not disappear  Instead  the text in the note will change  from black to red just like it does with the Text button  and the rectangle that  contains the note will turn yellow  Apart from this difference  you can create  a note for an image using the exact same process that you use to type text on  an image  The example on the following page shows what a text o
233. ode reader  such as the Welch  Allyn SCANTEAM 3400 or the Symbol Technologies Spark     The name of the object will now appear in the tracking diagram underneath  the destination that you entered earlier  A new tracking prompt  question  mark  will also appear at the top of the tracking diagram  The prompt indi   cates that your transaction was completed  and that the Tracking program is  now waiting for the next destination to be entered  The example on the fol   lowing page shows what the Tracking window looks like after you enter the  bar code of an object     274    Chapter 14    Prompt for next destination       mon Me pis E      lii  bairr   sarna Semm pom FE    Th mri ieem    iraa Hee dOP    Name of object    This section showed you how to assign one Smeadlink object to one  Smeadlink destination  You can use the procedure explained in this section  to assign as many objects to destinations as you want  Each time you assign  an object to a destination  the previous transactions in the tracking diagram  will scroll down and the new transaction will be displayed at the top     Note  If you assign an object to a temporary destination  or container  and  you then assign the container to another destination  the Tracking program  will automatically update the location of the object in the container     Tracking Smeadlink Objects 275    Assigning Multiple Objects to a Destination    The previous section showed you how to assign one object to a destination   In actual practic
234. oding the various requirements  then simply applying the codes to the  files     Further discussion of how to set up and maintain Retention codes will be  covered in the next section     Smeadlink can also track various citations used in the file system by associ   ating these citations with Retention Codes  Citation Codes will be set up  separately for each citation used  and will spell out the legal time periods  necessary for storing the associated record or physical file  Citation Code  maintenance will be discussed in the next section        a Smeadlink 1  Smeadlink Express  Vemo       Fis View Go Tools Rows Retention Reports Add Ins    Window Halp               x    E Retention Code Mairtenance  Navigation    Records      Citation Mantenance  C    ae Ei ie  act  J O0007   Viewe  Hr  r ule Typ                    i Lecuyer Ipes       316 Chapter 16    Using Retention Codes    Users will need to set up Retention codes for Smeadlink records by openi ng  the Retention Code Maintenance window     1  Choose Retention from the Smeadlink main menu     2  Click Retention Code Maintenance and you will see the window open as  in the example     Eetention Lede Haini enii E    ACDOUKTMG  AMIN itd 5 ALE Caled Peg   ACDOURTING    CAPITAL PROPERTY   ACDOURTIMG   GEMEFAL   ADMIN ET RATION  IH TERMAL SERVICES   ADHINGT RATION   FLAH RGF ORCAS TING   ADMIN TILATION  PADPDATY HAMARE HENT  ADMIN B TRATION   PROPERTY HAMACE HEMT COWS TF    ADHINA TRATION   POLES PACED LARS  SDHING TRATION   P
235. ogical opera   tors AND and OR to adjust how the filters in the Filter window will be  applied to the open view     e To establish an AND relationship between two consecutive filter lines   select the AND option in the first line     e To establish an OR relationship between two consecutive filter lines   select the OR option in the first line     As an example of using parentheses and logical operators  suppose you were  working in a view that contained client rows and you wanted to see all the  rows for clients in the cities of Anchorage  Alaska and Birmingham  Ala   bama  You could accomplish this task by using four filters  The example on  the following page shows how the four filters would be set up in the Filter  window     90    Chapter 5       Using parentheses and logical operators in the Filter window    4  Sometimes when you are working with filters  you may want to keep a  filter but not apply it to the open view  In other words  you may not want to  delete a filter  but you want to see what the open view looks like without the  filter being applied to it  The Filter window has an option called Active that  allows you to do just that     The Active option includes a check box for activating or deactivating all the  filters in the window at once  and individual check boxes for activating or  deactivating each filter line in the window     e The check box for activating or deactivating all the filters at once is  called Apply Filters  and it is located in the lower 
236. older and the subfolders are often referred to as child folders   This relationship between the parent folder and child folders is called a par   ent child relationship  We will be using this terminology later on in discuss   ing components in Smeadlink   because it is more standard than folder and  subfolder     The example below shows what a folder looks like in Smeadlink  The folder  in the example is called Client  and it contains rows for the different clients  in a company    Name of open Smeadilink folder       Rows in open Smeadlink folder    40    Chapter 3    Row    A row is one line of data in a Smeadlink folder  Each row contains a group of  related values  For instance  each row in a customer folder could contain a  name  a phone number and an address for one customer  Rows are some   times called records  The example below shows what a row  or record  looks  like in Smeadlink           A row in Smeadlink    Note  From this point forward  this manual will always use the term  row   in place of the term  record      Cell    Each row in Smeadlink is made up of one or more cells  Each cell contains  one of the data values in the row  For instance  if a row in a customer folder  contained a customer name  an address and a phone number  then that row  would contain three cells  The first cell would contain the customer s name   the second cell would contain the customer s address and the third cell would  contain the customer s phone number  The example below shows wh
237. omatic annotat   ing means that the Smeadlink Scanner program will add a short text string to  images after they have been scanned  Both endorsed and annotated text strings  are permanent     160    Chapter 9    The text string used by the automatic endorser annotation feature is made up  of a text prefix and a counter value  For instance  suppose you specify a text  prefix of  ACME Inc  and a counter value of 1  and then you scan 10 single   page documents  The text string for the first document would be  ACME  Inc 1   and the text string for the next nine documents would be  ACME Inc  2  through  ACME Inc 10   The Scanner program allows you to specify  what the text in the text strings will look like and where it will be placed on  the page  You can also specify how the counter will operate     In order to use the automatic endorser feature  you will need to have a scan   ner equipped with an endorser  There are two basic types of endorsers  pre   scan endorsers and post scan endorsers  Pre scan endorsers print the text  string on paper documents before they are scanned  Post scan endorsers print  the text string on paper documents after they have been scanned  The main  difference between pre scan and post scan endorsers is that the scanned im   ages from pre scan endorsers match the paper documents they were scanned  from  Because post scan endorsers scan paper documents and then print text  strings on them  the paper documents have an endorsed text string on them  that t
238. omatically be activated  The Select button  allows you to select any red text block  line or shape that has been added to  the current image  You can then reposition the red object on the image  or  delete it from the image altogether by pressing the DELETE button on your  keyboard  To select an object     e Make sure the Select button on the toolbar is activated     e Place your mouse pointer over the desired object and click the left  mouse button once     Small  white handles will appear around the object after you have  clicked on it  to indicate that it is selected  You can select multiple  objects at once by holding down the SHIFT key on your keyboard  while you click each object  The example below shows what two se   lected red objects look like in the Image Viewer  The red objects in the  example are rectangles     J      aro l ee E  ie A dea r  i Svea       A selected red object in an image    220 Chapter 11    Line    The Line button allows you to draw any number of lines on the current  image  To draw a line on the image     e Click the Line button on the toolbar     e Now position the mouse pointer over the place on the image where  you want the line to start  hold down the left mouse button and drag  the mouse pointer in the desired direction  As you drag the mouse  pointer  a line will be drawn on the image     e Let go of the left mouse button once the line is positioned correctly and  is the correct length     The new line will be automatically selected once y
239. onpermanent changes to the program   Editor allows you to edit tables or rows in the program and Manager allows  you to make permanent changes to the program   s appearance or default  settings     The purpose of this manual is to explain how to use the modules and features  that are available in Smeadlink when you login with the standard Guest or  Editor user names  This includes everything a typical user will use in  Smeadlink  This manual assumes that you have a basic knowledge of Win   dows   based programs  but it does not assume that you have any prior  knowledge of records management software     2 Introduction    The second Smeadlink manual is called the System Administrator s Guide   The purpose of the System Administrator s Guide is to explain how to use the  administrative utilities that are available in Smeadlink when you login with  the standard Manager user name  This includes all the tools needed for setup   maintenance and repair of your Smeadlink system  The System Administrator s  Guide assumes that you have a basic knowledge of Windows based programs  and networking  but it does not assume that you have any prior knowledge of  records management software     Installing Smeadlink    This manual and the System Administrator s Guide both assume that your  Smeadlink system has already been correctly installed  Smeadlink systems are  typically installed by Smeadlink authorized resellers or dealers  The dealer  who installs your system should be the one who sold 
240. oom dropdown is relative to the size of the original  document  So if you select 100   for instance  you could view the  document at the size it was originally scanned     e Click one of the percentage options in the Zoom dropdown     Once you click a percentage  the image in the active viewer window  will be resized to the corresponding height and width  The percentage  you selected will also be displayed in the Zoom window     Lock Zoom    When you resize an image using the normal Zoom feature  the Zoom per   centage you selected will only be applied as long as the original image is  displayed in the Image Viewer  If you bring up a different image in the  Image Viewer  either a different page in a multi page image document  a  different version in a multi version image document or an altogether differ   ent image document  then the Zoom percentage you selected will be dis   carded  The new image will be displayed in the Image Viewer using Fill  Viewer with Image     The Lock Zoom button allows you to keep the specified Zoom percentage  and use it to view any number of different images in the Image Viewer   When Lock Zoom is enabled  you can bring up different pages  different  versions and different image documents in the Image Viewer  and each im   age will be displayed using the same Zoom percentage  To enable Lock  Zoom for the Image Viewer     e Click the Lock Zoom button     186    Chapter 10    Rotate Image 90 Degrees    The Rotate Image 90 Degrees feature allows you 
241. ore depending on the number of trackable item types in the open  database  Each column in explained below     e The Date Due column lists the due back date for each object in the    report     e The Object column lists the folder that contains each object in the    report     e The ID column identifies each object in the report   it contains the  same information that you would see if you tracked the object and    then looked at the object s entry in the Tracking Status Viewer     e The number of columns between the ID column and the Transaction  Time column will be determined by the tracking hierarchy in the open  database   there will be one column for each trackable type in the da   tabase  These columns display the complete tracking assignment for  each object in the report     e The Transaction Time column lists the date and time that each object    in the report was scanned     e The Scan Operator column lists the Smeadlink user name of the person  who tracked each object in the report     312 Chapter 15    To print the Past Due Tracked Objects report     1  Click the Print button at the bottom of the report window  A standard  Print window will now appear as shown below     Comment   Prot ong Copan    i Hinia of per  fi          Print window  2  Set the options on the Print window to the desired settings     For more information about the options on the Print window  see the section  Print Setup in chapter 7  Steps 2   5 in this section explain the different op   tions
242. otate Image 90 Degrees option allows you to rotate the image in the  active viewer window in 90 degree increments  This feature is helpful if a  document was scanned in upside down  and you would like to view the  image document right side up  To rotate the image in the active viewer  window 90 degrees  click the Rotate Image 90 Degrees option once     Gray Scale    The Gray Scale option allows you to make the lines and text on the image  in the active viewer window appear darker  This can increase readability on  images that have light or thin elements  To darken the lines and text on the  image in the active viewer window  click the Gray Scale option once  If the  image looks worse after applying Gray Scale  you can return the image to  its original state by clicking the Gray Scale option again     Print Fax   Print Image    The Print Image option  on the Print Fax submenu  works exactly like the  Print   lImage command on Smeadlink s Printing menu  When an image is  in the active viewer window  clicking the Print Image option will bring up  the Print window  You can then set the options on this window to the de   sired settings  and click the OK button on it to print the current image  For  more detailed information about printing an image  see the section called  Printing an Image in chapter 7  Note  Should you need Smeadlink to not  scale the printed image to fit the paper and instead print it at the original  size  use the Print   Fax   Print 1 1 option     Print Fax   
243. otate the current image 90 degrees   click the Rotate Image 90 Degrees button once     Gray Scale    The Gray Scale button allows you to make the lines and text on the current  image in the Manual Indexing utility appear darker  This can increase read   ability on images that have light or thin elements  To darken the lines and  text on the current image in the viewer  click the Gray Scale button once  If  the image looks worse after applying Gray Scale  you can return the image  to its original state by clicking the Gray Scale button again     Print Image    The Print Image button works exactly like the Print   Image command on  the File menu  The only difference between the two is that the Print Image  button is easier to get to than the File   Print   lImage command  When an  image is in the Manual Indexing utility  clicking the Print Image button will  bring up the Print window  You can then set the options on this window to  the desired settings  and click the OK button on it to print the current image   For more detailed information about printing an image  see the section Print   ing Images in chapter 7     Using the Manual Indexing Utility 243    Fax Image    The Fax Image button is similar to the Print Image button   it works exactly  like the Fax Image command on the File menu  but it s easier to get to  When  an image is displayed in the Manual Indexing utility  clicking the Fax Image  button will start the process for faxing that image  For step by step instruc   
244. ou let go of the left mouse  button     Rect    The Rect button allows you to draw any number of rectangles on the current  image  To draw a rectangle     e Click the Rect button on the toolbar     e Now position the mouse pointer over the area on the image where you  want the rectangle to start  hold down the left mouse button and drag  the mouse pointer diagonally in the desired direction  As you drag the  mouse pointer  a rectangle will be drawn on the image     e Let go of the left mouse button once the rectangle is the desired size  and is in the desired position     The new rectangle will be automatically selected once you let go of the left  mouse button     Using the Image Viewer 221    Ellipse    The Ellipse button allows you to draw any number of ellipses on the image  in the active viewer window  Recall from basic math that an ellipse can be  either a regular circle  or a circle that has been stretched horizontally or  vertically  To draw an ellipse     e Click the Ellipse button on the toolbar     e Now position the mouse pointer over area on the image where you  want the ellipse to start  hold down the left mouse button and drag the  mouse pointer in the desired direction  As you drag the mouse pointer   an ellipse will be drawn on the image        Let go of the left mouse button once the ellipse is the desired size and  is in the desired position     The new ellipse will be automatically selected once you let go of the left  mouse button     Polyline    The Poly
245. ouse button once  Select the Send To op   tion on the popup menu that appears  and then select the Smeadlink  option on the Send To submenu     Once you send the document to Smeadlink  the Smeadlink Login window  will appear  if Smeadlink was not already open      Using PC Files 331    4  If Smeadlink was not already open  then open the desired database in the  Login window now     Once you have opened a database  the Login window will close and the PC  Files window will appear  The PC Files window lists all the LinkScripts in  the open Smeadlink database  and it allows you to select which LinkScript  will be used to index the selected document  The example below shows  what the PC Files window looks like     Note  The PC Files window will only appear if the open database contains  multiple LinkScripts  If the open database contains just one LinkScript  then  that LinkScript will be run automatically and you will not see the PC Files  window     Smeadiink   PC FILES    Chasan whet you would  ika io do wiih thie PC Fin   then chek a    Fie To Phocen  Vahaa Mew ir 3 1 Menton 2 jespanded  doc       T Mesthi soson fesse doe al Pa Fiar in thi hahh   aa   cm   ahmi       PC Files window       5  Click the desired LinkScript in the PC Files window     All the LinkScripts in the open Smeadlink database are displayed in the box  in the middle of the PC Files window  In the example above  the PC Files  window displays two LinkScripts  starting with one called Index Correspon   dence   
246. ow Menu Tie        Dstsbese Connecton Tirnak fio       30    Chapter 2    General Options    The previous part of this section showed you how to access the general op   tions from any Smeadlink program  The rest of this section will explain the  purpose of each option     Restore Open Windows on Startup    If this option is enabled  any programs that were open in Smeadlink when it  was last closed will be automatically opened next time it is opened  For  instance  if the Scanner and Tracking programs were open when Smeadlink  was last closed  then both of these programs will be automatically opened  next time Smeadlink is opened  In addition  this option will also reopen any  windows that were open in a program  like the Image Viewer      Restore User Name on Startup    If this setting is activated  the last user name that was used to open a pro   gram will automatically be entered in the Login window the next time the  program is opened  This setting is helpful if one user uses a Smeadlink work   station on a regular basis  because it saves the user from entering their user  name each time they want to open a Smeadlink program     Show Menu Tips    If this setting is activated  a menu tip will appear in the lower left corner of  the program window each time you click a menu  or if you place your mouse  pointer over a command on an open menu  The example below shows where  menu tips are displayed on a program s window        IT Loree Deere    AET Femi ese  es hemm irimi  AKT 
247. ow by clicking in one of its  cells or by selecting it  To select a row     e Click the row selector of the desired row     The row selector is the box at the very left side of each row  Once you click  a row selector  the row will be highlighted to indicate that it is selected  The  example below shows what a selected row looks like        A row selector  A selected row    2  Just below the grid  click the link of the desired subfolder     The example on the following page shows what the subfolder links look  like     Note  There are also keyboard shortcuts to open subfolders  as well as to  navigate back to the parent folder  These alternate methods are listed  below     60    Chapter 4    Parent Link           Subfolder Links    e To open a subfolder using the keyboard  hold down the CTRL key and  press the number key relative to the subfolder you want to open  In  the example above  you would press CTRL 1 to go to the Folders  subfolder  CTRL 2 to go to Matter Contacts and CTRL 3 to go to  Matter Notes     e To open the parent folder using the keyboard  hold down the ALT key  and press the number key relative to the number of levels you want to  go back up  In the example above  you would press ALT 1 to go back  up to the All Clients parent folder     The selected subfolder will now be opened in the Smeadlink window  The  parent folder will collapse to a header to only show the pertinent information  of the parent     Note  To see the complete row for the parent folder  c
248. own below  The Scanner folder  will be open in the Options window  because it was opened from the Scan   ner program     ge ee oe  rim  E im  ris  P ie    T pibe mi hape bei    L  ptm ome       sete  Sars  Options window  2  Click the desired option under Image Viewer Location     3  Click the OK button or press ENTER  The Options window will now  close  and the Image Viewer will be moved to the selected position     184    Chapter 10    Using the Features on the Image Viewer s Toolbar    The rest of this section will show you how to use the features on the Image  Viewer s toolbar  which is located at the top of the Image Viewer  To view  the name of any feature on the toolbar  place your mouse pointer over the  feature for a few seconds  The name will then be displayed below the fea   ture in a beige box     The features on the Image Viewer s toolbar only affect the image document  that is currently displayed in the Image Viewer  To display a document   simply click the row of the desired document in the Scanner s records grid   This section explains the Image Viewer s features in the order they appear  on the toolbar     Previous Page  Page Number and Next Page    The Previous Page and Next Page features allow you to see the previous or  next images in a multi image document  The Page Number feature displays  the page number of the image that is currently displayed in the Image Viewer   If the current image in the image viewer is part of a multi image document   then you ca
249. p the  tracking history for that object  This section will show you how to use the  Tracking Viewer to view an object s tracking history  You can use the infor   mation in this section to view the tracking history for both standard objects  and containers     The History report is the tool you will use to view the history of an object   This section is divided into three parts  the first part explains how to open  the History report  the second part explains how to print the History report  and the third part explains how to export the data in the History report     To open the History report     1  Click the row of the desired object     The tracking status of the selected object will now appear in the Tracking  Viewer     2  Place your mouse pointer over the object s entry in the Tracking Viewer   and then click the right mouse button once     The Tracking Viewer submenu will now appear  The options on this sub   menu will differ according to the tracking level of the object that you se   lected  and whether or not it is a container  If the object is a container  and if  it has one or more objects assigned to it  then the submenu will contain one  or more  ITEMS Contained  commands  where ITEMS is one type of ob   ject assigned to this container  For instance  if a folder object had a docu   ment assigned to it  the Tracking Viewer submenu would include the com   mand Documents Contained     Regardless of the object s tracking level  and regardless of whether or not it  is 
250. pecify which database will be opened  The  example on the following page shows what the Login window looks like     Opening a Smeadlink Program 23    Fa Smeadlink Lopin 5 0  97       Smeadlink Login window    2  Select the appropriate type option for the database you wish to open  To  select a type     e Click the Access or SQL button in the Database Type section of the  Login window     The type you will need to select is determined by the database you want to  open  1 e  if you want to open an Access database then you will need to select  the Access type  and if you want to open a SQL database then you will need  to select the SQL type   Once you select a type  all the recently opened data   bases of that type will be listed in the database box beneath the two type  buttons     Note  If you are unsure which database type to select  check with your  Smeadlink administrator     3  Select the desired database  To select a database     e If the database is listed in the database box beneath the two type but   tons  then click the database  It will turn blue once you click it  to  indicate that it is now selected     e If the database is not listed in the database box  then double click the  More Files option in the database box  The Open Database window  will now appear  Use the window to locate the database you wish to  open  and then double click the database to select it     24    Chapter 2    The database that you select will determine what data is displayed in Smeadlink  p
251. pective modules  For instance  the Image Viewer is described  in the section about the Imaging module     Note  For more information about each end user module available in  Smeadlink  see the section Smeadlink Modules in chapter 1     Moving Around in Smeadlink 53    4  Moving Around in Smeadlink    TTF Frier home       Chapter contents  Introduction  Using the Search Options  Opening the Navigation Bar  Opening a Folder  Opening a Subfolder  Opening a View    54 Chapter 4    Introduction    The previous chapter introduced you to Smeadlink  You learned the names  of the basic components  and you also learned about some basic concepts   You should now have a general idea about what Smeadlink does  and what  the main components in it look like  The next four chapters in this manual  will show you how to use Smeadlink  and walk you through each of the  different tasks that it is intended for  This chapter will begin by showing you  how to move around in Smeadlink     Smeadlink has several features that allow you to easily move around in the  open database  These features are called navigation utilities  This chapter  will show you how to use Smeadlink s navigation utilities to move between  the different folders  workgroups and subfolders in the open database  You  will also learn how to open the different views in a folder or subfolder  and  how to open an add in     Using the Search Options    Smeadlink features a Search Bar which can open at startup  and features  both Find 
252. play in a New Instance   If you select this option and Jump To finds  a match for the ID number you entered  then Jump To will display the  matching row in a new instance of Smeadlink  The matching row will  be displayed in its folder or subfolder  and it will be highlighted to  distinguish it from the other rows in the folder or subfolder     e Search Current Workgroup   If you select this option  then Jump To  will only search the current workgroup for a row that matches the ID  number you entered     e Search Current Table   If you select this option  then Jump To will  search the table that the current folder or subfolder is based on for a  row that matches the ID number you entered  Remember that the data  ina table is not necessarily the same as the data in a folder or subfolder  based on that table  the table may contain more or less data than the  folder or subfolder   If Jump To finds a matching row in the table that  is not normally displayed in the folder or subfolder  than it will tem   porarily add the row to the table     76    Chapter 5    2  Enter the ID number of the row you want to find in the Jump To box     There are two ways you can enter an ID number into the Jump To box   First  you can simply type in the desired number  Second  you can use a  hand held bar code reader to scan the number into the box     If you want to use a bar code reader  the instructions it came with will show  you how to connect it to your computer  Once it is connected  simply cli
253. pses on the current  image  Recall from basic math that an ellipse can be either a regular circle   or a circle that has been stretched horizontally or vertically  To draw an  ellipse     e Click the Ellipse button on the toolbar     e Now position the mouse pointer over area on the image where you  want the ellipse to start  hold down the left mouse button and drag the  mouse pointer in the desired direction  As you drag the mouse pointer   an ellipse will be drawn on the image     e Let go of the left mouse button once the ellipse is the desired size and  is in the desired position     The new ellipse will be automatically selected once you let go of the left  mouse button     Polyline    The fifth Redlining button is called Polyline  This button allows you to draw  any number of  polyline  shapes  A polyline shape is any shape made up of  lines that are connected to each other end to end  The difference between a  polyline shape and a polygon is that the beginning of the first line and the  end of the last line do not have to be connected to each other on a polyline  shape like they do on a polygon  In other words  a polyline shape does not  have to define a bounded area  To draw a polyline shape     e Click the Polyline button on the toolbar     e Now position the mouse pointer over the area on the image where you  want the shape to start  click the left mouse button and drag the mouse  pointer in the desired direction  A black line will be drawn as you drag  the mouse po
254. pt to LinkScript  but  the example on the following page shows what a typical LinkScript  window looks like     Using the Manual Indexing Utility 237       A typical LinkScript window    If your LinkScript requires information  enter the appropriate infor   mation in the window and then click the OK button at the bottom  The  LinkScript will now use the information you entered to locate the row  that the orphan image document needs to be attached to  and it will  attach the document to that row     Once the document is attached it will no longer be an orphan  so it will  be removed from the Manual Indexing utility  You will now be able to  view the image document using the standard Image Viewer  which is  explained in the previous chapter of this manual     Filter Orphan List    Clicking the Filter Orphan List button will bring up a specialized Filter win   dow  This window allows you to filter the orphans in the open database by  three different categories  trackable Id numbers  number of pages and record  type Id numbers  Any orphan image documents that do not meet the filters  in the Filter window will not be displayed in the Manual Indexing utility     Filtering the orphan image documents in a database is helpful if the docu   ments need to be indexed by multiple operators  For instance  one operator  could be assigned all orphan image documents with trackable Id numbers  between 1 and 100  another operator could be assigned all orphan image  documents with trackable Id n
255. r program  For information about the print  setup process  see the previous section in this chapter     To print documents from the Scanner program     1  Open the batch that contains the document you want to print   2  Select the document you want to print  To select an image document   e Click the document s row in the Scanner s records grid     The document s row will turn blue after you select it  to indicate that it is  selected  The document s image will also appear in the Scanner s Image  Viewer  if the document contains multiple pages and was saved as one file   then only the first page of the document will be displayed in the Image  Viewer  but the entire file will be printed once you start the print process      3  Open the File menu from the Scanner s main menu bar and click the Print  command  The Print submenu will now appear as shown below      Ew    Ga OpenDistsbass   Oe  Close Disisbase    0  Pret F Image          Print submenu    198 Chapter 10    4  Click the Image command on the Print submenu  The Print window will  now appear as shown below        Print window    5  Verify that the options on the Print window are set according to the de   sired settings     All the options on the Print window except the Page Range options will be  set as they were during the print setup process  For more information about  these options  see steps 2 5 in the previous section of this chapter     6  If the selected document is a multi page document that was saved as one  fil
256. rarily in your possession  When you use the Track   ing program to assign an object from a permanent destination  like a filing  room  to a temporary destination  like an employee  you will also be able to  assign a due back date for the object  The due back date is the date that the  object needs to be back at its permanent location     Once you have assigned due back dates for objects assigned to temporary  destinations  you can then open Smeadlink and run the Past Due Tracked  Objects report  This report will display each object that has not been re   turned to its permanent destination by its assigned due back date     Introduction to Smeadlink 17    Retention Module    The Smeadlink Retention Module has been added to enhance records man   agement and especially the removal of records no longer required to be kept  on file  The Retention feature allows users to set up Retention Codes for  documents in the database which determine how long a document has been  active or inactive in the file system  These documents may need to remain in  the database as well as in their respective file folders for a certain length of  time as determined by industry or government regulations  Now Smeadlink  users will be able to automate the management of these files by setting up  and coding the various requirements  then simply applying the codes to the  files     Further discussion of how to set up and maintain Retention Codes will be  covered in Chapter 16 of this User s Guide     Smeadl
257. rce you are using     The selected document will now be re scanned or reprocessed according to  the current rule settings     Scanning and Viewing Images 193    Correcting Bar Codes that were not Read Correctly    When you review a batch  it is a good idea to check for bar code recognition  problems in addition to image processing problems  For instance  you may  find that the Scanner program was not able to find a bar code on a document s  image  when you can see the bar code clearly in the image viewer  The  Scanner s Edit Bar Codes feature allows you to enter bar codes manually if  the Scanner is unable to find them on its own  The following instructions  will show you how to use the Edit Bar Codes feature to manually enter bar  codes for scanned documents     To correct a bar code that was not read correctly     1  Open the Tools menu and click the Options command  The Options win   dow will now appear  The Scanner folder will be open in the Options win   dow     2  Click the Edit Bar Codes option in the Scanner folder  then press OK to  save your changes and close the Options window     3  Click the Bar Codes cell that you want to modify  A blinking cursor will  now appear in the cell as shown below        4  Type the correct bar code in the cell     5  Once you have entered the correct bar code into the document row  click  the mouse pointer over another row in the records grid  This will save the  changes you made to the bar code entry of the first row     As long as t
258. re effective and  efficient for users in the document management industry  The new features  are summarized below     e Enhanced records management  e Additional indexing and tracking abilities     Streamlined user interface    New enhancements have been implemented to simplify requesting docu   ments  streamline retention of legal documents  and assist with bar code  tracking  Other tools now part of Smeadlink make it even easier to manage  documents electronically  These new tools include enhanced integration of  Microsoft and email documents into Smeadlink  Other special tools such as  I Access and I Publish enable users to easily and quickly create customized  HTML pages and web based documents     Smeadlink now offers more options to index images  request files and track  both electronic and printed records  In addition  bar code tracking enhance   ments build in flexibility to add memos  fields  and even drop down menus     Smeadlink s enhanced user interface has been designed to be intuitive  al   lowing even a first time user to start working with Smeadlink s various mod   ules immediately  The main screen is divided into three sections  a  Find   screen for quick searches  a clickable listing of the records management  workgroups  and the active work screen  with a menu of document manage   ment options     Another obvious enhancement to the Smeadlink program is the updated and  streamlined main screen  The tool bar at the top of the screen has been sim   plified  an
259. re than one ver   sion  This option will be grayed out if it is not applicable to the image  document in the active viewer window  If the image document in the active  viewer window contains more than one version  you can view the next ver   sion of the document by clicking the Next Version option once     Pages   Previous Page    The Previous Page option  on the Pages submenu  will be available if the  image document in the active viewer window contains more than one page   and if a page other than the first page is currently being displayed  This  option will be grayed out if it is not applicable to the image document in the  active viewer window  If the image document in the active viewer window  contains more than one page  and if the page that is currently being dis   played is not the first page  than you can see the previous page of the docu   ment by clicking the Previous Page option once     212    Chapter 11    Pages   Next Page    The Next Page option  on the Pages submenu  will be available if the im   age document in the active viewer window contains more than one page   This option will be grayed out if it is not applicable to the image document  in the active viewer window  If the image document in the active viewer  window contains more than one page  you can view the next page of the  document by clicking the Next Page option once     Zoom   Fit to Viewer    The Fit to Viewer option  on the Zoom submenu  allows you to return a  magnified image to its original
260. rmanent destination by their assigned due back date     Using the Tracking Features 293    Opening the Tracking Viewer    The Tracking Viewer is a utility in Smeadlink that allows you to view the  tracking status and the tracking history of an object  You can also use the  Tracking Viewer to view the contents of a destination     This section will discuss when the Tracking Viewer is visible and how one  can adjust its size  The next three sections in this chapter will then show  you how to use the Tracking Viewer to view information about tracking  items in the open database     To open the Tracking Viewer     The Tracking Viewer is always on when a folder that has been set up for  tracking is displayed  If you change to a folder that is not set up for track   ing  the Tracking Viewer automatically hides itself     The Tracking Viewer is shown in the example below  By default  the Track   ing Viewer will display a one line tracking status summary of the row that  is currently active in the open view  If no row is currently active  then the  Tracking Viewer will not display anything     TIAI Ling eae    LIDE a  u e be  Wim Liber ae Bs    i         Tracking Status Viewer    294    Chapter 15  Alternatively  one can click on the Plus button on the far right side of the  tracking viewer to expand it into a detailed tracking status view     In the examples below  the Plus button is shown on the summary or one  line view   and then the detail tracking status view is shown     Se  e
261. rmn Barend  one hamo mie opahi Poad kara       MAA C Ttar Pind Fi rae paaie cher harie Igie ce oe p e a an  lanig le Te oh be ha boim a de carwam  7    testa ret cos Fle hagi preg to be iors    i A frozen column in Smeadlink    Once you have frozen a column  it will remain on the left side of the view as  you scroll back and forth between the other columns in the view  Apart from  remaining on the screen at all times  the frozen column will behave no dif   ferently than other columns in the view     To unfreeze a frozen column     After you have frozen a column and worked with it  you may eventually  want to unfreeze it and return it to normal  The instructions below will show  you how to unfreeze a frozen column     1  Place the mouse pointer over the header of the column you want to un   freeze  and then click the right mouse button once     A popup menu will now appear at the lower right side of the column header   The button to the left of the Freeze Column command will appear pressed  down     2  Click the Freeze Column command on the popup menu     The column will now be unfrozen  It will return to its original location in the  view  and if it was the only frozen column in the view  the separator bar will  disappear     Viewing Rows in Smeadlink 81    Moving Columns in a View    Sometimes you may want to reposition the columns in a view to make the  view easier to use  This section will show you how to move one column in  the open view  You can use the information in th
262. rograms and utilities  i e  what workgroups and folders are displayed in the  browsing program  what images are displayed in the Scanner program  etc       Note  If you are unsure which database to select  check with your Smeadlink  administrator     4  Type your user name in the Name box   5  Type your password in the Password box   6  Click the OK button or press the ENTER key on the keyboard     The Smeadlink start up screen will now open  The example below shows  what the screen looks like immediately after it has been opened        Smeadlink program immediately after being opened    When you first open the browsing program  it may look somewhat different  than the example above  This is because the exact appearance of the browsing  program depends on the structure of the database you selected earlier  and the  current settings of the browsing program s preference options  located on the  Options window in the browsing program folder   You will learn more about  these options later on     Opening a Smeadlink Program 25    Opening Other End user Programs from Smeadlink    Once you have opened Smeadlink  you will be able to use it to open any  other Smeadlink program     To open another end user program from the Go menu   1  Click the Go command on the browsing program s menu bar     The Go menu will now appear  The top section of the Go menu contains three  commands for the different end user programs in your Smeadlink system  The  example below shows what the Go menu look
263. rom the view  or you  can delete a group of rows at once  This section will show you how to use  the Delete Rows command to delete rows from the open view     Note  You cannot delete rows that have attachments  i e  subfolders  track   ing assignments  images  etc   unless you Smeadlink system administrator  has set up your system to allow you to do so   as controlled by table security     To delete rows from the open view     1  Select which rows in the view you want to delete  To select a row in the  open view     e Click the row selector of the desired row  the row selector is the gray  box at the very left side of each row      The row will appear highlighted after you click it  to indicate that it is  selected  You can select multiple rows at once by holding the down the  CTRL key while you click row selectors  The example below shows  what a row selector and a group of selected rows looks like        A selected row    A row selector    Editing Rows in Smeadlink 105    2  Click the Delete Rows command on the Rows menu  the Delete button  on the toolbar  or press the DELETE key on the keyboard     A message box will now appear asking if you want to delete the selected  rows  The example below shows what the Delete Rows message box looks  like        Datel Roma           Sp Youkares selected 10  rows for deletion   Dhog Yes bo deise the  nres oe Hg by geal    Died         Delete Rows message box    3  Press ENTER or click the Yes button on the Delete Rows message box to  d
264. ropriate row in the Doctors folder   open the Patients subfolder from that row  create a row for the first patient   reopen the Doctors folder  find the next doctor row  open the Patients sub   folder from that row  create a row for the next patient  etc       In addition  if a patient changes doctors  then you would need to find the old  doctor s row in the Doctors folder  open the Patients folder from that row   delete the patient s row there  reopen the Doctors folder  find the new doctor s  row  open the Patients subfolder from that row  and add a new row there  As  you can see  this standard method can quickly become inefficient and need   lessly complicated     100    Chapter 6    To make it easier to create new child rows and attach them to parent rows   Smeadlink supports special columns called dropdowns  A dropdown is basi   cally a column in a child folder that you can use to attach rows in that folder  to rows in a parent folder  You can also use dropdowns to reattach existing  child rows to different rows in the parent folder     Dropdowns are able to simplify these tasks  because they eliminate the need  to go back and fourth between the parent folder and the child folder   with a  dropdown column you can create new child rows  attach them to parent  rows  delete existing child rows or reattach existing child rows to new par   ent rows  all from the child folder in the parent child relationship     To provide this increased functionality  dropdowns use a slightly
265. roup in Smeadlink that contains a group of financial folders  Since  there are no physical limitations in Smeadlink  each workgroup can contain  any number of folders  The example on the following page shows what a  workgroup looks like in Smeadlink  The workgroup in the example is called  Tracking Data  and it contains four folders used for tracking     42    Chapter 3    Name of open workgroup    lm Drees  eee tm Rept oe      T t naa    is u ee wo a       Folders in open workgroup  Subfolder    Each Smeadlink folder can contain any number of subfolders  Each subfolder  is like a folder within the main folder  The first step in opening a subfolder is  to select a row in the main folder  You can then open the subfolder  and it  will display all the rows it contains that are related to the selected row in the  main folder     When a folder contains one or more subfolders  the folder is often referred  to as a parent folder and the subfolders are often referred to as child folders   This relationship between the parent folder and child folders is called a par   ent child relationship  We will be using this terminology later on in discuss   ing components in Smeadlink  because it is more standard than folder and  subfolder     In Smeadlink  subfolders look exactly the same as folders  You can tell  subfolders apart from folders because subfolders are children folders nested  under the parent folder  Available subfolders are shown as links below the  parent folder    View    Each
266. rrent Retention Codes that are in the  system     Smeadlink also allows user flexibility in managing the records to be de   stroyed  Users can click Item On Hold before it is destroyed  for instance  if  a manager needed to approve its destruction   Users can also set an item to  be on hold until a preset date elapses  Once the date elapses  the record is  again eligible for destruction     322    Chapter 16  Enabling Retention for Smeadlink Folders    Enabling or turning on all of the above features for any folder in Smeadlink  is a simple procedure performed by your Smeadlink system administrator   Using table properties in the Database Map  your system administrator can  turn on Retention as well as turn on Inactivity periods  They also define  what fields control the different events in retention     Once the system administrator has enabled retention on a folder  they can  add a column to the folder s view to display and   or allow you to pick  retention codes  Finally  the Retention Information for any record in the  folder will then be available on the right click submenu     Using PC Files 323    17  Using PC Files       Chapter contents    Introduction   PC Files Concepts   Indexing a Document   Indexing Multiple Documents with one LinkScript  Indexing Multiple Documents with Multiple LinkScripts  Viewing a PC Files Document in Smeadlink   Using I Access and I Publish    324 Chapter 17    Introduction    This chapter will show you how to use the Smeadlink PC Files mo
267. rs can access the Retention Properties under the Database Map   A right click on the user s mouse will bring up the Table Properties  This  screen can be used to change layout options including the Retention Mainte   nance fields  Using this function will close out the open Smeadlink window   Once the user has finished adjusting the properties table  click on the  Smeadlink icon on the right side of the database map window to reopen  Smeadlink           Eves Te      ject Pent   Pmj    Decs ia ind O ieee    Pemi yas Erh ieme ti       318 Chapter 16    Using Citation Codes    Smeadlink will also automatically associate legal or government documents   or citations  within the Retention features  By setting up the Citation Codes   users will be able to associate them with Retention Codes  This ensures the  users have documented government or industry requirements  and have ad   dressed the need to store or manage these documents over a certain period of  time     1  With the Retention menu open  choose Citation Code Maintenance     2  Click Citation Maintenance  Below is an example of the Citation Main   tenance window     Citation Codes  Subject  Notes and Legal period can all be added in this  window and saved  Users can code all necessary citations and save the entire  list for use with the Retention Code features in Smeadlink     Caked Dasa   EF agate a   Lope Deeks   eee  Falce aed Pepoechee       Introduction to Retention 319  To associate Citation Codes with Retention Code
268. rule on the Rule submenu     Note  The Scanner processes images according to the current settings on  the Scanning menu  If you modify the settings in the Scanning menu after  you select arule  the Scanner will process any scanned images according to  the modified settings     178 Chapter 10    2  If the rule that you selected in step 1 uses a disk source  you will now need  to specify which files in the source directory should be scanned  To specify  the desired files     e Open the Scanning menu and click the Input Output command  The  Input Output submenu will now appear     e Click the Disk Source Input Settings command on the Input Output  submenu  The Disk Source Input Settings window will now appear as  shown below                 Disk Source Input Settings window    e The top half of the Disk Source Input Settings window allows you to  select which directory the files will be scanned from  Make sure that  the correct directory is displayed here     e The Filter Files by Type option on the Disk Source Input Settings  window allows you to select which type of files in the directory will be  displayed for you to select  Click the down arrow at the right of the  Filter Files by Type option to display a list of file extensions  Click  again on the extension that corresponds to the file type you want to  select  All the files of the type you selected will now be displayed in  the window below the Filter Files by Type option     Scanning and Viewing Images 179    e To select
269. rule were explained in the first section of this chapter  This section explains  the remaining options on these four submenus and show you how to use  each one  None of the options explained in this section are required by the  Scanner  so you do not have to set any of them if you do not want to and you  are satisfied with the capabilities of the basic rule you created earlier     If you do want to use one or more of these options to extend the capabilities  of your basic rule  open the rule and then set the desired options according  to the instructions given for each one  Once you have set the options to the  settings you want  click the Save Active Rule command on the Rule sub   menu  remember  the Rule submenu is opened from the Scanning menu    Your rule will now be extended to include the options that you just set     The options explained in this section are divided up according to which  submenu they are located on  The four submenus covered in this section are  Sources  Documents  Input Output and Image Processing  You can open  any of these submenus by first opening the Scanning menu and then click   ing the name of the desired submenu  The options for each submenu are  explained from the top of the menu to the bottom  Any options that are  explained in the first section of this chapter are not explained again  since  you should already be familiar with them  It is recommended that you at  least look over all the options explained in this section once  so that you  
270. s  first make sure these  steps have been followed to enter in the Citation Code information    1  Choose Retention on the Smeadlink toolbar   2  Click Citation Code Maintenance    3  Click the Add button   4  Add all new Citation Codes as necessary     Now the users will go back to the Retention Code Maintenance window and  click the Edit button  At the bottom of the Retention Code Maintenance win   dow  the user will see the Referenced Citations button  When this button is  clicked  it will bring up a window with all assigned Citations listed                             To add a citation  click the Add button and highlight the appropriate Cita   tion Code  Now choose Select  Once the window is closed  that citation will  be attached to  or associated with  that particular Retention Code     320 Chapter 16    Using Destruction Reports    Another key part to the retention process is the destruction of outdated files  and records  Smeadlink has been set up to run a number of different reports  for users to track those files and to dispose of them when necessary     These are the available reports within the Smeadlink Retention Module     Eligible for Destruction Report     Shows which documents can now be de   stroyed  pending the proper approval  This report shows the detail about  that record  Users can right click on the record to see all the details       nee    sire Bre Deer bet    ele Bea E ay  E upa nap a  z bra lum jam  Slee Ere iai leeu  Bee ide Geers        ps iege  
271. s batch                 Cancel   Show Files  gt     Smeadlink PC Files program          PC Files serves two general purposes  First  it makes documents that would  normally be available to just one person available to every Smeadlink user  on your network  Second  it makes the documents easy to find and open     Introduction to Smeadlink 19    For instance  suppose you write a document that needs to be seen by other  employees in your company  If you save the document to your hard drive  after writing it  then your fellow employees will probably not be able to  view the document   This is because personal hard drives are normally not  visible to other computers on a network   In addition  even if other employ   ees did have access to your hard drive  or if you saved the document to a  shared drive  then they would need to know exactly where the document  was located in order to find it     Indexing the document with PC Files can solve both of these potential prob   lems  First  since the document is accessible through Smeadlink  any user  now has access to it  Second  the document can be attached to a row in an  obvious location  like a customers or employees folder  so it will be easy for  others to find and open     20 Chapter 2    2  Opening a Smeadlink Program    Fl Smeeadlink Lopin 5 0  947       Chapter contents  Introduction  Opening a Smeadlink Program  Using Smeadlink General Options  Opening an Add In from a Smeadlink Program  Using Smeadlink Help  Exiting a Smeadli
272. s by including the ability to  Transfer records manually  using the Transfer button on the Smeadlink menu  bar in the main window     Within bar code tracking  users are now able to browse for the choices of  location when tracking a document to a location through the use of dropdown  menu options     New options have been added to assist in tracking documents  This is espe   cially relevant if a large number of users are using and tracking documents   Users can set up additional fields for text or memos  and create dropdown  menus  All of these new options allow users to automate the tracking pro   cess  but still allow the flexibility of manual tracking as necessary     The next sections will involve a more detailed look at these four tracking  enhancements  Default tracking options including adding optional fields   transferring records and location browsing     Using the Tracking Features 305    Setting default tracking properties    Smeadlink has the added ability to set up default properties for records in a  specific location  Default properties for records may include Tracking due  dates  options for tracking reconciliation and tracking out status     To set up default properties for records in a specific location     1  Choose Tools on the Smeadlink tool bar  click Database Map  You will  see a map of the entire Smeadlink database structure     Bet Sse se       2  Choose application properties  by right clicking on the top most level  and choosing such  and you will 
273. s destina   tion     To print the History report     1  Click the Print button at the bottom of the History window  A standard  Print window will now appear as shown below     Frins  ihe Re     ppa OF PAGE bo PS    Comment   Poni omg Copan  Hiin of ogee       Print window    304    Chapter 15    2  Set the options on the Print window to the desired settings     For more information about the options on the Print window  see the section  Print Setup in chapter 7  Steps 2   5 in this section explain the different op   tions on the Print window     3  Click the OK button in the lower right corner of the Print window  The  History report will now be printed according to the current settings on the  Print window     To export the History report     1  Click the Export button at the bottom of the History window  A window  will now appear asking if you would like to export the rows in the Contents  report     2  Click the Yes button on the window     3  Now go to the section called Exporting a Records Grid in chapter 7 of this  manual  Go directly to step 4 in the section  and continue from there  The  remaining steps will walk you through the export process     Setting up and using additional tracking properties    Smeadlink has the added ability to set up default properties for records in a  specific location  Default properties for records may include Tracking due  dates  options for tracking reconciliation and tracking out status     Smeadlink also simplifies the tracking proces
274. s for     By default  the Print   Labels command will print one label for each row in  the open view  If you would like to only print labels for certain rows in the  view  then select the desired rows now  To select a row     e Click the row selector of the desired row     The row selector is the gray box at the far left side of each row  Once you  click a row selector  the entire row will become highlighted to indicate that it  is selected  You can select multiple rows at once by holding down the CTRL  key while you click each row selector  The example on the following page  shows what a row selector and a group of selected rows look like     124 Chapter 7       A selected row  A row selector    2  Click the Print command on the File menu  The Print submenu will now  appear as shown below   insert screen shot        Print submenu    3  Click the Labels command on the Print submenu  The Smeadlink Label  Printer window will now appear as shown on the following page     Data Output from Smeadlink 125          Ekai    l m Tid Aafiata 110 L La            Bienema  Lica ate odo    Beggi Dood pee    ee ae ee pa iei aTa  ae Erion rea          Smeadlink Label Printer window    4  Select the desired label design  To select a design     e Click the down arrow at the right of the Design box  to display a list of designs  that have been created for the open view s table     e Click the desired design on the design list     The design you select determines what information will be included
275. s in a view  If Edit Mode was not  enabled  then you could only select rows   you could not edit them  The  Edit Mode feature was removed to make it easier to edit rows  This section  will show you how rows are now edited in a view  You can use the informa   tion in this section to edit existing rows in any view in the open Smeadlink  database  including views in both folders and subfolders     To edit existing rows in the open view     1  Click the desired cell in the row you would like to edit  A flashing cursor  will now appear in the cell     2  Type the desired information in the cell     As soon as you begin typing  a pencil will appear in the row selector of the  edited row as shown below  The pencil means that information has been  modified in one of the row s cells                 Editing pencil    3  If you would like to edit other cells in this row     e Use the arrow keys on the keyboard to move to the appropriate cell   you can also click the mouse pointer over the desired cell      e Once the cursor appears in the cell you would like to edit  type in the  desired changes     Chapter 6    4  Once you finish editing the row  you will need to save the changes you  have made  There are five ways to save a row  and each method is explained  below     e Click the Save Row command on the Rows menu   e Click the Save button on the toolbar     e Use the Up or Down arrow keys on the keyboard to move to another  row in the open view     e Use the TAB key on the keyboard to
276. s like     So  Fe Smeadlink  gt     Bs Scanner Ctrl E  WM  Bar Code Tracking Ctril K                   1 Records  2 Tracking  3 Maintenance  4HR   5 AP   6 Correspondence       End user programs on the Go menu    Note  There is no PC Files option on the Go menu  because you cannot open  the PC Files program from the browsing program  The PC Files program  only appears when you are indexing PC Files documents  or if you use the  Attach PC Files option on the right click submenu  For more information   see chapter 16     2  Click the command on the Go menu for the program you would like to  open     The selected Smeadlink program will now open     Note  If you select the Smeadlink button on the Go menu and Smeadlink is  already open  then Smeadlink will open another copy of the browsing pro   gram  Having several copies of Smeadlink open at once can be helpful if you  want to copy data from one folder to another  For more information  see the  next section     26    Chapter 2    Opening Multiple Copies of Smeadlink    For most Smeadlink programs  such as the Scanner program or the Tracking  program  you can only have one copy of the program open at once  this is  called one instance of the program   For Smeadlink  however  you can have  up to five copies open at once     When you have multiple copies of Smeadlink open  the same database is  open in each copy  but each copy can display a different section of that data   base  For instance  one copy could display a Clients folder
277. s of data in a system modeled after a physical filing  cabinet  It groups related rows together and displays them as the contents of  a folder  Each Smeadlink folder contains a number of related rows  and it  may also contain one or more subfolders  Since there are no physical limita   tions in Smeadlink   each folder can contain any number of rows or subfold   ers  The example below shows what an open folder looks like in Smeadlink    The folder in the example is called Client     Smeadlink organizes related folders into groups called workgroups  Each  workgroup can contain any number of folders  The example below shows  how a workgroup is displayed  The workgroup in the example is called Track   ing Maintenance  and it contains four folders used for tracking  The Em   ployee folder in the Tracking Maintenance workgroup is currently open     el     H  anita  To  Lamar   ES mato  La  _Urnie ite  rae   a PA  oe     on or te     wre  a Be  Pa       DETE ee ij    Introduction to Smeadlink 11    Because Smeadlink offers a database browsing program  it allows you to do  much more than just view rows in different folders  You can edit existing  rows or add new rows to any folder  You can also sort rows in a folder based  on one or more of the folder s columns  and display a selected group of rows  in a folder using one or more filters     If you cannot find a row in your database  Smeadlink has a user friendly  search utility that allows you to quickly locate individual rows by any
278. s permanent destination  by its assigned due back date  The example below shows what the Past Due  Tracked Objects report looks like     oo Utali P Bias a On tae i  CE  G  Li skei tae    fee Es Euh bales fe  Bibie H  Cr Emire HL A  Fi 1 Late Pias  aes irris  hes Las Litiy Limin Mee          Past Due Tracked Objects report    As you learned in chapter 1  there is a second way to enter object and desti   nation bar codes into Smeadlink Tracking   you can use the Denso BHT   6000 portable scanner  The Denso scanner is a compact  lightweight unit  that allows you to track objects away from your desk  On average  the Denso  scanner can hold around three or four thousand bar codes  so you can per   form a substantial amount of tracking before you need to upload the track   ing information from the Denso scanner to Smeadlink  The Import Wizard   which is a Smeadlink administrative utility  is the tool you will use to upload  tracking data from the Denso scanner     The Denso scanner uses a special program for tracking Smeadlink objects   This program has all the functionality of the standard Smeadlink Tracking  program  so in addition to simply assigning an object to a destination  you  can enter due back dates for objects and you can assign multiple objects to  one destination  The Denso tracking program has a simple user interface  so  once you become familiar with the standard Smeadlink Tracking program  the transition to the Denso scanner should be very straightforward     Intro
279. s two tools that allow you to modify how data is  displayed within a folder     The first tool is called column sorting  Column sorting allows you to orga   nize the rows in a folder according to the cells in one of the folder s columns   When you are performing a sort on a column  you can choose from either  ascending order or descending order  Ascending order organizes cells that  contain text in alphabetical order from A Z  and cells that contain numbers  in numerical order starting from 0  Descending order organizes text cells  from Z   A  and numerical cells in order ending at 0     When you perform any kind of sort on a column  Smeadlink does not just  sort the cells in that column  It sorts all the rows in the open folder based on  their cells in the sorted column  The example below shows what a sorted  folder looks like  The folder in the example is called Client  and a sort in  ascending order has been performed on its Client Name column     ef Se be eee See ee ee    U    Bebi liane tne i AE       Smeadlink folder sorted in ascending order  according to Client Name column    Introduction to Smeadlink 49    The second tool for customizing the display of data within a folder is col   umn filtering  Column filtering allows you to specify exactly which rows  will be displayed in a folder  For instance  suppose you work in a medical  office and you have a folder that contains rows for all your patients  Some of  the columns in this folder include Patient Name  Patient    
280. section in this chapter will show you how to extend the functional   ity of a basic rule with all the options available on the Scanning submenus   The first part of this section explains the general procedure for extending a  tule  and the rest of it explains in detail each option available on the Sources   Documents  Input Output and Image Processing submenus  Although you  do not have to set many of these options  it is a good idea to at least look  them over so that you know what the capabilities of the Scanner are     Working with Scanner Rules 139    Creating a Basic Rule    This section will show you how to create a basic rule in the Scanner pro   gram  This rule will only set the features that are required by the Scanner to  define a rule  Once you have created the rule you can use it to scan docu   ments into your Smeadlink database  but no image processing will be per   formed on the document images  The section Extending a Rule later in this  chapter will explain the general procedure for extending the functionality of  a basic rule  and the four following sections will explain in detail each op   tion available for extending basic rules     To create a basic rule     1  Open the Scanning menu from the menu bar  and click the Rule com   mand  The Rule submenu will now appear     2  Click the New Rule command on the Rule submenu  The New Rule Cre   ation window will now appear as shown below           New Rule Creation window    3  Enter the identification informatio
281. see the example below     Epam   prira   mapa fees   geal  tek  eee    beige Bee T  Tiea fe fiat       On the Tracking tab  you will see were a user can set tracking options  such  as tracking reconciliation requirements  due dates  histories  additional field  descriptions  and additional memo field descriptions  Users will also be  able to create dropdown menus by enabling the selection or suggestion list  settings  These are optional fields  set to enhance the tracking information  for your records     306    Chapter 15    Using the Transfer Option    Objects in Smeadlink can be quickly and easily transferred from one location  to another using the Transfer button on the Smeadlink menu bar  Any user  can transfer records  unless the security settings have been changed to limit  access to Transfer     If you are using Transfer button on a folder for the first time  you will need to  do a quick  one time setup  Below is an example of the setup screen        On this screen  you should pick what you want as the default destination  whenever objects are transferrer in this folder  For example  you may know  that Folders are commonly transferred to Employees  Therefore  on the above  screen  you would pick Employees as the default Destination Table   and the  fields that will provide additional information about the Employee  for ex   ample  maybe the Employee s ID and Name so you know you are transferring  the object to the correct person   After performing this setup  and in f
282. seeneenees 344  Appendix A  Smeadlink System Requirements                 s00004 331  Minimum Hard Ware  ecescsesvessiegssnesenpessevsstiscssacevevetarss EEE NEEE 331  Recommended Hardware           cceccesescseceeceeeeeercneceesaeeeeneeas 331  Operating System vecseisisscesciseccdeenccsester Acoseteesceec  iteeedscaneviess 331  SAS E E T 331    Databas Enies arnar EE E REEE 331    Contents vii    Introduction 1    Introduction    Welcome to Smeadlink    Welcome to Smeadlink  a intuitive and completely integrated document man   agement system for managing both paper and electronic documents  This  Introduction explains the basic information you might want to know before  learning how to use Smeadlink  such as     e the scope of each Smeadlink manual  e installing Smeadlink   e upgrading Smeadlink in the future   e customizing Smeadlink   e Smeadlink training    e Smeadlink contact information    The Scope of each Smeadlink Manual    Your Smeadlink system comes with two manuals  This manual that you are  reading is called the User   s Guide  and it is intended for typical Smeadlink  users  The second manual is called the System Administrator s Guide  and it  is intended for the administrator of your Smeadlink system     There are three user names that are frequently used to access Smeadlink  systems  Guest  Editor and Manager  These names give three degrees of user  access to the programs in the system  Guest allows you to view a Smeadlink  program   s main contents and make n
283. sions as they are released  you may also  want to expand the capabilities of your existing system by adding one or more  new modules  For instance  you may originally purchase Smeadlink for bar  code tracking  but later on decide you would like to use it for imaging as well   In this case  you would need to add the Imaging module to your existing  Smeadlink system  If you do decide to add one or more modules  then you can  purchase the additional modules through your dealer at any time     Smeadlink Training    To get the most out of their Smeadlink system  many companies purchase  professional training for their employees who will be using Smeadlink on a  regular basis  Professional training is currently offered by your dealer and by  Smead Software Support  and it explains how to use both the end user fea   tures and the administrative features in Smeadlink  For more information about  Smeadlink training  contact your dealer or Smead Software Support at  800   800 6131     Smeadlink Contact Information    Technical Support    To obtain technical support for your Smeadlink system  contact your autho   rized Smeadlink reseller or Smead Software Support     Phone   800  800 6131    Introduction    Sales Information    If you are interested in sales information about Smeadlink  Smead Sales can  be contacted by phone or email  The phone number and email address for  Smead Sales are both listed below     Phone   800  216 3832  Email  smeadlink smead com  On the Web    Once your S
284. t    As you can see in the example above  the rows in the Contents report are  divided into four columns  Each column is explained below       The first column shows the type of objects are contained at this loca   tion        The next column displays the ID and description of the content     e The third column is called Transaction Time  This column lists the  date and time that each object was assigned to this destination     e The fourth column is called Scan Operator  This column lists the  Smeadlink user name of the person who assigned each object to this  destination        The last column is called Date Due  This column lists the due date of  each object  if the object has a due date  in the example above  the  column has scrolled off to the right     4  If you would like to see all the objects of the selected type that have ever  been assigned to this destination  instead of just the objects that are currently  assigned to the destination  then click the History button     Using the Tracking Features 299    The Contents report will now be expanded to include all the objects of the  selected type that have ever been assigned to this destination  The columns  in the report will also change somewhat  The example below shows what  the Contents report looks like when it has been expanded to include all the  objects that were ever assigned to a destination     Cte Gee si E apiye Pepe Bice el Pai  1  hammimn  e S ige Larisie    Fiii Pim d rpa baa  i Tiii Face 4 Corer Dana  h
285. t   Image feature to print a single or multiple page image document     To print an image document   1  Open the Image Viewer  To open the Image Viewer     e Click the Attachments command on the View menu  or click the At   tachments button on the toolbar      2  Activate the row that the image you want to print is attached to  To acti   vate a row     e Click in one of the row s cells     The image document attached to the activated row will now appear in the  Image Viewer as shown below        An image in the Image Viewer    118    Chapter 7  3  Click the Print command on the File menu  The Print submenu will now  appear     4  Click the Image command on the Print submenu  The Print window will  now appear as shown below        Print window    e If you would like to print this image using a printer other than the  default printer  the printer that was specified in the print setup pro   cess   than click the down arrow at the right of the Name box on the  Print window and select the desired printer     e If the open image document in the Image Viewer contains multiple  pages  you can choose to print a range of pages instead of all of them   To do so  click the Pages radio button on the Print window and then  enter the appropriate page numbers in the from and to boxes     e If you would like to print more than one copy of the image  enter the  desired number of copies in the Number of copies box     5  Click the OK button in the lower right corner of the window  The open  ima
286. t Wizard  and if you use the same import or load on a regular  basis to import data into Smeadlink  Monitor Imports on Startup saves the  user from having to reopen the import or load each time they reopen  Smeadlink     Note  For more information about Import Wizard  see chapter 5 in the Sys   tem Administrator s Guide     Database Connection Timeout    This setting only applies to SQL databases  and it determines how much  time Smeadlink has to connect to the database after the OK button on the  Login window is clicked  i e  how much time Smeadlink has to make the  initial database connection   To set Database Connection Timeout  simply  type the desired connection timeout in seconds into the Database Connec   tion Timeout box     32 Chapter 2    Opening an Add In from a Smeadlink Program    Some Smeadlink programs are often integrated with outside utilities  For  instance  Crystal Reports is often used with Smeadlink to provide extended  report capabilities beyond Smeadlink s Report Generator  To simplify this  process  Smeadlink allows you to create shortcuts to other programs  files or  web pages  These shortcuts are called add ins  and they are created with an  administrative utility called the Add Ins Manager     Once an add in has been created  it becomes visible in the Add Ins menu of  each Smeadlink program  The Add Ins menu has built in security  so if an  add in points to an item that a user does not have access to  then that add in  will not appear on the Add Ins
287. t itself up just as it  was when you finished your scanning session     For instance  suppose you scan five purchase order documents into your  Smeadlink database with the Scanner program  Once you have finished scan   ning the documents  the Scanner s records grid will contain one row for each  purchase order scanned and the Scanner s Image Viewer will display the  image of the last purchase order that you scanned  Now suppose that you  exit the Scanner program  Next time you open the Scanner  you can reopen  the batch that was created during your purchase order scanning session  The  records grid will then redisplay the five purchase order records  and the  Image Viewer will redisplay the image of the last purchase order that you  scanned during that session  Basically  the Scanner will set itself up just as it  was at the end of the session that the batch was created for     By saving session information in separate batches  the Scanner provides  you with a comprehensive look at your scanning history  You can open old  batches to see when you scanned a certain group of documents  and you can  also see which documents you scanned during the same session  Normally   you open batches from the Scan submenu  A window is displayed which  lists all the batches in the open Smeadlink database according to the date and  time they were created  You can then pick the desired batch and it will be  opened by the Scanner     The Load Last Batch option on the Scanner submenu allows you to
288. t read properly     Opening a Batch    The following instructions will show you how to open an existing batch in  the Scanner program  If you are reviewing a batch immediately after you  have finished scanning documents into it  then you will not need to go through  the process of opening a batch  In that case  simply skip the following in   structions and go straight to the next part of this section     To open a batch     1  Open the Scanning menu and click the Scan command  The Scan sub   menu will now appear     2  Click the Locate an old Batch command on the Scan submenu      You can also click the Locate an old Batch button on the Scanner s toolbar    The Locate an old Batch window will now appear as shown on the follow     ing page     190    Chapter 10                   Locate an old Batch window    The Locate an old Batch window lists all the batches in the open Smeadlink  database  The first column in this window contains an Id number for each  batch in the database  The first batch that was scanned has an Id number of  1  the second batch has an Id number of 2  etc  The second column displays  the date and time that the first document in each batch was scanned  The  third column displays the Smeadlink user name that was selected when the  batch was scanned     The Current Operator Batches Only  option allows you to display only those  batches that were scanned by a particular user  To use this option     e Select a batch that was scanned by the desired user name   
289. tach them manually  The process of manually attaching an  orphan image to a row is called manual indexing  and it is what gives the  Manual Indexing utility its name     136 Chapter 8    Scanner System Requirements    The Smeadlink Scanner uses the Kofax Adrenaline scanner controller to  process images  In addition to the Smeadlink Scanner software  you will  need to purchase an Adrenaline scanner controller for the Scanner program  to function  You will also need to purchase a scanner if you want to scan in  paper documents instead of just electronic documents  The scanner you use  needs to be compatible with the Adrenaline scanner controller     For more information about the Kofax Adrenaline scanner controller  con   tact your Smeadlink authorized reseller  or  see Kofax s web site at  http   www kofax com     Once you have purchased the Kofax Adrenaline scanner controller  you  will need to install it on your machine and configure a source for it  The  instructions that come with the Adrenaline scanner controller will walk  you through both tasks  Finally  if you want to use a scanner  you will need  to connect it on your machine according to the instructions it comes with   You will then be ready to start using the Smeadlink Scanner program to  scan images     Working with Scanner Rules 137    9  Working with Scanner Rules    BPE p Se eS ee F       Chapter contents    Introduction   Creating a Basic Rule   Renaming a Rule   Cloning a Rule   Deleting a Rule   Using Load L
290. tains  multiple LinkScripts  If the open database contains just one LinkScript  then  that LinkScript will be run automatically and you will not see the PC Files  window     Smeadlink   PC FILES    Chet what you sald Eke to do pith this PC File      therm click    or    File To Process  Vahat  Heim a1 Veian 2  equenced  doo        Use thet acten  acip  bot al PC Fikes itha batch  Bi   Cancel   Show Fis  gt       PC Files window       5  Verify that you sent the correct files to Smeadlink  To see which files you  sent to be indexed     e Click the Show Files button at the bottom of the PC Files window     The PC Files will now expand to include a box called Files in this batch  The  Files in this batch box will list all the files that you sent to Smeadlink to be  indexed by PC Files  The example on the following page shows what the  Files in this batch box looks like  The box in the example contains two files   starting with one called R  r    What s New in 3 1 Version 2 doc If you would  like to return the PC Files window to its original size after verifying that you  sent the correct files  then click the Hide Files button     Using PC Files 339       Files in this batch box    6  Click the LinkScript that you want the first document to be processed  with     All the LinkScripts in the open Smeadlink database are displayed in the box  in the middle of the PC Files window  In the example above  the PC Files  window displays two LinkScripts  starting with one called Index Corr
291. tandard  Print window will now appear as shown below        Print window    2  Set the options on the Print window to the desired settings     For more information about the options on the Print window  see the section  Print Setup in chapter 7  Steps 2 5 in this section explain the different op   tions on the Print window     3  Click the OK button in the lower right corner of the Print window  The  Contents report will now be printed according to the current settings on the  Print window     To export the Contents report     1  Click the Export button at the bottom of the Contents window  A window  will now appear asking if you would like to export the rows in the Contents  report     2  Click the Yes button on the window     3  Now go to the section called Exporting a Records Grid in chapter 7 of this  manual  Go directly to step 4 in the section  and continue from there  The  remaining steps will walk you through the export process     Using the Tracking Features 301    Viewing the History of an Object    The main purpose of the Tracking Viewer is to display the tracking status of  individual objects  However  you can also use the Tracking Viewer to dis   play the history of an object or to display the contents of a destination  This  section explains how to use the Tracking Viewer to display the history of an  object  and the next section explains how to use it to view the contents of a  destination     All the destinations that an object has ever been assigned to make u
292. tep by step instruc   tions about the process for faxing an image document in the Scanner  see the  section Faxing an Image later in this chapter     Scanning and Viewing Images 187    Image Information    The Image Information feature allows you to view the name and location of  the active image on your computer or network  To view the name and loca   tion of the active image     e Click the Image Information button     A Smeadlink window will now appear displaying the image information   The example below shows what the window looks like  The image in the  example is called MO00016 TIF  and it is located in the  C  SDLK IMAGES legal directory         Fee lbh    y MAGE INFORMATION   MO CABOLEWMIABE SttegahM D00076  TIF        Image Information window    Copy to Clipboard    The Copy to Clipboard feature allows you to copy the entire image in the  active viewer window to the Windows Clipboard  You can then paste the  image into another program such as Microsoft Word  Copy to Clipboard  will only copy the current image in the active viewer window  so if the  image is part of a multi page image document the remaining pages in the  document will not be copied  To copy the current image in the active viewer  window to the Windows Clipboard     e Click the Copy to Clipboard button once     Magnify    The Magnify feature allows you to zoom in on any part of an image in the  Image Viewer  It is useful for viewing portions of an image that are other   wise too small to read  To magni
293. ter     Tracking Smeadlink Objects 271    To assign an object to a destination     1  Make sure the open Smeadlink database contains bar codes for both the  object you want to track and the destination you want to assign the object to     2  Choose the Go command on the Smeadlink menu bar  and click the Bar  Code Tracking program  The Smeadlink Bar Code Tracking window will  open     E he econ A oe       3  Enter the bar code of the object s destination in the Destination section of  the Tracking window  You can do this in one of three ways      e Type the bar code in the Destination section of the Tracking window   and then press the ENTER key or click the OK button     e Pick the destination by clicking the       button to the right of the  Destination section     e Scan the bar code with a hand held bar code reader  such as the Welch  Allyn SCANTEAM 3400 or the Symbol Technologies Spark     The name of the destination will now appear in the tracking diagram on the  left side of the Tracking window  An icon will appear at the left of the  destination that corresponds with the folder that contains the destination row  in Smeadlink  A question mark will also appear below the destination that  you entered  The question mark is a prompt indicating that the Tracking  program is now waiting for you to assign an object to the destination     272    Chapter 14    If the destination that you entered is a container that has a tracking status of  its own  then the tracking status of t
294. ter  the printer specified in the print setup process   then  click the down arrow at the right of the Name box on the Print window  and select the desired printer     e If you would like to print more than one copy of the report  then enter  the desired number of copies in the Number of copies box     7  Click the OK button on the Print window     A report will now be printed for the open view  If you printed a basic report   then the name of the open Smeadlink database will be printed at the top of  the report and the name of the open view will be printed directly underneath  it  If you printed a formatted report  then the information in the report s  header will be determined by that report s settings     If no rows are currently selected in the open view  then the report will in   clude all the rows in the view  If one or more rows are selected  then only  those rows will appear in the report  The report will include as many col   umns as it can fit horizontally on one page  but any columns that are mini   mized in the open view will not be included in the report     Data Output from Smeadlink 117    Printing Images    The Print   Image command on the File menu allows you to print single and  multiple page image documents that are attached to rows in the open view   When you are working with multiple page image documents  the  Print   Image command allows you to print either a selected range of pages  or the entire document  This section will show you how to use the  Prin
295. th of the cells in any Smeadlink view     To adjust the height of all cells in the open view     1  Place the mouse pointer at the far left of the records grid on the dividing  line between two rows     The mouse pointer will now become a vertical resizing cursor as shown in  the example below  The cursor in this example is between the second and  third rows in the grid     iaa   Cee ee ere         Vertical resizing cursor    2  Once the vertical resizing cursor has appeared  hold the left mouse button  down while you drag the cursor up or down to the desired row height     3  Let go of the left mouse button when the row is the size you want  The  remaining rows in the view will now be resized to the new height     70    Chapter 5    To adjust the width of all cells in a column of the open view     1  Place the mouse pointer at the top of the records grid on the dividing line  between the column you want to modify and the next column to the right     The mouse pointer will become a horizontal resizing cursor as shown in the  example below  The cursor in this example is placed to change the width of  the first column     a                          Horizontal resizing cursor    2  Once the horizontal resizing cursor has appeared  hold the left mouse  button down while you drag the cursor left or right to the desired column  width     3  Let go of the left mouse button when the column is the size you want  The  remaining cells in the column will now be resized to the new cell wi
296. the  mouse button  The area in the box will now be copied to the Windows  Clipboard     Scanning and Viewing Images 189    Reviewing a Batch    As you learned earlier  the Scanner program treats each group of documents  that you scan in one session as a group  or batch  After you have scanned a  group of documents  the Scanner saves all the batch information about these  documents in a batch list  You can later reopen any batch in the batch list  and view the different documents that were scanned in that batch     It is a good idea to review a batch soon after it has been scanned  Reviewing  a batch means viewing each image that has been scanned in a batch and  verifying that it was scanned correctly  Several reasons to review each batch  that you scan are that you can catch documents that were scanned in upside  down  and you can also correct bar codes that were not read properly by the  Scanner  There are two main features available in the Scanner for correcting  problems that you may find when reviewing a batch  The Modify feature  allow you to correct any image processing problems  and the Edit Bar Codes  feature allows you to correct bar code recognition problems     This section will show you how to review a batch  The first part explains  how to open a batch  the second part explains how to view documents in a  batch  the third part explains how to correct documents that were not pro   cessed correctly and the fourth part explains how to correct bar codes that  were no
297. the Zoom Window  and be ready for you to type your information into the first field in the  folder   Note  using the Zoom Window for adding records is an option  that may be set in the Options command on the Tools menu      e Click the first cell in the blank row at the bottom of the records grid  A  blinking cursor will now appear in the first cell of the blank row     2  Type in the desired information     If you are entering a record directly to the grid  a pencil will appear in the  row selector of the new row as soon as you start typing  The pencil means  that information has been modified in one of the row s cells  A new  blank  row will also be added beneath the row you are working with  The example  below shows what a view looks like once you begin adding a row     If you are using the Zoom Window  a blank entry form is your tool for enter        New blank row    Pencil in row selector of row being added    98    Chapter 6    ing your information  The Zoom Window enhances and facilitates data entry  by giving you the ability to add many records quickly and easily  When you  are done with one record  simply use the Save  amp  Clear button to save your  current record and clear the Zoom Window  making it ready for your next  button     In both the grid and the Zoom Window  use the TAB and ALT TAB keys to  move the cursor from cell to cell  you can also click on the cell with your  mouse      3  Once you finish entering your data  you will need to save it  There are  sev
298. the different ways to open a folder   You can use these methods to open a folder when another folder is open in  Smeadlink  or when a subfolder is open     Moving Around in Smeadlink 57    To open a folder from the Navigation Bar     1  If the desired folder is not in the open workgroup  then click the name of  the appropriate workgroup on the Navigation Bar     Once you click the name of a workgroup  that workgroup will be opened   The Navigation Bar will display the name and icon of each folder that the  workgroup contains     2  Click the name of the desired folder on the Navigation Bar   The selected folder will now be opened in the Smeadlink window     Note  to go straight into a particular view of the folder  right click on the  name of the desired folder in the Navigation Bar  A submenu will display  showing all available views of that folder     To open a folder from the Go menu   1  Open the Go menu from Smeadlink s main menu bar     The bottom section of the Go menu lists the different workgroups in the  open Smeadlink database  as shown below     2  Click the workgroup on the Go menu that contains the desired folder     Go  PR spani     E nng the     Ml Bar Code Tracking 9 ChE       Workgroups in the open database    58    Chapter 4    folders in the workgroup  The example below shows what a workgroup  submenu looks like  The submenu in the example lists four folders  starting  with a folder called Customers     3  Click the desired folder on the workgroup submenu 
299. the rows in a folder based on one or more of the folder s columns  and you  can display a selected group of rows in a folder using one or more filters  If  you cannot find a row  Smeadlink has a user friendly search tool located on  the main screen which can search by name  number or any record field   Finally  you can export the data from any folder in Smeadlink to a standard   comma delimited text file  This allows you to import your Smeadlink data  into other programs such as Microsoft Word or Excel     As you may have noticed in examples so far  when a folder is open in  Smeadlink you can only see the name of the open folder     To aid in navigating from one folder to another  Smeadlink displays the  parent   child folders via Links above and below the grid  much like you  would find on a Internet web page  Clicking on the link will open the  folder for you  Below are examples of these links     Parent Folder Link          Child Folder Link    Introduction to Smeadlink 45    In the example  one is looking at the child folder called Folders for the parent  folder called Clients  One could go to the Documents subfolder by clicking  on the Child Folder Link  Or  they could go back up to the parent folder by  clicking on the Parent Folder Link  These will change as you move between  different folders in Smeadlink  depending on the design of your database      The second navigation utility in Smeadlink is the Navigation bar  The Navi   gation bar displays the different workgro
300. they will reflect the  most up to date data in the view s table     Data Output from Smeadlink 107    7  Data Output from Smeadlink       Chapter contents    Introduction  Print Setup  Printing Reports  Printing Images  Fax Setup  Faxing Images  Printing Labels  Exporting Rows    108 Chapter 7    Introduction    The previous chapter showed you how to use the editing features in Smeadlink   You learned how to edit existing rows in a view  and how to add one or more  new rows to a view  You also learned how to work with dropdowns in a view  and how to delete rows  either one row at a time or several rows at once     This chapter will show you how to use the features in Smeadlink for data  output  All the data output features in Smeadlink are located on the File menu   You can use these features to print reports or images from Smeadlink using a  standard desktop printer  and you can use them to fax images from Smeadlink  using fax management software and a fax machine  You can also use  Smeadlink s data output features to print both black and white labels and  color coded labels for the rows in a view  and you can use them to export the  rows in a view to a standard  comma delimited text file for use in other  programs     Data Output from Smeadlink 109    Print Setup    Before you can begin printing reports or images from Smeadlink  you will  need to go through a basic print setup process  The print setup process will  determine the default printer settings for printing reports
301. through all  the orphans in the open database  However  if one or more filters have been  applied to the orphans in a database  then the Previous Orphan button will  only allow you to cycle back through the orphans in the database that pass  all the active filters  For more information about filtering the orphans  see  the previous option in this section     Next Orphan    The Next Orphan button allows you to view the next orphan in the open  database   Next  in this situation means an orphan image document with a  trackable Id number one greater than the trackable Id number of the current  orphan  For instance  if the current orphan image document in the Manual  Indexing utility has a trackable Id number of 52  then clicking the Next  Orphan button once will open the orphan that has a trackable Id number of  53  clicking it again will open the orphan with an Id of 54  etc   Remember  the  trackable Id number of the current orphan in the Manual Indexing utility is  displayed in a bar at the top of the image      In general  the Next Orphan button allows you to cycle ahead through all the  orphans in the open database  However  if one or more filters have been  applied to the orphans in a database  then the Next Orphan button will only  allow you to cycle ahead through the orphans in the database that pass all  the active filters  For more information about filtering the orphans  see the  previous page     240    Chapter 12    Previous Page    The Previous Page button will be 
302. tion in this section to rename any rule in the open Smeadlink data   base     To rename an existing rule     1  Open the Scanning menu and click the Rule command  The Rule sub   menu will now appear     2  Click the Rename Rule command on the Rule submenu  The Rename  Existing Rule window will now appear as shown below     Rename Existing Rule    Existing Rules Selection     Select Existing Rule ID   Scammer Scanner J      New Rule Creation        New Rule ID       Cancel                     Rename Existing Rule window    3  Select the rule that you want to rename  To select a rule     e Click the down arrow at the right of the Select Existing Rule ID box to  display a list of existing rules in the open Smeadlink database     e Click the desired rule   4  Type the new name for the selected rule in the New Rule ID box     5  Press ENTER or click the OK button     Working with Scanner Rules 145    Smeadlink will display a message indicating that it is going to update the  Rule s ID on a number of Scan Batches  You should click on the Yes button  to continue  However  if you have many Scan Batches  this update could  take a few seconds     The list of rules on the Rule submenu will now be rebuilt with the updated  name  You can double check that the rule was correctly renamed by re   opening the Rule submenu  The rule you just renamed should be listed  under the new name you gave it  and the old name should be removed from  the list of rules     146 Chapter 9    Cloning a Rule  
303. tions about the process for faxing an image document in the Librarian  see  the section Faxing Images in chapter 7     Image Information    Clicking the Image Information button will bring up a window that displays  basic information about the current orphan in the Manual Indexing utility   The example below shows what the image information window looks like     i  mani PONSA ON    fe pariah pe  De daha ina Pai LAPEER BE CUM Erie PROC NF  Toch anda Fis anes Tri  Dak foanmad TA aE  inter Dade  LCE       Image information window    Copy to Clipboard    The Copy to Clipboard button allows you to copy the entire image in the  Manual Indexing utility to the Windows Clipboard  You can then paste the  image into another program such as Microsoft Word  Copy to Clipboard  will only copy the current image in the viewer so if the image is part of a  multi page image document the remaining pages in the document will not  be copied  To copy the current image in the Manual Indexing utility to the  Windows Clipboard  click the Copy to Clipboard button once     Delete Image    The Delete Image button allows you to delete the current image in the Manual  Indexing utility  This is helpful for deleting individual pages out of multi   page orphan image documents  When you click the Delete Image button  a  window will appear asking if you want to delete the current image  You can  then click the Yes button or press ENTER to delete the current page  To  delete an entire orphan image document  you 
304. tive viewer window will be resized to the corresponding height and  width  The percentage you selected will also be displayed in the Zoom win   dow     Zoom Lock Zoom    When you resize an image using the normal Zoom feature  the Zoom per   centage you selected will only be applied as long as the original image is  displayed in the active viewer window  If you bring up a different image in  the active viewer window  either a different page in a multi page image  document  a different version in a multi version image document or an alto   gether different image document  then the Zoom percentage you selected  will be discarded  The new image will be displayed in the active viewer  window using Fill Viewer with Image     The Lock Zoom button allows you to keep the specified Zoom percentage  and use it to view any number of different images in the active viewer win   dow  When Lock Zoom is enabled  you can bring up different pages  differ   ent versions and different image documents in the active viewer window   and each image will be displayed using the same Zoom percentage  To en   able Lock Zoom for the active viewer window  click the Lock Zoom option  on the Zoom submenu     Note  Lock Zoom only applies to the active viewer window  If you have  multiple viewer windows in your Image Viewer and you would like to lock  the current Zoom percentage for each one  you will need to enable Lock  Zoom separately for each window     214    Chapter 11    Rotate Image 90 Degrees    The R
305. to rotate the current image  in the Image Viewer in 90 degree increments  This feature is helpful if a  document was scanned in upside down  and you would like to view the  image right side up  To rotate an image 90 degrees  in a clockwise direc   tion        Click the Rotate Image 90 Degrees button     Gray Scale    The Gray Scale feature will make the lines and text on the current image in  the Image Viewer appear darker  This can increase readability on images  that have light or thin elements  To enhance the lines and text on an image     e Click the Gray Scale button     Print Image    The Print Image feature works exactly like the Print    mage command on  the Scanner s File menu  The only difference between the two is that the  Print Image feature is easier to get to than the Print    mage command  When  an image is in the Image Viewer  clicking the Print Image button will bring  up the Print window  You can then set the options on this window to the  desired settings  and click the OK button on it to print the current image  For  more detailed information about printing an image from the Scanner  see the  section called Printing Scanned Documents later in this chapter     Fax Image    The Fax Image feature is similar to the Print Image button   it works exactly  like the Fax Image command on the Scanner s File menu  but it is easier to  get to  When an image is open in the Image Viewer  clicking the Fax Image  button will start the process for faxing that image  For s
306. to understand the concept of using paren   theses to adjust order of operation  You will also need to understand how the  logical operators And and Or are used in computer programming to adjust  precedence  If you are not familiar with these concepts  they are covered in  detail in most entry level computer programming books  This section is di   vided into four parts  The first part explains how to create one filter in a  view  the second part explains how to work with multiple filters  the third  part explains how to remove filters and the fourth part explains how to use  the Filter window s advanced features     Viewing Rows in Smeadlink 83    Creating One Filter in a View    The following instructions will show you how to create one filter in the open  view  and apply it to the rows in the view     To create one filter in the open view   1  Click the Rows menu  then click Filter     The Filter window will appear in the middle of your Smeadlink window   The example below shows what the Filter window looks like     Peu Bee  re nce are he       Filter window    If no filters have been created for the open view  then your filter window  will look like the example above  If one or more filters have already been  created for the view  then they will be listed in the Filter window  You can  remove any old filters by clicking the Remove All button at the bottom of  the Filter window     2  Click the New Line button     The New Line button is located in the lower left corner of th
307. to your Smeadlink database  After you  have used this rule to scan your documents  you will not use it again  To  avoid taking up unnecessary disk space with unwanted rules  the Scanner  allows you to permanently remove any rule from the open Smeadlink data   base  This section will show you how to delete a rule     To delete a rule     1  Open the Scanning menu and click the Rule command  The Rule sub   menu will now appear     2  Click the Delete Rule command on the Rule submenu  The Delete Exist   ing Rule window will now appear as shown below     Delete Existing Rule  Existing Rules Selection  Select Existing Rule ID  EA       Cancel      Delete Existing Rule window       3  Select the rule that you want to delete  To select a rule     e Click the down arrow at the right of the Select Existing Rule ID box to  display a list of existing rules in the open Smeadlink database     e Click the desired rule     4  Press ENTER or click the OK button on the Delete Existing Rule win   dow     The Delete Rule window will now appear  asking if you want to delete the  specified rule     5  Click the Yes button on the Delete Rule window  The rule you specified  earlier will now be permanently removed from the open Smeadlink data   base     148 Chapter 9    Using Load Last Batch    Each time you scan a group of documents with the Scanner program  the  Scanner creates something called a batch and saves the session information  into it  If you open this batch later on  the Scanner will se
308. tomatically  using a custom script called a Link   Script  or you can attach it manually  The process of manually attaching an  orphan image to a row is called manual indexing  and it is what gives the  Manual Indexing Viewer its name     14    Chapter 1    Tracking Module    The Smeadlink Tracking module includes the Tracking program and several  add on utilities  The purpose of the Tracking module is to help you monitor  the location of physical objects like folders or boxes  The Tracking module  uses bar codes to monitor the location of each object  In order to track an  object with Smeadlink Tracking  there needs to be a row for the object and a  row for the object s destination in Smeadlink     The Tracking program is the main component in the Tracking module  It is  used for entering bar codes and for assigning the bar code of each Smeadlink  object to the bar code of a Smeadlink destination   An object is an item that  you want to monitor the location of  and a destination is the location of an  object   The process of entering the bar codes of an object and its destination  into Smeadlink Tracking is called tracking an object     When you want to monitor the location of an object with Smeadlink Track   ing  the first step is to run Smeadlink Bar Code Tracking from the Go menu   Then  simply supply the bar codes for the object and the object s destination   Sometimes you may want to track a number of objects that have the same  destination  like a group of folders in a
309. tton above the Selected Fields box  The  lt  lt TRACKING  DATE gt  gt  Properties window will now appear as shown below           ae it ded hhi riitt        lt  lt TRACKING DATE gt  gt  Properties window       14  Select the mmddyyhhmmss format in the Date Format box  and then  click OK to close the  lt  lt TRACKING DATE gt  gt  Properties window     15  Set the date format for the  lt  lt TRACKING DUE DATE gt  gt  column to  mmddyy  using the same procedure explained in steps 13 and 14     Tracking Smeadlink Objects 289    16  Click the Next button at the bottom of the third Import Wizard window   The fourth Import Wizard window will now appear as shown below     Note  There is no sample data in the example shown below  because it is  only being used to show you what the options on the fourth Import Wizard  window look like        etic   ti         Fourth Import Wizard window  17  Enter the desired name for the import in the Import Name box     18  Ifa copy of the data needs to be saved for other purposes  then enter the  desired name in the Storage File for Denso Import box  i e  Denso txt      19  Check the Delete Source File after Processing if the import file is to be  deleted after it has been imported into Smeadlink     20  Click the Next button at the bottom of the fourth Import Wizard win   dow  The fifth Import Wizard window will now appear     21  Click the Finish button at the bottom of the fifth Import Wizard window     290    Chapter 14    To run a Denso import 
310. u               The Help menu allows you to view PDF versions of this user s guide or the  Smeadlink System Administrator guide  and it also allows you to view the  exact version number and registration information for your Smeadlink sys   tem  The first part of this section will show you how to view a PDF version  of this manual  and the second section will show you how to view the ver   sion and registration information for your Smeadlink system     Viewing the PDF Manuals    The PDF format preserves page layout and typography  so when you open  either Smeadlink manual from the Help menu it will look the same as it  looks in printed form  The advantage of viewing the manuals online is that  you can find information and move from topic to topic much faster in the  online versions  and also you do not have to keep track of any physical docu   ments     PDF Requirements    In order to view the PDF manuals  you will need to have the following items  installed on your computer     e the Smeadlink PDF help files  e the Adobe   Acrobat 4 0  or above  Reader    The PDF files for both manuals are included on your Smeadlink CD ROM   and they will be installed automatically when you install your Smeadlink  programs  The Acrobat Reader is also included on the Smeadlink CD ROM   but it will not be automatically installed  If you do not already have the Acro   bat Reader and you want to be able to view the PDF manuals  then the steps  on the following page will show you how to install th
311. u  This section will show you how to use the Redlining popup  menu to delete all Redlining objects on the current image at once     To delete all Redlining objects on an image at once     1  Place your mouse pointer over the Manual Indexing utility window and  click the right mouse button once     A popup menu will now appear in the Manual Indexing utility as shown  below        Redlining popup menu  2  Click the Select All command on the Redlining popup menu     All the Redlining objects on the current image will now be automatically  selected  To indicate that the objects are selected  small  white squares will  appear at the corners of each object     3  Press the DELETE key on the keyboard  All the Redlining objects on the  current image will now be deleted     Using the Manual Indexing Utility 257    Saving Changes and Exiting Redlining Edit Mode    Once you have used the various Redlining buttons to edit an image  you will  probably want to save the changes you have made  This section will show  you how to save any Redlining changes that have been made to the current  image in the Manual Indexing utility  This procedure will also exit Redlin   ing Edit Mode     To save Redlining changes and to exit Redlining Edit Mode     e Simply click one of the other buttons in the same toolbar group as the  Redlining Edit Mode button     There are three other buttons in the same toolbar group as the Redlining Edit  Mode button  These three are the Magnify button  the Drag button and
312. u are work   ing with columns that contain data which is hard to tell apart  such as  phone numbers or email addresses  you can look at the customer names to  help you identify different rows  This section will show you how to freeze a  column in a view  You will also learn how to unfreeze a column once it has  been frozen     Note  Unlike sorting  which can only be performed on certain columns   you can use the Freeze feature on any column in a Smeadlink view  You can  freeze up to one less than the total number of visible columns in the view     To freeze a column in the open view     1  Place the mouse pointer over the desired column header  and then click  the right mouse button once     A popup menu will now appear at the lower right side of the column header   The example below shows what the popup menu looks like          i os         eae    feat Hf ares ae  ki era      Popup menu    Column header that was  used to open the popup menu    80    Chapter 5    2  Click the Freeze Column command on the popup menu     The selected column will now be frozen  To distinguish the frozen column  from columns that have not been frozen  it will be placed at the left side of  the open view  Also  a bar will appear separating the frozen column from the  other columns in the view  The example below shows what a frozen column  looks like  The frozen column in the example is called Author         ee bmi Caie eo ene ae oe  re ee    ree ry EET Fister ppt adage  nS ee et ee a I pira ma  F 
313. ual Indexing Utility 253    ETOT    HG    ofa  ao ee a Asm  EX OCea4Y mm       A pointer on an image    Freehand    The Freehand button allows you to draw  freehand  on the current image in  the Manual Indexing utility  Drawing freehand means that you do not have  to draw a predetermined shape   you can draw any type of line or shape or  curve  To draw freehand on the image in the active viewer window     e Click the Freehand button on the toolbar     e Now position the mouse pointer over the area on the image where you  want to start drawing  hold down the left mouse button and drag the  mouse pointer to create the desired line  curve or shape     e Let go of the left mouse button when you have finished drawing the  first object     e You can draw any number of additional objects using the same proce   dure you used to draw the first one     254    Chapter 12    Text    The Text button allows you to type text on the current image in the Manual  Indexing utility  You may want to use the Text button to label objects that  you draw using buttons like Line or Rect  To type some text on the current  image in the viewer     e Click the Text button on the toolbar     e Now place the mouse pointer in the desired position  and drag it to  create a rectangle  When you let go of the left mouse button after cre   ating the rectangle  the letters AaBbYyZz will appear in the top left  corner of the window  followed by a blinking cursor     Note  If the text in the rectangle is too small t
314. umbers between 101 and 200  etc  Filtering  allows each operator to clearly see which orphan image documents they will  be working with  The example on the following page shows what the Filter  window looks like that appears after clicking the Filter Orphan List button     238    Chapter 12       Filter window    As you can see in the example  the Filter window for orphan image docu   ments is very similar to the standard Librarian Filter window  Both windows  allow you to create three part filters  both windows can test filters for syntax  errors and both windows have an Advanced setting that allows you to use  parentheses and logical operators to adjust how the filters are applied  The  only difference between these two window is that the first component of the  filters in the standard Filter window is a column name  whereas the first  component of the filters in the orphan image Filter window is one of the  three categories introduced earlier  Each category is explained below     The first filter category is Trackable ID  The trackable Id number is a unique  number that identifies each orphan image document  When an orphan im   age document is open in the Manual Indexing Viewer  the trackable Id num   ber will be displayed in a bar at the top of the image     Note  As you can see in the example above  the trackable Id category is  simply called Id in the Filter window     The second filter category is PageCount  The page count is simply the num   ber of pages in an orphan 
315. ups in the active database  and the  different folders in the open workgroup  Clicking on a folder in the Naviga   tion bar will open that folder in Smeadlink  The example on the following  page shows what the Navigation bar looks like  The Navigation Bar in the  example contains six workgroups called Records  Tracking  Maintenance   HR  AP and Correspondence  The Records workgroup is currently open   and the name of its folders is displayed in the Navigation Bar     46 Chapter 3    Navigation Bar    Other workgroups in the active database       Names of the folders in the open workgroup    In the example above  the Navigation Bar is located on the left side of the  Smeadlink window which when it is turned on  via the View menu  is where  it is always positioned     Introduction to Smeadlink 47    In Smeadlink  there are two different options you can choose from for view   ing data in an open folder  The first option is called Grid View  All Smeadlink  folders you have seen so far in the examples have displayed data using the  Grid View option  When you open a folder with Grid View turned on  the  data in the folder will be displayed as a number of rows  All of the rows  together form a records grid  For instance  in the example on the previous  page the Clients folder contains a records grid made up of two rows     In Smeadlink  there is an option called Form View that you can use for  viewing data in an open folder  Form View allows you to display the rows in  a folder one 
316. ur operator name     e Press the ENT button to return to the Options menu     4  From the main menu  press the 1 button  The Tracking window will now  appear  The tracking window contains a destination box and an object box     5  Scan the bar code of the first destination you will be assigning objects to   To scan the destination s bar code     e Place the Denso scanner within six to twelve inches of the desired  destination bar code  and aim the top of the scanner at the bar code     284 Chapter 14    e Press the M1 or M2 button  You will see a red light coming out the top  of the scanner  The bar code will appear in the destination box once it  has been scanned     e To change a locked destination while in Tracking mode  press the F5  button  This will move the cursor up to the destination box  and you  can then scan a new destination bar code as explained above     6  Scan the bar code of the object  or objects  if the current destination is  locked  that you want to assign to the first destination  To scan each object  bar code     e Place the Denso scanner within six to twelve inches of the desired  object bar code  and aim the top of the scanner at the bar code     e Press the M1 or M2 button  You will see a red light coming out the top  of the scanner  The bar code will appear in the object box once it has  been scanned     e Ifthe current destination is a locked destination  then you can continue  scanning object bar codes  Each object bar code that you scan will be 
317. ut the information outside  will be discarded  This allows you to clip out the information you want from  scanned documents and throw away the rest     Working with Scanner Rules 151    To define a front or back picking rectangle  click the Enabled option in the  appropriate section  Now select English if you want the rectangle to be de   fined in terms of inches  or Pixels if you want the rectangle to be defined in  terms of pixels  Once you have selected a measurement system  you will  need to enter the appropriate values for your rectangle in the Top  Left  Width  and Height boxes  In the Top box  enter an offset relative to the top of the  entire image for the top of the picking rectangle  In the Left box  enter an  offset relative to the left edge of the entire image for the left edge of the  picking rectangle  In the Width box  enter the width of the picking rectangle   Finally  in the Height box enter the height of the picking rectangle     After the Front and Back Picking Rectangle sections  the next two sections  on the Source Properties window are Front and Back Rotation  These sec   tions contain options that allow you to rotate the front or back of scanned  documents before they are compressed and saved to disk  This allows you to  save images in a rotated state  If you would like to have images rotated as  they are scanned  select the desired rotation in degrees     The Front and Back Delete Blank Page Threshold sections allow you to  have the Scanner discard ima
318. uture  transfers  you will see the Transfer window after clicking the Transfer button  as shown below        The default Transfer destination will be shown in the Transfer window   as  you setup during the initial setup discussed above   The user will then  choose transfer destination from the dropdown menu  in our example  the  Employee   as well as a due back date and click OK to complete the transfer   A Setup button is provided on this screen to re display the Transfer Setup  window and chose a different default destination if desired     Using the Tracking Features 307    Using the Tracking Requestor    Smeadlink s Requestor option coordinates the activities between the users  and a File Room Administrator  As multiple users enter requests for files   requests are categorized by requestor ID and priority  then displayed on  Requestor Reports  the Smeadlink Tracking Viewer  and optionally as files  are tracked     The first step for a user who needs to retrieve a file is to find the corre   sponding entry in the Smeadlink database  highlight the file and click Re   quest on the Smeadlink menu bar  The example shows a highlighted sample  file with the Request window open     eee LG  Emines Dia Ghali E     r High       po      imm         The user will choose the Requestor from the list and select the priority of  the request  If the file has already been requested  the user will be notified  and given the option to place their request on a Wait List  The Tracking  Viewer w
319. ve window in the  Image Viewer     Closing Attachment Windows    To remove Attachment Windows  simply click on the  X  or Close button  in the upper right hand corner of the Attachment Window  Additionally   the Close option is available on the toolbar  in the Window submenu  as  well as the Close Other Attachment Windows option  This latter option  will close all other attachment windows  accept the currently active win   dow     Using the Image Viewer 211    View    The View option displays a submenu that allows you to chose how you  want images to be displayed  You can display only the image  only thumb   nail version s  of the image s   or both     Versions   Previous Version    The Previous Version option  on the Versions submenu  will be available if  the image document in the active viewer window contains more than one  version  and if a version of that image document other than the first version  is currently being displayed  The Previous Version option will be grayed out  if it is not applicable to the image document in the active viewer window  If  the image document in the active viewer window contains more than one  version  and if the version that is currently being displayed is not the first  version  you can view the previous version of the image document by click   ing the Previous Version option once     Versions   Next Version    The Next Version option  on the Versions submenu  will be available if the  image document in the active viewer window contains mo
320. ver 2000  SP1     Microsoft Office Connectivity  for PC Files   Office 2000  Office XP    332 Appendix A  Smeadlink System Requirements    
321. w  create a rectangle around the portion of the image document that you want  to copy  just like you do when you use the Magnify button  When you let go  of the left mouse button after creating the rectangle  the data inside the rect   angle will be sent automatically to the Windows Clipboard     Using the Manual Indexing Utility 247    Using Redlining Edit Mode    Redlining Edit Mode allows you to edit any image that is displayed in the  Manual Indexing utility  When you click the Redlining Edit Mode button  a  new section will be added to the Manual Indexing utility s toolbar that con   tains a number of editing buttons  You can use these buttons to edit any  image in the viewer with text  lines or shapes  As the name implies  all the  objects that you add to an image will be red     This section is divided into four parts  The first part of explains how to  activate Redlining Edit Mode  the second part explains each Redlining op   tion  the third part explains how to delete Redlining objects on an image and  the last part explains how to save your Redlining changes and exit Redlining  Edit Mode     Activating Redlining Edit Mode    To activate Redlining Edit Mode  simply click the Redlining Edit Mode  button  this button is the last button on the toolbar when it is not in Redlining  Edit Mode   Once you click the button  a new section will be added to the  toolbar  This section will contain all the Redlining options  The example  below shows what the Manual Indexing utilit
322. w to save your Redlining changes and exit Redlining  Edit Mode     Activating Redlining Edit Mode    To activate Redlining Edit Mode  simply click the Redlining Edit Mode  option on the Mode submenu  Once you click the option  a new section will  be added to the end of the Image Viewer submenu that contains all the  Redlining options  The example below shows the additional menu options                 Window b   Main Toolbar   Redining Toplbar   View  gt    Versione      Pages b   Line   Zoom   fe CO Rectangle   wich ri eos    Bilpse     Rotate Image 90 Decrees CS Polyline  48  Gray Scale ie E Polygon  A mage Intormation ake Z Pointer  Ba Copy To Clipboard v Freehand   Select All WM Feact   X Delete Image z  BB Anrotstin croton Aa Tea  Fed Te ae Send to Ba O Note       _ amp  Highlight  Mode  Rediining Edit Mode   gt         Default Properties    Using the Image Viewer 219    Redlining Features    This section lists features on the Redlining submenu  and explains how to  use each one  The features are explained in the order they appear on the  Tools submenu  Additionally  these features can be displayed on a tradi   tional toolbar by clicking on the Redlining Toolbar option  near the top of  the Image Viewer submenu   When the Redlining Toolbar is displayed   tooltips are available     Select    When you first click the Redlining Edit Mode option  the Select option  re   ferred to as  buttons  through the rest of this section  on the Redlining  section of the toolbar will aut
323. ween your hard   ware     Using the Image Viewer 205    11  Using the Librarian Image Viewer    b e i   a a       Chapter contents    Introduction   Opening an Image Document in the Image Viewer  Options on the Image Viewer s Toolbar   Using Redlining Edit Mode    206 Chapter 11    Introduction    The previous chapter showed you how to scan and view image documents in  the Scanner program  You learned how to scan documents with or without a  LinkScript  and you learned how to view images using the Scanner s Image  Viewer  You also learned how to review a batch and correct any images that  were not scanned correctly  Finally  you learned how to print or fax a  Smeadlink image  and you learned how to perform some basic troubleshoot   ing for the Scanner program     This chapter will show you how to use Smeadlink s Image Viewer  which is  the second component in the Imaging module  The Image Viewer is an add   on utility for Smeadlink that allows you to view attached images  image that  are attached to rows   You will learn how to view orphan images in the next  chapter  using another add on utility for Smeadlink called the Manual Index   ing utility     The first section in this chapter will show you how to open the Image Viewer  utility  and adjust its position in the main Smeadlink window  The second  section will then explain each of the general options on the Image Viewer s  toolbar  These options allow you to do things like zoom in on an image  and  print or fax an image  
324. will be automatically selected once you let  go of the left mouse button  and the area under the rectangle will now stand  out from the rest of the image  The example on the following page shows  what a highlighting rectangle looks like     Using the Image Viewer 227    aI ea aa  Pub se ciex a Re eT  eN oOcEs  mmal        P LERA H H Hr a  hid       A highlighting rectangle    Redact   The Redact button allows you to hide text on the image you do not want  others to view  Selecting this button allows you to draw a Rectangle  see  the Rectangle option earlier in this section  that is opaque   allowing you to    cover up sections of a document     228    Chapter 11    Deleting Redlining Objects on an Image    There are several ways to delete Redlining objects on an image  For deleting  individual Redlining objects  you can simply select the desired object and  press the DELETE key on your keyboard  For deleting all the Redlining  objects on an image at once  however  you will need to use the Redlining  popup menu  This section will show you how to use the Redlining popup  menu to delete all Redlining objects on the current image at once     To delete all Redlining objects on an image at once     1  Place your mouse pointer over the Image Viewer window and click the  right mouse button once to display the Image Viewer submenu  Now click  the Redlining option     2  Click the Select All command on the Redlining popup menu     All the Redlining objects on the current image will now
325. will need to use the Delete  Orphan button  which is explained on the following page     244    Chapter 12    Delete Orphan    The Delete Orphan button allows you to delete the current orphan image  document in the Manual Indexing utility  The difference between Delete  Image and Delete Orphan is that Delete Image only deletes the image that is  currently displayed in the Manual Indexing utility  whereas Delete Orphan  deletes the entire document  For orphan image documents that contain only  one page  the Delete Image and Delete Orphan buttons function identically     When you click the Delete Orphan button  a window will appear asking if  you want to delete the current orphan  You can then click the Yes button or  press ENTER to permanently delete the orphan     Note  Once an orphan is deleted  there is no way to bring it back  This  applies to both single images deleted with the Delete Image button  and  multiple page orphan image documents deleted with the Delete Orphan  button     Annotations    The Annotations button allows you to view and work with the annotations  for the current orphan image  Annotations are notes arranged in chronologi   cal order that are specific to one image  Each Smeadlink image can have any  number of annotations     If one or more annotations have been created for the current orphan image   then the Annotations button will have a yellow background  Otherwise  the  background will be white  When you click the Annotations button  the  Smeadlink 
326. window    3  Press ENTER or click the Yes button on the Smeadlink window     The Open ASCII Export Output File window will now appear  This window  specifies which text file the data in the open view will be exported to  The  example on the following page shows what the Open ASCII Export Output  File window looks like     128 Chapter 7    Open ASCII Cape  Outpt Fila       aem aaa       Open ASCII Export Output File window    4  In the File name box  type the name of the file you want the selected rows  exported to     5  Press ENTER or click the OK button on the Open ASCII Export Output  File window  The data in the open view will now be exported to the speci   fied text file     6  If you want to make sure the exporting process worked correctly  open the  text file that you exported the rows to     The exported data should appear in comma delimited fields with quotation  marks around the entries in each field  In the example below  the file  export3 txt contains seven rows of exported data  the first row just lists the  name of each field in the view the data was exported from      E apota WwordFisd    Bie Ed View Insert Foma Help             osla aa al   fae     Hatter  7   Hatter Name   Pi5307T0   Viewsbles Parent Application     OTSHS     patala Copyright     197974    ineedlink Patent Application    196686   Wildtile Copyright     JO 70 S    REN Agreement       345654    Cybernetic Flanges Patent     SOTEO7E   Heeger wieh Office Dapre         For Heip  poses F  a  Ea    
327. window looks like        PC Files LinkScript window    Once you have entered the identification information in the LinkScript win   dow  if required by the selected LinkScript   then the document will be in   dexed in Smeadlink  Anyone on the network with Smeadlink on their com   puter and the appropriate access rights will now be able to open the docu   ment quickly and easily from Smeadlink     PC Files documents are opened from Smeadlink with the Image Viewer util   ity  As you learned in chapter 11  the Image Viewer is typically used to view  images  To view an image  you select a row with the Image Viewer open  or  click in one of the row s cells   and any image that is attached to the selected  row is then displayed in the Image Viewer     328    Chapter 17    Viewing PC Files documents with the Image Viewer is a slightly different  process than viewing images  After you select a row that has a PC Files  document attached to it  the document will not be displayed in the Image  Viewer  Instead  the Image Viewer will display a shortcut to the program the  document was written with  This is done to keep your PC Files in their  original native format  The Image Viewer will also display the name and  location of the Smeadlink copy of the document  as well as provide options  to edit the PC Files document  The example below shows what the Image  Viewer looks like when a row has been selected that is attached to a PC  Files document     Lisciierts Gipi Dalnane lialtiectiaind  
328. wn below     Freee   Tisu Codd prim Nesi  Taw GPAH ie FE  Wiee Sanh    Comreeri    Paper   Centar   ze E    F Prum  Al    jo   rece alri limy          Print Setup window    2  Select the default fax machine for faxing images  To select a fax ma   chine     e Click the down arrow at the right of the Name box to display a list of  the printers and fax machines that are available on your computer     e Click the name of the desired fax machine     The Status  Type  Where and Comment options underneath Name will now  be filled in according to the fax machine you chose     200    Chapter 10    3  If you would like to adjust specific settings for the fax machine you chose  in step 3  click the Properties button to the right of the Name box     A properties window will now appear that you can use to adjust specific  settings on your fax machine  The exact appearance of the properties win   dow will vary according to which fax management program you are using   The example below shows what the RightFAX properties window looks  like  Once you have set the options on your properties window  click the OK  button to save your changes and close the window     HiafaP AN Fan Piima ont AFAN Paperia He  Papar   Giesgties   Fordi   Devis Castors    Pape Laie HITT       Durnin      A  Fee CA   imaa       Puan pmr  ures  fT          ae o    RightFAX properties window    Note  The Size and Source options on the Print window are not applicable  to faxing images  so you can ignore these options    
329. ws  then any Smeadlink user can view the images   Attached images are displayed in Smeadlink with the Image Viewer utility   which is the second component in the Smeadlink Imaging module  In addi   tion to displaying images  the Image Viewer includes features to help in  viewing such as Zoom or Rotate  The example below shows what the Image  Viewer looks like        Image Viewer in Smeadlink    As you learned earlier  the Image Viewer can only be used to view attached  images  If you scan images with a rule that does not specify a LinkScript   however  your images will be scanned into Smeadlink as orphans  To view  orphan images in Smeadlink  you will need to use the Manual Indexing util   ity    The Manual Indexing utility looks very similar to the Image Viewer  It con   sists of a toolbar and a viewer window  Images are displayed one at a time  in the viewer window  and they are manipulated with the tools in the toolbar     The example on the following page shows what the Manual Indexing utility  looks like     Introduction to Smeadlink Imaging 135    5 ae ran  ae ee iT heer      Pe    i amme   e295 885 E ao    a                Manual Indexing utility in Smeadlink    In addition to standard tools for manipulating images  like Zoom and Ro   tate  or Fax and Print  the Manual Indexing utility allows you to attach  orphan images to rows  You can either attach orphan images automatically   using a LinkScript that you run directly from the Manual Indexing utility   or you can at
330. y convert it to base 36     Note  The File Extension setting does not modify how an image is saved  It  only modifies how an image is named  If you want to modify the format the  Scanner uses to save images  use the Storage option explained on the fol   lowing page     158    Chapter 9    Storage    Selecting the Storage option on the Input Output submenu will bring up the  Storage Properties window shown below     ohana  Propecia                Storage Properties window    The Storage Properties window allows you to determine the file type and  compression format for images scanned with the current rule  To modify  either file type or compression format  click the down arrow at the right of  the appropriate box to display a list of file type or compression format choices   Then click on the desired file type or compression format to select it     Note  The CALS file format does not support images scanned with rotation   If you want to save rotated images  you will need to use a different file for   mat     Multiple Page Image File    The Multiple Page Image File option on the Input Output submenu allows  you to determine how the Scanner will save multiple page documents  If  you leave this option unchecked  the Scanner will save multiple page docu   ments as separate images  For instance  a four page document would be saved  as four separate image files  If you select the Multiple Page Image File op   tion  the same four page document would be saved as one file that contains
331. y s toolbar looks like once  Redlining Edit Mode has been activated     h   sii sett   ot IL  o A        ola Be o tx Bo oP Bala  hNOOGG4YmmoD    l    Redlining section on the Manual Indexing utility s toolbar    248    Chapter 12    Redlining Options    This section lists each option in the Redlining section of the toolbar  and  explains how to use each one  The options are explained in the order they  appear on the toolbar  Remember  to view the name of an option  place your  mouse pointer over the option for a few seconds  The name will then be  displayed in a beige box beneath the option     Select    When you first click the Redlining Edit Mode button  the Select button on  the Redlining section of the toolbar will automatically be activated  Select  allows you to select any red text block  line or shape that has been added to  the current image  You can then reposition the red object on the image  or  delete it from the image altogether by pressing the DELETE button on your  keyboard  To select an object     e Make sure the Select button on the toolbar is activated     e Place your mouse pointer over the desired object and click the left  mouse button once     Small  white handles will appear around the object after you have  clicked on it  to indicate that it is selected  You can select multiple  objects at once by holding down the SHIFT key on your keyboard  while you click each object  The example below shows what three  selected red objects look like in the Manual In
332. you the system  and who  worked with you to design and build the database that your system will use     In some cases  Smeadlink systems are installed by Smead Software Support   This usually occurs when a customer has Smead Software Support design and  build a database for them  instead of having the database done by the dealer     Upgrading Smeadlink in the Future    Every Smeadlink system sold comes with a support and maintenance contract   The contract entitles the end user to support from the dealer and Smead Soft   ware Support  In addition  it entitles the end user to updated software when  released  The actual terms of your contract will depend on which dealer you  purchased your system from  and which terms you agreed on with the dealer     When anew version of Smeadlink is released  all customers with current main   tenance contracts will be sent a free upgrade package from Smead Software  Support and   or your dealer  The package will include a CD with the new  Smeadlink program   exe file  on it  manuals expanded to include the latest  features in the new version  and any white papers necessary to explain spe   cific setup issues or system requirements for the new version  The customer  can then either install the upgrade themselves using the white papers as a  guide  or they can have the upgrade professionally installed  Professional in   stallation is available from both dealers and Smead Software Support     Introduction 3    In addition to upgrading to new ver
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
Table of Contents:  Mode d`emploi  User`s Manual - NEC Display Solutions  Rencontres n°118  21. CCTP Lot 4 RIA, colonnes sèches et poteaux d    Owners Manual - ESD  Homework 13: User Manual  Samsung 740NPLUS Felhasználói kézikönyv  府民も参加できる研修会    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file